US20180055927A1 - Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes - Google Patents

Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20180055927A1
US20180055927A1 US15/811,026 US201715811026A US2018055927A1 US 20180055927 A1 US20180055927 A1 US 20180055927A1 US 201715811026 A US201715811026 A US 201715811026A US 2018055927 A1 US2018055927 A1 US 2018055927A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
binding antagonist
individual
antibody
composition
taxane
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Granted
Application number
US15/811,026
Other versions
US11154616B2 (en
Inventor
Daniel S. Chen
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Genentech Inc
Original Assignee
Genentech Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Genentech Inc filed Critical Genentech Inc
Priority to US15/811,026 priority Critical patent/US11154616B2/en
Publication of US20180055927A1 publication Critical patent/US20180055927A1/en
Priority to US17/477,090 priority patent/US20220133886A1/en
Application granted granted Critical
Publication of US11154616B2 publication Critical patent/US11154616B2/en
Active legal-status Critical Current
Adjusted expiration legal-status Critical

Links

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/395Antibodies; Immunoglobulins; Immune serum, e.g. antilymphocytic serum
    • A61K39/39533Antibodies; Immunoglobulins; Immune serum, e.g. antilymphocytic serum against materials from animals
    • A61K39/39558Antibodies; Immunoglobulins; Immune serum, e.g. antilymphocytic serum against materials from animals against tumor tissues, cells, antigens
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K39/395Antibodies; Immunoglobulins; Immune serum, e.g. antilymphocytic serum
    • A61K39/39533Antibodies; Immunoglobulins; Immune serum, e.g. antilymphocytic serum against materials from animals
    • A61K39/3955Antibodies; Immunoglobulins; Immune serum, e.g. antilymphocytic serum against materials from animals against proteinaceous materials, e.g. enzymes, hormones, lymphokines
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/01Hydrocarbons
    • A61K31/015Hydrocarbons carbocyclic
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/335Heterocyclic compounds having oxygen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. fungichromin
    • A61K31/337Heterocyclic compounds having oxygen as the only ring hetero atom, e.g. fungichromin having four-membered rings, e.g. taxol
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/505Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim
    • A61K31/519Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim ortho- or peri-condensed with heterocyclic rings
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K45/00Medicinal preparations containing active ingredients not provided for in groups A61K31/00 - A61K41/00
    • A61K45/06Mixtures of active ingredients without chemical characterisation, e.g. antiphlogistics and cardiaca
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P15/00Drugs for genital or sexual disorders; Contraceptives
    • A61P15/14Drugs for genital or sexual disorders; Contraceptives for lactation disorders, e.g. galactorrhoea
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • A61P35/04Antineoplastic agents specific for metastasis
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • A61P37/04Immunostimulants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07CACYCLIC OR CARBOCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07C271/00Derivatives of carbamic acids, i.e. compounds containing any of the groups, the nitrogen atom not being part of nitro or nitroso groups
    • C07C271/02Carbamic acids; Salts of carbamic acids
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K16/00Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies
    • C07K16/18Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans
    • C07K16/28Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans against receptors, cell surface antigens or cell surface determinants
    • C07K16/2803Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans against receptors, cell surface antigens or cell surface determinants against the immunoglobulin superfamily
    • C07K16/2827Immunoglobulins [IGs], e.g. monoclonal or polyclonal antibodies against material from animals or humans against receptors, cell surface antigens or cell surface determinants against the immunoglobulin superfamily against B7 molecules, e.g. CD80, CD86
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K39/00Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies
    • A61K2039/505Medicinal preparations containing antigens or antibodies comprising antibodies
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K2300/00Mixtures or combinations of active ingredients, wherein at least one active ingredient is fully defined in groups A61K31/00 - A61K41/00
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07KPEPTIDES
    • C07K2317/00Immunoglobulins specific features
    • C07K2317/70Immunoglobulins specific features characterized by effect upon binding to a cell or to an antigen
    • C07K2317/76Antagonist effect on antigen, e.g. neutralization or inhibition of binding

Definitions

  • This invention relates to methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers and for enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer by administering a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
  • T-cells lymphocyte activation of resting T lymphocytes by antigen-presenting cells (APCs). This model further provides for the discrimination of self from non-self and immune tolerance.
  • the primary signal, or antigen-specific signal is transduced through the T-cell receptor (TCR) following recognition of foreign antigen peptide presented in the context of the major histocompatibility-complex (MHC).
  • the second signal, or co-stimulatory signal is delivered to T-cells by co-stimulatory molecules expressed on APCs and induces T-cells to promote clonal expansion, cytokine secretion and effector function. In the absence of co-stimulation, T-cells can become refractory to antigen stimulation, which results in a tolerogenic response to either foreign or endogenous antigens.
  • T-cells receive both positive and negative secondary co-stimulatory signals.
  • the regulation of such positive and negative signals is critical to maximize the host's protective immune responses, while maintaining immune tolerance and preventing autoimmunity.
  • Negative secondary signals seem necessary for induction of T-cell tolerance, while positive signals promote T-cell activation. While the simple two-signal model still provides a valid explanation for na ⁇ ve lymphocytes, a host's immune response is a dynamic process, and co-stimulatory signals can also be provided to antigen-exposed T-cells.
  • the mechanism of co-stimulation is of therapeutic interest because the manipulation of co-stimulatory signals provides a means to either enhance or terminate cell-based immune response.
  • T cell dysfunction or anergy occurs concurrently with an induced and sustained expression of the inhibitory receptor, programmed death 1 polypeptide (PD-1), which binds to ligands that include PD-L1 and PD-L2.
  • PD-1 programmed death 1 polypeptide
  • PD-L1 is overexpressed in many cancers and is often associated with poor prognosis.
  • the majority of tumor-infiltrating T lymphocytes predominantly express PD-1, in contrast to T lymphocytes in normal tissues and peripheral blood T lymphocytes, indicating that up-regulation of PD-1 on tumor-reactive T cells can contribute to impaired anti-tumor immune responses.
  • An optimal therapeutic treatment may combine blockade of PD-1 receptor/ligand interaction with an agent that directly inhibits tumor growth.
  • an optimal therapy for treating, stabilizing, preventing, and/or delaying development of various cancers (e.g., locally advanced or metastatic breast, e.g., metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC)).
  • various cancers e.g., locally advanced or metastatic breast, e.g., metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC)).
  • This invention relates to methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers (e.g., metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC)) and for enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer by administering a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
  • mTNBC metastatic triple-negative breast cancer
  • the invention features a method for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer (e.g., mTNBC) in an individual comprising administering to the individual an effective amount of a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
  • a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist, and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to its ligand binding partners.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L1.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L2. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to both PD-L1 and PD-L2. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is an antibody. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of MDX 1106 (nivolumab), MK-3475 (pembrolizumab), CT-011 (pidilizumab), MEDI-0680 (AMP-514), PDR001, REGN2810, and BGB-108.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to PD-1.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to B7-1.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to both PD-1 and B7-1.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is an antibody.
  • the antibody is selected from the group consisting of: MPDL3280A (atezolizumab), YW243.55.S70, MDX-1105, MED14736 (durvalumab), and MSB0010718C (avelumab).
  • the antibody is MPDL3280A.
  • MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 700 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks (e.g., about 750 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks, e.g., about 800 mg to about 850 mg every two weeks).
  • MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 840 mg every two weeks.
  • the antibody comprises a heavy chain comprising an HVR-H1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:19, HVR-H2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:20, and HVR-H3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:21; and a light chain comprising an HVR-L1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:22, HVR-L2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:23, and HVR-L3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:24.
  • the antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:25 and a light chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an antibody.
  • the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an immunoadhesin.
  • the locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer may be, without limitation, triple-negative breast cancer (TNBC) or metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC).
  • TNBC triple-negative breast cancer
  • mTNBC metastatic triple-negative breast cancer
  • the individual has locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer or has been diagnosed with locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • the cancer cells in the individual express PD-L1.
  • the expression of PD-L1 may be determined by an immunohistochemistry (IHC) assay.
  • the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens (e.g., 0, 1, or 2 prior cytotoxic treatment regimen(s)) for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • prior cytotoxic treatment regimens e.g., 0, 1, or 2 prior cytotoxic treatment regimen(s)
  • the individual has never had prior systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer (e.g., mTNBC). Accordingly, in any of the methods described herein, the administration of an effective amount of a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be a first-line therapy for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be a first-line therapy for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • the treatment may result in a response in the individual.
  • the response is a complete response.
  • the response is a sustained response after cessation of the treatment.
  • the response is a complete response that is sustained after cessation of the treatment.
  • the response is a partial response.
  • the response is a partial response that is sustained after cessation of the treatment.
  • the taxane is administered before the PD-1 axis binding antagonist, simultaneous with the PD-1 axis binding antagonist, or after the PD-1 axis binding antagonist.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 50 mg/m 2 to about 175 mg/m 2 every week (e.g., about 75 mg/m 2 to about 150 mg/m 2 every week, e.g., about 80 mg/m 2 to about 125 mg/m 2 every week, e.g., about 100 mg/m 2 to about 125 mg/m 2 every week).
  • the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 every week.
  • the taxane is paclitaxel.
  • the invention features a method for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the method comprises a dosing regimen comprising treatment cycles, wherein the individual is administered, on days 1 and 15 of each cycle, a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist at a dose of about 840 mg, and on days 1, 8, and 15 of each cycle, a taxane at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 , each cycle being repeated every 28 days.
  • the cycle is repeated until there is loss of clinical benefit.
  • cycles are repeated in which only the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is administered.
  • the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. In some embodiments, the individual has never had prior targeted systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • the invention features a method of enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer, the method comprising administering an effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
  • CD8+ T cells in the individual have enhanced priming, activation, proliferation, and/or cytolytic activity relative to prior to the administration of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane.
  • the number of CD8+ T cells is elevated relative to prior to administration of the combination.
  • the CD8+ T cell is an antigen-specific CD8+ T cell.
  • Treg function is suppressed relative to prior to the administration of the combination.
  • T cell exhaustion is decreased relative to prior to the administration of the combination.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to its ligand binding partners.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L1.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L2.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to both PD-L1 and PD-L2.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist is an antibody.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of MDX 1106 (nivolumab), MK-3475 (pembrolizumab), CT-011 (pidilizumab), MEDI-0680 (AMP-514), PDR001, REGN2810, and BGB-108.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to PD-1.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to B7-1.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to both PD-1 and B7-1.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is an antibody.
  • the antibody is selected from the group consisting of: MPDL3280A (atezolizumab), YW243.55.S70, MDX-1105, MED14736 (durvalumab), and MSB0010718C (avelumab).
  • the antibody is MPDL3280A.
  • MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 700 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks (e.g., about 750 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks, e.g., about 800 mg to about 850 mg every two weeks).
  • MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 840 mg every two weeks.
  • the antibody comprises a heavy chain comprising an HVR-H1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:19, HVR-H2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:20, and HVR-H3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:21; and a light chain comprising an HVR-L1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:22, HVR-L2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:23, and HVR-L3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:24.
  • the antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:25 and a light chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an antibody.
  • the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an immunoadhesin.
  • the locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer may be, without limitation, triple-negative breast cancer (TNBC) or metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC).
  • TNBC triple-negative breast cancer
  • mTNBC metastatic triple-negative breast cancer
  • the cancer cells in the individual express PD-L1.
  • the expression of PD-L1 may be determined by an immunohistochemistry (IHC) assay.
  • the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens (e.g., 0, 1, or 2 prior cytotoxic treatment regimen(s)) for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • prior cytotoxic treatment regimens e.g., 0, 1, or 2 prior cytotoxic treatment regimen(s)
  • the individual has never had prior systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer (e.g., mTNBC).
  • locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer e.g., mTNBC
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 50 mg/m 2 to about 175 mg/m 2 every week (e.g., about 75 mg/m 2 to about 150 mg/m 2 every week, e.g., about 80 mg/m 2 to about 125 mg/m 2 every week, e.g., about 100 mg/m 2 to about 125 mg/m 2 every week). In some embodiments, the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 every week. In some embodiments, the taxane is paclitaxel.
  • the invention features a method of enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer, wherein the method comprises a dosing regimen comprising treatment cycles, wherein the individual is administered, on days 1 and 15 of each cycle, a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist at a dose of about 840 mg, and on days 1, 8, and 15 of each cycle, a taxane at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 , each cycle being repeated every 28 days.
  • the CD8+ T cells in the individual have enhanced priming, activation, proliferation, and/or cytolytic activity relative to prior to the administration of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane.
  • the number of CD8+ T cells is elevated relative to prior to administration of the combination.
  • the CD8+ T cell is an antigen-specific CD8+ T cell.
  • Treg function is suppressed relative to prior to the administration of the combination.
  • T cell exhaustion is decreased relative to prior to the administration of the combination.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • the locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer may be, without limitation, TNBC or mTNBC.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. In some embodiments, the individual has never had prior targeted systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or the taxane are administered intravenously, intramuscularly, subcutaneously, topically, orally, transdermally, intraperitoneally, intraorbitally, by implantation, by inhalation, intrathecally, intraventricularly, or intranasally.
  • the method may further comprise administering an effective amount of a chemotherapeutic agent.
  • the invention features a use of a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist in the manufacture of a medicament for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the medicament comprises the human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and wherein the treatment comprises administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
  • the medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
  • the treatment comprises administration of the medicament once every two weeks to the individual.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the treatment comprises administration of the composition to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every week to the individual.
  • the medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg
  • taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)
  • the treatment comprises administration of the medicament once every two weeks to the individual and administration of the composition once every week to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC.
  • the invention features a use of a taxane in the manufacture of a medicament for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the medicament comprises the taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carder, and wherein the treatment comprises administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the treatment comprises administration of the medicament to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the treatment comprises administration of the medicament once every week to the individual.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
  • the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
  • the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual.
  • the medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg, and the treatment comprises administration of the medicament once every week and administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual.
  • the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC.
  • the invention features a composition comprising a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier for use in treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the treatment comprises administration of said composition in combination with a second composition, wherein the second composition comprises a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
  • the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
  • the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the second composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 .
  • the treatment comprises administration of the second composition once every week to the individual.
  • the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg
  • the second composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2
  • the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every two weeks and administration of the second composition once every week to the individual.
  • the invention features a composition comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier for use in treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the treatment comprises administration of said composition in combination with a second composition, wherein the second composition comprises a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 .
  • the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every week to the individual.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
  • the second composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
  • the treatment comprises administration of the second composition once every two weeks to the individual.
  • the composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2
  • the second composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg
  • the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every week and administration of the second composition once every two weeks to the individual.
  • the invention features a kit comprising a medicament comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and a package insert comprising instructions for administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
  • the medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
  • the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the medicament once every two weeks to the individual.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 .
  • the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the composition once every week to the individual.
  • the medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg
  • the composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2
  • the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the medicament once every two weeks and administration of the composition once every week to the individual.
  • the invention features a kit comprising a first medicament comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and a second medicament comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the kit further comprises a package insert comprising instructions for administration of the first medicament and the second medicament for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
  • the first medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
  • the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the first medicament once every two weeks to the individual.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the second medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 .
  • the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the second medicament once every week to the individual.
  • the first medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg
  • the second medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2
  • the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the first medicament once every two weeks and administration of the second medicament once every week to the individual.
  • the invention features a kit comprising a medicament comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and a package insert comprising instructions for administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 .
  • the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the medicament once every week to the individual.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
  • the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
  • the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual.
  • the medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2
  • the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg
  • the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the medicament once every week and administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist may be selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist, and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-1 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to its ligand binding partners.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L1.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L2.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to both PD-L1 and PD-L2.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist is an antibody. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of MDX 1106 (nivolumab), MK-3475 (pembrolizumab), CT-011 (pidilizumab), MEDI-0680 (AMP-514), PDR001, REGN2810, and BGB-108.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to PD-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to B7-1.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to both PD-1 and B7-1.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is an antibody.
  • the antibody is selected from the group consisting of: MPDL3280A (atezolizumab), YW243.55.S70, MDX-1105, MED14736 (durvalumab), and MSB0010718C (avelumab).
  • the antibody comprises a heavy chain comprising an HVR-H1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:19, HVR-H2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:20, and HVR-H3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:21; and a light chain comprising an HVR-L1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:22, HVR-L2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:23, and HVR-L3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:24.
  • the antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:25 and a light chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4.
  • the taxane may be nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the taxane is paclitaxel.
  • PD-1 axis binding antagonist refers to a molecule that inhibits the interaction of a PD-1 axis binding partner with either one or more of its binding partner, so as to remove T-cell dysfunction resulting from signaling on the PD-1 signaling axis—with a result being to restore or enhance T-cell function (e.g., proliferation, cytokine production, and/or target cell killing).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist includes a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist, and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • PD-1 binding antagonist refers to a molecule that decreases, blocks, inhibits, abrogates or interferes with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-1 with one or more of its binding partners, such as PD-L1 and/or PD-L2.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-1 to one or more of its binding partners.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L1 and/or PD-L2.
  • PD-1 binding antagonists include anti-PD-1 antibodies, antigen-binding fragments thereof, immunoadhesins, fusion proteins, oligopeptides, and other molecules that decrease, block, inhibit, abrogate or interfere with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-1 with PD-L1 and/or PD-L2.
  • a PD-1 binding antagonist reduces the negative co-stimulatory signal mediated by or through cell surface proteins expressed on T lymphocytes mediated signaling through PD-1 so as render a dysfunctional T-cell less dysfunctional (e.g., enhancing effector responses to antigen recognition).
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist is an anti-PD-1 antibody.
  • a PD-1 binding antagonist is MDX-1106 (nivolumab) described herein.
  • a PD-1 binding antagonist is MK-3475 (pembrolizumab) described herein.
  • a PD-1 binding antagonist is CT-011 (pidilizumab) described herein.
  • a PD-1 binding antagonist is MEDI-0680 (AMP-514) described herein.
  • a PD-1 binding antagonist is PDR001 described herein.
  • a PD-1 binding antagonist is REGN2810 described herein.
  • a PD-1 binding antagonist is BGB-108 described herein.
  • PD-L1 binding antagonist refers to a molecule that decreases, blocks, inhibits, abrogates or interferes with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-L1 with either one or more of its binding partners, such as PD-1 and/or B7-1.
  • a PD-L1 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to its binding partners.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits binding of PD-L1 to PD-1 and/or B7-1.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonists include anti-PD-L1 antibodies, antigen-binding fragments thereof, immunoadhesins, fusion proteins, oligopeptides and other molecules that decrease, block, inhibit, abrogate or interfere with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-L1 with one or more of its binding partners, such as PD-1 and/or B7-1.
  • a PD-L1 binding antagonist reduces the negative co-stimulatory signal mediated by or through cell surface proteins expressed on T lymphocytes mediated signaling through PD-L1 so as to render a dysfunctional T-cell less dysfunctional (e.g., enhancing effector responses to antigen recognition).
  • a PD-L1 binding antagonist is an anti-PD-L1 antibody.
  • an anti-PD-L1 antibody is MPDL3280A (atezolizumab, marketed as TECENTRIQTM with a WHO Drug Information (International Nonproprietary Names for Pharmaceutical Substances), Recommended INN: List 74, Vol. 29, No. 3, 2015 (see page 387)) described herein.
  • an anti-PD-L1 antibody is MDX-1105 described herein.
  • an anti-PD-L1 antibody is YW243.55.S70 described herein.
  • an anti-PD-L1 antibody is MED14736 (durvalumab) described herein.
  • an anti-PD-L1 antibody is MSB0010718C (avelumab) described herein.
  • PD-L2 binding antagonist refers to a molecule that decreases, blocks, inhibits, abrogates or interferes with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-L2 with either one or more of its binding partners, such as PD-1.
  • a PD-L2 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-L2 to one or more of its binding partners.
  • the PD-L2 binding antagonist inhibits binding of PD-L2 to PD-1.
  • the PD-L2 antagonists include anti-PD-L2 antibodies, antigen binding fragments thereof, immunoadhesins, fusion proteins, oligopeptides and other molecules that decrease, block, inhibit, abrogate or interfere with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-L2 with either one or more of its binding partners, such as PD-1.
  • a PD-L2 binding antagonist reduces the negative co-stimulatory signal mediated by or through cell surface proteins expressed on T lymphocytes mediated signaling through PD-L2 so as render a dysfunctional T-cell less dysfunctional (e.g., enhancing effector responses to antigen recognition).
  • a PD-L2 binding antagonist is an immunoadhesin.
  • Taxanes as used herein is a diterpene which may bind to tubulin, promoting microtubule assembly and stabilization and/or prevent microtubule depolymerization.
  • Taxanes included herein include taxoid 10-deacetylbaccatin III and/or derivatives thereof.
  • Examplary taxanes include, but are not limited to, paclitaxel (i.e., TAXOL®, CAS #33069-62-4), docetaxel (i.e., TAXOTERE®, CAS #114977-28-5), larotaxel, cabazitaxel, milataxel, tesetaxel, and/or orataxel.
  • the taxane is an albumin-coated nanoparticle (e.g., nano-albumin bound (nab)-paclitaxel, i.e., ABRAXANE® and/or nab-docetaxel, ABI-008).
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the taxane is formulated in CREMAPHOR® (e.g., TAXOL®) and/or in Tween such as polysorbate 80 (e.g., TAXOTERE®).
  • the taxane is liposome-encapsulated taxane.
  • the taxane is a prodrug form and/or conjugated form of taxane (e.g., DHA covalently conjugated to paclitaxel, paclitaxel poliglumex, and/or linoleyl carbonate-paclitaxel).
  • the paclitaxel is formulated with substantially no surfactant (e.g., in the absence of CREMAPHOR and/or Tween-such as TOCOSOL® paclitaxel).
  • disfunction in the context of immune dysfunction, refers to a state of reduced immune responsiveness to antigenic stimulation.
  • the term includes the common elements of both “exhaustion” and/or “anergy” in which antigen recognition may occur, but the ensuing immune response is ineffective to control infection or tumor growth.
  • disfunctional also includes refractory or unresponsive to antigen recognition, specifically, impaired capacity to translate antigen recognition into down-stream T-cell effector functions, such as proliferation, cytokine production (e.g., IL-2) and/or target cell killing.
  • T cell anergy refers to the state of unresponsiveness to antigen stimulation resulting from incomplete or insufficient signals delivered through the T-cell receptor (e.g., increase in intracellular Ca +2 in the absence of ras-activation). T cell anergy can also result upon stimulation with antigen in the absence of co-stimulation, resulting in the cell becoming refractory to subsequent activation by the antigen even in the context of co-stimulation. The unresponsive state can often be overridden by the presence of Interleukin-2. Anergic T-cells do not undergo clonal expansion and/or acquire effector functions.
  • exhaustion refers to T cell exhaustion as a state of T cell dysfunction that arises from sustained TCR signaling that occurs during many chronic infections and cancer. It is distinguished from anergy in that it arises not through incomplete or deficient signaling, but from sustained signaling. It is defined by poor effector function, sustained expression of inhibitory receptors and a transcriptional state distinct from that of functional effector or memory T cells. Exhaustion prevents optimal control of infection and tumors. Exhaustion can result from both extrinsic negative regulatory pathways (e.g., immunoregulatory cytokines) as well as cell intrinsic negative regulatory (costimulatory) pathways (PD-1, B7-H3, B7-H4, etc.).
  • extrinsic negative regulatory pathways e.g., immunoregulatory cytokines
  • costimulatory costimulatory
  • “Enhancing T-cell function” means to induce, cause or stimulate a T-cell to have a sustained or amplified biological function, or renew or reactivate exhausted or inactive T-cells.
  • Examples of enhancing T-cell function include: increased secretion of ⁇ -interferon from CD8+ T-cells, increased proliferation, increased antigen responsiveness (e.g., viral, pathogen, or tumor clearance) relative to such levels before the intervention.
  • the level of enhancement is as least 50%, alternatively 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, 100%, 120%, 150%, or 200% enhancement. The manner of measuring this enhancement is known to one of ordinary skill in the art.
  • T cell dysfunctional disorder is a disorder or condition of T-cells characterized by decreased responsiveness to antigenic stimulation.
  • a T-cell dysfunctional disorder is a disorder that is specifically associated with inappropriate increased signaling through PD-1.
  • a T-cell dysfunctional disorder is one in which T-cells are anergic or have decreased ability to secrete cytokines, proliferate, or execute cytolytic activity.
  • the decreased responsiveness results in ineffective control of a pathogen or tumor expressing an immunogen.
  • T cell dysfunctional disorders characterized by T-cell dysfunction include unresolved acute infection, chronic infection and tumor immunity.
  • Tumor immunity refers to the process in which tumors evade immune recognition and clearance. Thus, as a therapeutic concept, tumor immunity is “treated” when such evasion is attenuated, and the tumors are recognized and attacked by the immune system. Examples of tumor recognition include tumor binding, tumor shrinkage and tumor clearance.
  • Immunogenicity refers to the ability of a particular substance to provoke an immune response. Tumors are immunogenic and enhancing tumor immunogenicity aids in the clearance of the tumor cells by the immune response. Examples of enhancing tumor immunogenicity include treatment with a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
  • sustained response refers to the sustained effect on reducing tumor growth after cessation of a treatment.
  • the tumor size may remain to be the same or smaller as compared to the size at the beginning of the administration phase.
  • the sustained response has a duration at least the same as the treatment duration, at least 1.5 ⁇ , 2.0 ⁇ , 2.5 ⁇ , or 3.0 ⁇ length of the treatment duration.
  • reducing or inhibiting cancer relapse means to reduce or inhibit tumor or cancer relapse or tumor or cancer progression.
  • cancer relapse and/or cancer progression include, without limitation, cancer metastasis.
  • partial response refers to at least a 30% decrease in the sum of the longest diameters (SLD) of target lesions, taking as reference the baseline SLD.
  • stable disease or “SD” refers to neither sufficient shrinkage of target lesions to qualify for PR, nor sufficient increase to qualify for PD, taking as reference the smallest SLD since the treatment started.
  • PD progressive disease
  • progression free survival refers to the length of time during and after treatment during which the disease being treated (e.g., cancer) does not get worse. Progression-free survival may include the amount of time patients have experienced a complete response or a partial response, as well as the amount of time patients have experienced stable disease.
  • ORR objective response rate
  • OS all survival
  • pharmaceutical formulation refers to a preparation which is in such form as to permit the biological activity of the active ingredient to be effective, and which contains no additional components which are unacceptably toxic to a subject to which the formulation would be administered. Such formulations are sterile. “Pharmaceutically acceptable” excipients (vehicles, additives) are those which can reasonably be administered to a subject mammal to provide an effective dose of the active ingredient employed.
  • treatment refers to clinical intervention designed to alter the natural course of the individual or cell being treated during the course of clinical pathology. Desirable effects of treatment include decreasing the rate of disease progression, ameliorating or palliating the disease state, and remission or improved prognosis.
  • an individual is successfully “treated” if one or more symptoms associated with cancer are mitigated or eliminated, including, but are not limited to, reducing the proliferation of (or destroying) cancerous cells, decreasing symptoms resulting from the disease, increasing the quality of life of those suffering from the disease, decreasing the dose of other medications required to treat the disease, and/or prolonging survival of individuals.
  • “delaying progression” of a disease means to defer, hinder, slow, retard, stabilize, and/or postpone development of the disease (such as cancer). This delay can be of varying lengths of time, depending on the history of the disease and/or individual being treated. As is evident to one skilled in the art, a sufficient or significant delay can, in effect, encompass prevention, in that the individual does not develop the disease. For example, a late stage cancer, such as development of metastasis, may be delayed.
  • an “effective amount” is at least the minimum amount required to effect a measurable improvement or prevention of a particular disorder.
  • An effective amount herein may vary according to factors such as the disease state, age, sex, and weight of the patient, and the ability of the agent to elicit a desired response in the individual.
  • An effective amount is also one in which any toxic or detrimental effects of the treatment are outweighed by the therapeutically beneficial effects.
  • beneficial or desired results include results such as eliminating or reducing the risk, lessening the severity, or delaying the onset of the disease, including biochemical, histological and/or behavioral symptoms of the disease, its complications and intermediate pathological phenotypes presenting during development of the disease.
  • beneficial or desired results include clinical results such as decreasing one or more symptoms resulting from the disease, increasing the quality of life of those suffering from the disease, decreasing the dose of other medications required to treat the disease, and enhancing effect of another medication such as via targeting, delaying the progression of the disease, and/or prolonging survival.
  • an effective amount of the drug may have the effect in reducing the number of cancer cells; reducing the tumor size; inhibiting (i.e., slow to some extent or desirably stop) cancer cell infiltration into peripheral organs: inhibit (i.e., slow to some extent and desirably stop) tumor metastasis; inhibiting to some extent tumor growth; and/or relieving to some extent one or more of the symptoms associated with the disorder.
  • an effective amount can be administered in one or more administrations.
  • an effective amount of drug, compound, or pharmaceutical composition is an amount sufficient to accomplish prophylactic or therapeutic treatment either directly or indirectly.
  • an effective amount of a drug, compound, or pharmaceutical composition may or may not be achieved in conjunction with another drug, compound, or pharmaceutical composition.
  • an “effective amount” may be considered in the context of administering one or more therapeutic agents, and a single agent may be considered to be given in an effective amount if, in conjunction with one or more other agents, a desirable result may be or is achieved.
  • conjunction with refers to administration of one treatment modality in addition to another treatment modality.
  • in conjunction with refers to administration of one treatment modality before, during, or after administration of the other treatment modality to the individual.
  • a “disorder” is any condition that would benefit from treatment including, but not limited to, chronic and acute disorders or diseases including those pathological conditions which predispose the mammal to the disorder in question.
  • cell proliferative disorder and “proliferative disorder” refer to disorders that are associated with some degree of abnormal cell proliferation.
  • the cell proliferative disorder is cancer.
  • the cell proliferative disorder is a tumor.
  • tumor refers to all neoplastic cell growth and proliferation, whether malignant or benign, and all pre-cancerous and cancerous cells and tissues.
  • cancer refers to all neoplastic cell growth and proliferation, whether malignant or benign, and all pre-cancerous and cancerous cells and tissues.
  • cancer refers to all neoplastic cell growth and proliferation, whether malignant or benign, and all pre-cancerous and cancerous cells and tissues.
  • breast cancer includes, but is not limited to, HER2+ breast cancer and triple-negative breast cancer (TNBC), which is a form of breast cancer in which the cancer cells are negative for estrogen receptors (ER ⁇ ), progesterone receptors (PR ⁇ ), and HER2 (HER2 ⁇ ), and which may be locally advanced, unresectable, and/or metastatic (e.g., metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC)).
  • TNBC triple-negative breast cancer
  • ER ⁇ estrogen receptors
  • PR ⁇ progesterone receptors
  • HER2 ⁇ HER2
  • metastatic e.g., metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC)
  • cancer staging is generally defined as cancer that has spread from a localized area to nearby tissues and/or lymph nodes.
  • locally advanced usually is classified in Stage II or III.
  • Cancer which is metastatic is a stage where the cancer spreads throughout the body to distant tissues and organs (stage IV).
  • Cytotoxic agent refers to any agent that is detrimental to cells (e.g., causes cell death, inhibits proliferation, or otherwise hinders a cellular function). Cytotoxic agents include, but are not limited to, radioactive isotopes (e.g., At 211 , I 131 , I 125 , Y 90 , Re 186 , Re 188 , Sm 153 , Bi 212 , P 32 , Pb 212 and radioactive isotopes of Lu); chemotherapeutic agents; growth inhibitory agents; enzymes and fragments thereof such as nucleolytic enzymes; and toxins such as small molecule toxins or enzymatically active toxins of bacterial, fungal, plant or animal origin, including fragments and/or variants thereof.
  • radioactive isotopes e.g., At 211 , I 131 , I 125 , Y 90 , Re 186 , Re 188 , Sm 153 , Bi 212 , P 32 , Pb
  • Exemplary cytotoxic agents can be selected from anti-microtubule agents, platinum coordination complexes, alkylating agents, antibiotic agents, topoisomerase II inhibitors, antimetabolites, topoisomerase I inhibitors, hormones and hormonal analogues, signal transduction pathway inhibitors, non-receptor tyrosine kinase angiogenesis inhibitors, immunotherapeutic agents, proapoptotic agents, inhibitors of LDH-A, inhibitors of fatty acid biosynthesis, cell cycle signalling inhibitors, HDAC inhibitors, proteasome inhibitors, and inhibitors of cancer metabolism.
  • the cytotoxic agent is a platinum-based chemotherapeutic agent.
  • the cytotoxic agent is an antagonist of EGFR.
  • the cytotoxic agent is N-(3-ethynylphenyl)-6,7-bis(2-methoxyethoxy)quinazolin-4-amine (e.g., erlotinib, TARCEVATM).
  • the cytotoxic agent is a RAF inhibitor.
  • the RAF inhibitor is a BRAF and/or CRAF inhibitor.
  • the RAF inhibitor is vemurafenib.
  • the cytotoxic agent is a PI3K inhibitor.
  • chemotherapeutic agent includes compounds useful in the treatment of cancer, such as mTNBC.
  • chemotherapeutic agents include erlotinib (TARCEVA®, Genentech/OSI Pharm.), bortezomib (VELCADE®, Millennium Pharm.), disulfiram, epigallocatechin gallate, salinosporamide A, carfilzomib, 17-AAG (geldanamycin), radicicol, lactate dehydrogenase A (LDH-A), fulvestrant (FASLODEX®, AstraZeneca), sunitib (SUTENT®, Pfizer/Sugen), letrozole (FEMARA®, Novartis), imatinib mesylate (GLEEVEC®, Novartis), finasunate (VATALANIB®, Novartis), oxaliplatin (ELOXATIN®, Sanofi), 5-FU (5-fluorouracil), leu
  • dynemicin including dynemicin A; bisphosphonates, such as clodronate; an esperamicin; as well as neocarzinostatin chromophore and related chromoprotein enediyne antibiotic chromophores), aclacinomysins, actinomycin, authramycin, azaserine, bleomycins, cactinomycin, carabicin, caminomycin, carzinophilin, chromomycinis, dactinomycin, daunorubicin, detorubicin, 6-diazo-5-oxo-L-norleucine, ADRIAMYCIN® (doxorubicin), morpholino-doxorubicin, cyanomorpholino-doxorubicin, 2-pyrrolino-doxorubicin and deoxydoxorubicin), epirubicin,
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include “platinum-based” chemotherapeutic agents, which comprise an organic compound which contains platinum as an integral part of the molecule. Typically platinum-based chemotherapeutic agents are coordination complexes of platinum. Platinum-based chemotherapeutic agents are sometimes called “platins” in the art. Examples of platinum-based chemotherapeutic agents include, but are not limited to, carboplatin, cisplatin, and oxaliplatin.
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include (i) anti-hormonal agents that act to regulate or inhibit hormone action on tumors such as anti-estrogens and selective estrogen receptor modulators (SERMs), including, for example, tamoxifen (including NOLVADEX®; tamoxifen citrate), raloxifene, droloxifene, iodoxyfene, 4-hydroxytamoxifen, trioxifene, keoxifene.
  • SERMs selective estrogen receptor modulators
  • LY117018, onapristone, and FARESTON® toremifine citrate
  • aromatase inhibitors that inhibit the enzyme aromatase, which regulates estrogen production in the adrenal glands, such as, for example, 4(5)-imidazoles, aminoglutethimide.
  • MEGASE® (megestrol acetate), AROMASIN® (exemestane; Pfizer), formestanie, fadrozole, RIVISOR® (vorozole), FEMARA® (letrozole; Novartis), and ARIMIDEX® (anastrozole; AstraZeneca);
  • anti-androgens such as flutamide, nilutamide, bicalutamide, leuprolide and goserelin; buserelin, tripterelin, medroxyprogesterone acetate, diethylstilbestrol, premarin, fluoxymesterone, all transretionic acid, fenretinide, as well as troxacitabine (a 1,3-dioxolane nucleoside cytosine analog);
  • protein kinase inhibitors (v) lipid kinase inhibitors;
  • antisense oligonucleotides particularly those which inhibit expression
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include antibodies such as alemtuzumab (Campath), bevacizumab (AVASTIN®, Genentech); cetuximab (ERBITUX®, Imclone); panitumumab (VECTIBIX®, Amgen), rituximab (RITUXAN®, Genentech/Biogen Idec), pertuzumab (OMNITARG®, 2C4, Genentech), trastuzumab (HERCEPTIN®, Genentech), tositumomab (Bexxar, Corixia), and the antibody drug conjugate, gemtuzumab ozogamicin (MYLOTARG, Wyeth).
  • antibodies such as alemtuzumab (Campath), bevacizumab (AVASTIN®, Genentech); cetuximab (ERBITUX®, Imclone); panitumumab (VECTIBIX®, Amgen), rituximab (
  • Additional humanized monoclonal antibodies with therapeutic potential as agents in combination with the compounds of the invention include: apolizumab, aselizumab, atlizumab, bapineuzumab, bivatuzumab mertansine, cantuzumab mertansine, cedelizumab, certolizumab pegol, cidfusituzumab, cidtuzumab, daclizumab, eculizumab, efalizumab, epratuzumab, erlizumab, felvizumab, fontolizumab, gemtuzumab ozogamicin, inotuzumab ozogamicin, ipilimumab, labetuzumab, lintuzumab, matuzumab, mepolizumab, motavizumab, motovizumab, natalizumab, nimotuzumab, nolovizum
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include “EGFR inhibitors,” which refers to compounds that bind to or otherwise interact directly with EGFR and prevent or reduce its signaling activity, and is alternatively referred to as an “EGFR antagonist.”
  • EGFR inhibitors refers to compounds that bind to or otherwise interact directly with EGFR and prevent or reduce its signaling activity
  • Examples of such agents include antibodies and small molecules that bind to EGFR.
  • antibodies which bind to EGFR include MAb 579 (ATCC CRL HB 8506), MAb 455 (ATCC CRL HB8507), MAb 225 (ATCC CRL 8508), MAb 528 (ATCC CRL 8509) (see, U.S. Pat. No.
  • EMD 55900 Stragliotto et al., Eur. J. Cancer 32A:636-640 (1996)
  • EMD7200 a humanized EGFR antibody directed against EGFR that competes with both EGF and TGF-alpha for EGFR binding
  • human EGFR antibody HuMax-EGFR (GenMab)
  • fully human antibodies known as E1.1, E2.4, E2.5, E6.2, E6.4, E2.11, E6. 3 and E7.6. 3 and described in U.S. Pat. No.
  • the anti-EGFR antibody may be conjugated with a cytotoxic agent, thus generating an immunoconjugate (see, e.g., EP659439A2, Merck Patent GmbH).
  • EGFR antagonists include small molecules such as compounds described in U.S. Pat. Nos.
  • Particular small molecule EGFR antagonists include OSI-774 (CP-358774, erlotinib, TARCEVA® Genentech/OSI Pharmaceuticals); PD 183805 (CI 1033, 2-propenamide, N-[4-[(3-chloro-4-fluorophenyl)amino]-7-[3-(4-morpholinyl)propoxy]-6-quinazolinyl]-, dihydrochloride. Pfizer Inc.); ZD1839, gefitinib (IRESSA®) 4-(3′-Chloro-4′-fluoroanilino)-7-methoxy-6-(3-morpholinopropoxy)quinazoline.
  • OSI-774 CP-358774, erlotinib, TARCEVA® Genentech/OSI Pharmaceuticals
  • PD 183805 CI 1033, 2-propenamide, N-[4-[(3-chloro-4-fluorophenyl)amino]-7-[3
  • ZM 105180 ((6-amino-4-(3-methylphenyl-amino)-quinazoline, Zeneca); BIBX-1382 (N8-(3-chloro-4-fluoro-phenyl)-N2-(1-methyl-piperidin-4-yl)-pyrimido[5,4-d]pyrimidine-2,8-diamine, Boehringer Ingelheim); PKI-166 ((R)-4-[4-[(1-phenylethyl)amino]-1H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-6-yl]-phenol); (R)-6-(4-hydroxyphenyl)-4-[(1-phenylethyl)amino]-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrmidine); CL-387785 (N-[4-[(3-bromophenyl)amino]-6-quinazolinyl]-2-butynamide); EKB
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include “tyrosine kinase inhibitors” including the EGFR-targeted drugs noted in the preceding paragraph; small molecule HER2 tyrosine kinase inhibitor such as TAK165 available from Takeda; CP-724,714, an oral selective inhibitor of the ErbB2 receptor tyrosine kinase (Pfizer and OSI); dual-HER inhibitors such as EKB-569 (available from Wyeth) which preferentially binds EGFR but inhibits both HER2 and EGFR-overexpressing cells; lapatinib (GSK572016; available from Glaxo-SmithKline), an oral HER2 and EGFR tyrosine kinase inhibitor; PKI-166 (available from Novartis); pan-HER inhibitors such as canertinib (CI-1033; Pharmacia); Raf-1 inhibitors such as antisense agent ISIS-5132 available from ISIS Pharmaceuticals which inhibit Raf-1 signaling; non-HER-target
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include dexamethasone, interferons, colchicine, metoprine, cyclosporine, amphotericin, metronidazole, alemtuzumab, alitretinoin, allopurinol, amifostine, arsenic trioxide, asparaginase, BCG live, bevacuzimab, bexarotene, cladribine, clofarabine, darbepoetin alfa, denileukin, dexrazoxane, epoetin alfa, elotinib, filgrastim, histrelin acetate, ibritumomab, interferon alfa-2a, interferon alfa-2b, lenalidomide, levamisole, mesna, methoxsalen, nandrolone, nelarabine, nofetumomab, oprelvekin,
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include hydrocortisone, hydrocortisone acetate, cortisone acetate, tixocortol pivalate, triamcinolone acetonide, triamcinolone alcohol, mometasone, amcinonide, budesonide, desonide, fluocinonide, fluocinolone acetonide, betamethasone, betamethasone sodium phosphate, dexamethasone, dexamethasone sodium phosphate, fluocortolone, hydrocortisone-17-butyrate, hydrocortisone-17-valerate, aclometasone dipropionate, betamethasone valerate, betamethasone dipropionate, prednicarbate, clobetasone-17-butyrate, clobetasol-17-propionate, fluocortolone caproate, fluocortolone pivalate and fluprednidene acetate; immune selective
  • NE-58095 zoledronic acid/zoledronate (ZOMETA®), alendronate (FOSAMAX®), pamidronate (AREDIA®), tiludronate (SKELID®), or risedronate (ACTONEL®); and epidermal growth factor receptor (EGF-R); vaccines such as THERATOPE® vaccine; perifosine, COX-2 inhibitor (e.g., celecoxib or etoricoxib), proteosome inhibitor (e.g.
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs with analgesic, antipyretic and anti-inflammatory effects.
  • NSAIDs include non-selective inhibitors of the enzyme cyclooxygenase.
  • Specific examples of NSAIDs include aspirin, propionic acid derivatives such as ibuprofen, fenoprofen, ketoprofen, flurbiprofen, oxaprozin and naproxen, acetic acid derivatives such as indomethacin, sulindac, etodolac, diclofenac, enolic acid derivatives such as piroxicam, meloxicam, tenoxicam, droxicam, lomoxicam and isoxicam, fenamic acid derivatives such as mefenamic acid, meclofenamic acid, flufenamic acid, tolfenamic acid, and COX-2 inhibitors such as celecoxib, etoricoxib, lumiracoxi
  • NSAIDs can be indicated for the symptomatic relief of conditions such as rheumatoid arthritis, osteoarthritis, inflammatory arthropathies, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriatic arthritis, Reiter's syndrome, acute gout, dysmenorrhoea, metastatic bone pain, headache and migraine, postoperative pain, mild-to-moderate pain due to inflammation and tissue injury, pyrexia, ileus, and renal colic.
  • conditions such as rheumatoid arthritis, osteoarthritis, inflammatory arthropathies, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriatic arthritis, Reiter's syndrome, acute gout, dysmenorrhoea, metastatic bone pain, headache and migraine, postoperative pain, mild-to-moderate pain due to inflammation and tissue injury, pyrexia, ileus, and renal colic.
  • a “growth inhibitory agent” when used herein refers to a compound or composition which inhibits growth of a cell either in vitro or in vivo.
  • a growth inhibitory agent is growth inhibitory antibody that prevents or reduces proliferation of a cell expressing an antigen to which the antibody binds.
  • the growth inhibitory agent may be one which significantly reduces the percentage of cells in S phase. Examples of growth inhibitory agents include agents that block cell cycle progression (at a place other than S phase), such as agents that induce G1 arrest and M-phase arrest.
  • Classical M-phase blockers include the vincas (vincristine and vinblastine), taxanes, and topoisomerase II inhibitors such as doxorubicin, epirubicin, daunorubicin, etoposide, and bleomycin.
  • Those agents that arrest G1 also spill over into S-phase arrest, for example, DNA alkylating agents such as tamoxifen, prednisone, dacarbazine, mechlorethamine, cisplatin, methotrexate, 5-fluorouracil, and ara-C.
  • radiation therapy is meant the use of directed gamma rays or beta rays to induce sufficient damage to a cell so as to limit its ability to function normally or to destroy the cell altogether. It will be appreciated that there will be many ways known in the art to determine the dosage and duration of treatment. Typical treatments are given as a one-time administration and typical dosages range from 10 to 200 units (Grays) per day.
  • An “individual” or a “subject” for purposes of treatment refers to any animal classified as a mammal, including humans, domestic and farm animals, and zoo, sports, or pet animals, such as dogs, horses, cats, cows, etc.
  • the mammal is human.
  • a individual or subject may be a patient.
  • antibody herein is used in the broadest sense and specifically covers monoclonal antibodies (including full length monoclonal antibodies), polyclonal antibodies, multispecific antibodies (e.g., bispecific antibodies), and antibody fragments so long as they exhibit the desired biological activity.
  • an “isolated” antibody is one which has been identified and separated and/or recovered from a component of its natural environment. Contaminant components of its natural environment are materials which would interfere with research, diagnostic or therapeutic uses for the antibody, and may include enzymes, hormones, and other proteinaceous or nonproteinaceous solutes.
  • an antibody is purified (1) to greater than 95% by weight of antibody as determined by, for example, the Lowry method, and in some embodiments, to greater than 99% by weight; (2) to a degree sufficient to obtain at least 15 residues of N-terminal or internal amino acid sequence by use of, for example, a spinning cup sequenator, or (3) to homogeneity by SDS-PAGE under reducing or nonreducing conditions using, for example, Coomassie blue or silver stain.
  • An isolated antibody includes the antibody in situ within recombinant cells since at least one component of the antibody's natural environment will not be present. Ordinarily, however, an isolated antibody will be prepared by at least one purification step.
  • “Native antibodies” are usually heterotetrameric glycoproteins of about 150,000 daltons, composed of two identical light (L) chains and two identical heavy (H) chains. Each light chain is linked to a heavy chain by one covalent disulfide bond, while the number of disulfide linkages varies among the heavy chains of different immunoglobulin isotypes. Each heavy and light chain also has regularly spaced intrachain disulfide bridges. Each heavy chain has at one end a variable domain (V H ) followed by a number of constant domains.
  • V H variable domain
  • Each light chain has a variable domain at one end (V L ) and a constant domain at its other end; the constant domain of the light chain is aligned with the first constant domain of the heavy chain, and the light chain variable domain is aligned with the variable domain of the heavy chain. Particular amino acid residues are believed to form an interface between the light chain and heavy chain variable domains.
  • constant domain refers to the portion of an immunoglobulin molecule having a more conserved amino acid sequence relative to the other portion of the immunoglobulin, the variable domain, which contains the antigen binding site.
  • the constant domain contains the C H 1, C H 2 and C H 3 domains (collectively, CH) of the heavy chain and the CHL (or CL) domain of the light chain.
  • variable region refers to the amino-terminal domains of the heavy or light chain of the antibody.
  • variable domain of the heavy chain may be referred to as “V H .”
  • variable domain of the light chain may be referred to as “V L .” These domains are generally the most variable parts of an antibody and contain the antigen-binding sites.
  • variable refers to the fact that certain portions of the variable domains differ extensively in sequence among antibodies and are used in the binding and specificity of each particular antibody for its particular antigen. However, the variability is not evenly distributed throughout the variable domains of antibodies. It is concentrated in three segments called hypervariable regions (HVRs) both in the light-chain and the heavy-chain variable domains. The more highly conserved portions of variable domains are called the framework regions (FR).
  • HVRs hypervariable regions
  • FR framework regions
  • the variable domains of native heavy and light chains each comprise four FR regions, largely adopting a beta-sheet configuration, connected by three HVRs, which form loops connecting, and in some cases forming part of, the beta-sheet structure.
  • the HVRs in each chain are held together in close proximity by the FR regions and, with the HVRs from the other chain, contribute to the formation of the antigen-binding site of antibodies (see Kabat et al., Sequences of Proteins of Immunological Interest , Fifth Edition, National Institute of Health, Bethesda, Md. (1991)).
  • the constant domains are not involved directly in the binding of an antibody to an antigen, but exhibit various effector functions, such as participation of the antibody in antibody-dependent cellular toxicity.
  • the “light chains” of antibodies (immunoglobulins) from any mammalian species can be assigned to one of two clearly distinct types, called kappa (“ ⁇ ”) and lambda (“ ⁇ ”), based on the amino acid sequences of their constant domains.
  • IgG immunoglobulins defined by the chemical and antigenic characteristics of their constant regions.
  • antibodies can be assigned to different classes.
  • immunoglobulins There are five major classes of immunoglobulins: IgA, IgD, IgE, IgG, and IgM, and several of these may be further divided into subclasses (isotypes), e.g., IgG 1 , IgG 2 , IgG 3 , IgG 4 , IgA 1 , and IgA 2 .
  • the heavy chain constant domains that correspond to the different classes of immunoglobulins are called ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇ , ⁇ , and ⁇ , respectively.
  • An antibody may be part of a larger fusion molecule, formed by covalent or non-covalent association of the antibody with one or more other proteins or peptides.
  • full-length antibody “intact antibody,” and “whole antibody” are used herein interchangeably to refer to an antibody in its substantially intact form, not antibody fragments as defined below.
  • the terms particularly refer to an antibody with heavy chains that contain an Fc region.
  • naked antibody for the purposes herein is an antibody that is not conjugated to a cytotoxic moiety or radiolabel.
  • Antibody fragments comprise a portion of an intact antibody, preferably comprising the antigen-binding region thereof.
  • the antibody fragment described herein is an antigen-binding fragment.
  • Examples of antibody fragments include Fab, Fab′, F(ab′) 2 , and Fv fragments; diabodies; linear antibodies; single-chain antibody molecules; and multispecific antibodies formed from antibody fragments.
  • Papain digestion of antibodies produces two identical antigen-binding fragments, called “Fab” fragments, each with a single antigen-binding site, and a residual “Fc” fragment, whose name reflects its ability to crystallize readily. Pepsin treatment yields an F(ab′) 2 fragment that has two antigen-combining sites and is still capable of cross-linking antigen.
  • Fv is the minimum antibody fragment which contains a complete antigen-binding site.
  • a two-chain Fv species consists of a dimer of one heavy- and one light-chain variable domain in tight, non-covalent association.
  • scFv single-chain Fv
  • one heavy- and one light-chain variable domain can be covalently linked by a flexible peptide linker such that the light and heavy chains can associate in a “dimeric” structure analogous to that in a two-chain Fv species. It is in this configuration that the three HVRs of each variable domain interact to define an antigen-binding site on the surface of the VH-VL dimer.
  • the six HVRs confer antigen-binding specificity to the antibody.
  • the Fab fragment contains the heavy- and light-chain variable domains and also contains the constant domain of the light chain and the first constant domain (CH1) of the heavy chain.
  • Fab′ fragments differ from Fab fragments by the addition of a few residues at the carboxy terminus of the heavy chain CH1 domain including one or more cysteines from the antibody hinge region.
  • Fab′-SH is the designation herein for Fab′ in which the cysteine residue(s) of the constant domains bear a free thiol group.
  • F(ab′) 2 antibody fragments originally were produced as pairs of Fab′ fragments which have hinge cysteines between them. Other chemical couplings of antibody fragments are also known.
  • Single-chain Fv or “scFv” antibody fragments comprise the VH and VL domains of antibody, wherein these domains are present in a single polypeptide chain.
  • the scFv polypeptide further comprises a polypeptide linker between the VH and VL domains which enables the scFv to form the desired structure for antigen binding.
  • diabodies refers to antibody fragments with two antigen-binding sites, which fragments comprise a heavy-chain variable domain (VH) connected to a light-chain variable domain (VL) in the same polypeptide chain (VH-VL).
  • VH heavy-chain variable domain
  • VL light-chain variable domain
  • Diabodies may be bivalent or bispecific. Diabodies are described more fully in, for example, EP 404,097; WO 1993/01161; Hudson et al., Nat. Med. 9:129-134 (2003); and Hollinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 90: 6444-6448 (1993). Triabodies and tetrabodies are also described in Hudson et al., Nat. Med. 9:129-134 (2003).
  • a monoclonal antibody refers to an antibody obtained from a population of substantially homogeneous antibodies, e.g., the individual antibodies comprising the population are identical except for possible mutations, e.g., naturally occurring mutations, that may be present in minor amounts. Thus, the modifier “monoclonal” indicates the character of the antibody as not being a mixture of discrete antibodies.
  • such a monoclonal antibody typically includes an antibody comprising a polypeptide sequence that binds a target, wherein the target-binding polypeptide sequence was obtained by a process that includes the selection of a single target binding polypeptide sequence from a plurality of polypeptide sequences.
  • the selection process can be the selection of a unique clone from a plurality of clones, such as a pool of hybridoma clones, phage clones, or recombinant DNA clones.
  • a selected target binding sequence can be further altered, for example, to improve affinity for the target, to humanize the target binding sequence, to improve its production in cell culture, to reduce its immunogenicity in vivo, to create a multispecific antibody, etc., and that an antibody comprising the altered target binding sequence is also a monoclonal antibody of this invention.
  • each monoclonal antibody of a monoclonal antibody preparation is directed against a single determinant on an antigen.
  • monoclonal antibody preparations are advantageous in that they are typically uncontaminated by other immunoglobulins.
  • the modifier “monoclonal” indicates the character of the antibody as being obtained from a substantially homogeneous population of antibodies, and is not to be construed as requiring production of the antibody by any particular method.
  • the monoclonal antibodies to be used in accordance with the invention may be made by a variety of techniques, including, for example, the hybridoma method (e.g., Kohler and Milstein, Nature, 256:495-97 (1975); Hongo et al., Hybridoma, 14 (3): 253-260 (1995), Harlow et al., Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual , (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, 2nd ed.
  • the monoclonal antibodies herein specifically include “chimeric” antibodies in which a portion of the heavy and/or light chain is identical with or homologous to corresponding sequences in antibodies derived from a particular species or belonging to a particular antibody class or subclass, while the remainder of the chain(s) is identical with or homologous to corresponding sequences in antibodies derived from another species or belonging to another antibody class or subclass, as well as fragments of such antibodies, so long as they exhibit the desired biological activity (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,816,567; and Morrison et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 81:6851-6855 (1984)).
  • Chimeric antibodies include PRIMATTZED® antibodies wherein the antigen-binding region of the antibody is derived from an antibody produced by, e.g., immunizing macaque monkeys with the antigen of interest.
  • “Humanized” forms of non-human (e.g., murine) antibodies are chimeric antibodies that contain minimal sequence derived from non-human immunoglobulin.
  • a humanized antibody is a human immunoglobulin (recipient antibody) in which residues from a HVR of the recipient are replaced by residues from a HVR of a non-human species (donor antibody) such as mouse, rat, rabbit, or nonhuman primate having the desired specificity, affinity, and/or capacity.
  • donor antibody such as mouse, rat, rabbit, or nonhuman primate having the desired specificity, affinity, and/or capacity.
  • FR residues of the human immunoglobulin are replaced by corresponding non-human residues.
  • humanized antibodies may comprise residues that are not found in the recipient antibody or in the donor antibody. These modifications may be made to further refine antibody performance.
  • a humanized antibody will comprise substantially all of at least one, and typically two, variable domains, in which all or substantially all of the hypervariable loops correspond to those of a non-human immunoglobulin, and all or substantially all of the FRs are those of a human immunoglobulin sequence.
  • the humanized antibody optionally will also comprise at least a portion of an immunoglobulin constant region (Fc), typically that of a human immunoglobulin.
  • Fc immunoglobulin constant region
  • a “human antibody” is one which possesses an amino acid sequence which corresponds to that of an antibody produced by a human and/or has been made using any of the techniques for making human antibodies as disclosed herein. This definition of a human antibody specifically excludes a humanized antibody comprising non-human antigen-binding residues.
  • Human antibodies can be produced using various techniques known in the art, including phage-display libraries. Hoogenboom and Winter, J. Mol. Biol., 227:381 (1991); Marks et al., J. Mol. Biol., 222:581 (1991). Also available for the preparation of human monoclonal antibodies are methods described in Cole et al., Monoclonal Antibodies and Cancer Therapy, Alan R. Liss , p.
  • Human antibodies can be prepared by administering the antigen to a transgenic animal that has been modified to produce such antibodies in response to antigenic challenge, but whose endogenous loci have been disabled, e.g., immunized xenomice (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,075,181 and 6,150,584 regarding XENOMOUSETM technology). See also, for example, Li et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 103:3557-3562 (2006) regarding human antibodies generated via a human B-cell hybridoma technology.
  • a “species-dependent antibody” is one which has a stronger binding affinity for an antigen from a first mammalian species than it has for a homologue of that antigen from a second mammalian species.
  • the species-dependent antibody “binds specifically” to a human antigen (e.g., has a binding affinity (Kd) value of no more than about 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 7 M, preferably no more than about 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 8 M and preferably no more than about 1 ⁇ 10 ⁇ 9 M) but has a binding affinity for a homologue of the antigen from a second nonhuman mammalian species which is at least about 50 fold, or at least about 500 fold, or at least about 1000 fold, weaker than its binding affinity for the human antigen.
  • the species-dependent antibody can be any of the various types of antibodies as defined above, but preferably is a humanized or human antibody.
  • hypervariable region when used herein refers to the regions of an antibody variable domain which are hypervariable in sequence and/or form structurally defined loops.
  • antibodies comprise six HVRs; three in the VH (H1, H2, H3), and three in the VL (L1, L2, L3).
  • H3 and L3 display the most diversity of the six HVRs, and H3 in particular is believed to play a unique role in conferring fine specificity to antibodies.
  • HVR delineations are in use and are encompassed herein.
  • the Kabat Complementarity Determining Regions are based on sequence variability and are the most commonly used (Kabat et al., Sequences of Proteins of Immunological Interest, 5th Ed. Public Health Service, National Institutes of Health, Bethesda, Md. (1991)). Chothia refers instead to the location of the structural loops (Chothia and Lesk J. Mol. Biol. 196:901-917 (1987)).
  • the AbM HVRs represent a compromise between the Kabat HVRs and Chothia structural loops, and are used by Oxford Molecular's AbM antibody modeling software.
  • the “contact” HVRs are based on an analysis of the available complex crystal structures. The residues from each of these HVRs are noted below.
  • HVRs may comprise “extended HVRs” as follows: 24-36 or 24-34 (L1), 46-56 or 50-56 (L2) and 89-97 or 89-96 (L3) in the VL and 26-35 (H1), 50-65 or 49-65 (H2) and 93-102, 94-102, or 95-102 (H3) in the VH.
  • the variable domain residues are numbered according to Kabat et al., supra, for each of these definitions.
  • Framework or “FR” residues are those variable domain residues other than the HVR residues as herein defined.
  • variable domain residue numbering as in Kabat or “amino acid position numbering as in Kabat,” and variations thereof, refers to the numbering system used for heavy chain variable domains or light chain variable domains of the compilation of antibodies in Kabat et al., supra. Using this numbering system, the actual linear amino acid sequence may contain fewer or additional amino acids corresponding to a shortening of, or insertion into, a FR or HVR of the variable domain.
  • a heavy chain variable domain may include a single amino acid insert (residue 52a according to Kabat) after residue 52 of H2 and inserted residues (e.g. residues 82a, 82b, and 82c, etc. according to Kabat) after heavy chain FR residue 82.
  • the Kabat numbering of residues may be determined for a given antibody by alignment at regions of homology of the sequence of the antibody with a “standard” Kabat numbered sequence.
  • the Kabat numbering system is generally used when referring to a residue in the variable domain (approximately residues 1-107 of the light chain and residues 1-113 of the heavy chain) (e.g., Kabat et al., Sequences of Immunological Interest. 5th Ed. Public Health Service, National Institutes of Health, Bethesda, Md. (1991)).
  • the “EU numbering system” or “EU index” is generally used when referring to a residue in an immunoglobulin heavy chain constant region (e.g., the EU index reported in Kabat et al., supra).
  • the “EU index as in Kabat” refers to the residue numbering of the human IgG1 EU antibody.
  • linear antibodies refers to the antibodies described in Zapata et al. (1995 Protein Eng, 8(10):1057-1062). Briefly, these antibodies comprise a pair of tandem Fd segments (VH-CH1-VH-CH1) which, together with complementary light chain polypeptides, form a pair of antigen binding regions. Linear antibodies can be bispecific or monospecific.
  • the term “binds”, “specifically binds to” or is “specific for” refers to measurable and reproducible interactions such as binding between a target and an antibody, which is determinative of the presence of the target in the presence of a heterogeneous population of molecules including biological molecules.
  • an antibody that binds to or specifically binds to a target is an antibody that binds this target with greater affinity, avidity, more readily, and/or with greater duration than it binds to other targets.
  • the extent of binding of an antibody to an unrelated target is less than about 10% of the binding of the antibody to the target as measured, e.g., by a radioimmunoassay (RIA).
  • an antibody that specifically binds to a target has a dissociation constant (Kd) of ⁇ 1 ⁇ M, ⁇ 100 nM, ⁇ 10 nM, ⁇ 1 nM, or ⁇ 0.1 nM.
  • Kd dissociation constant
  • an antibody specifically binds to an epitope on a protein that is conserved among the protein from different species.
  • specific binding can include, but does not require exclusive binding.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist includes a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • PD-1 (programmed death 1) is also referred to in the art as “programmed cell death 1,” “PDCD1,” “CD279,” and “SLEB2.”
  • An exemplary human PD-1 is shown in UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot Accession No. Q15116.
  • PD-L1 (programmed death ligand 1) is also referred to in the art as “programmed cell death 1 ligand 1,” “PDCD1 LG1,” “CD274,” “B7-H,” and “PDL1.”
  • An exemplary human PD-L1 is shown in UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot Accession No. Q9NZQ7.1.
  • PD-L2 (programmed death ligand 2) is also referred to in the art as “programmed cell death 1 ligand 2,” “PDCDILG2,” “CD273,” “B7-DC,” “Btdc,” and “PDL2.”
  • An exemplary human PD-L2 is shown in UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot Accession No. Q9BQ51.
  • PD-1, PD-L1, and PD-L2 are human PD-1, PD-L1 and PD-L2.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-1 to its ligand binding partners.
  • the PD-1 ligand binding partners are PD-L1 and/or PD-L2.
  • a PD-L1 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to its binding partners.
  • PD-L1 binding partners are PD-1 and/or B7-1.
  • the PD-L2 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-L2 to its binding partners.
  • a PD-L2 binding partner is PD-1.
  • the antagonist may be an antibody, an antigen binding fragment thereof, an immunoadhesin, a fusion protein, or oligopeptide.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist is an anti-PD-1 antibody (e.g., a human antibody, a humanized antibody, or a chimeric antibody).
  • the anti-PD-1 antibody is selected from the group consisting of MDX 1106 (nivolumab), MK-3475 (pembrolizumab), CT-011 (pidilizumab), MEDI-0680 (AMP-514), PDR001, REGN2810, and BGB-108.
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist is an immunoadhesin (e.g., an immunoadhesin comprising an extracellular or PD-1 binding portion of PD-L1 or PD-L2 fused to a constant region (e.g., an Fc region of an immunoglobulin sequence).
  • the PD-1 binding antagonist is AMP-224.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is anti-PD-L1 antibody.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody is selected from the group consisting of MPDL3280A, YW243.55.S70, MDX-1105, MEDI4736 (durvalumab), and MSB0010718C (avelumab).
  • Antibody YW243.55.S70 is an anti-PD-L1 described in WO 2010/077634.
  • MDX-1105 also known as BMS-936559, is an anti-PD-L1 antibody described in WO02007/005874.
  • MED14736 is an anti-PD-L1 monoclonal antibody described in WO2011/066389 and US2013/034559.
  • MDX-1106 also known as MDX-1106-04, ONO-4538, BMS-936558, or nivolumab
  • MK-3475 also known as lambrolizumab, is an anti-PD-1 antibody described in WO2009/114335.
  • CT-011 also known as hBAT, hBAT-1 or pidilizumab
  • AMP-224 also known as B7-DCIg
  • B7-DCIg is a PD-L2-Fc fusion soluble receptor described in WO2010/027827 and WO2011/066342.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is an anti-PD-L1 antibody.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody is capable of inhibiting binding between PD-L1 and PD-1 and/or between PD-L1 and B7-1.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a monoclonal antibody.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody is an antibody fragment selected from the group consisting of Fab, Fab′-SH, Fv, scFv, and (Fab′) 2 fragments.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a humanized antibody. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a human antibody.
  • anti-PD-L1 antibodies useful for the methods of this invention and methods for making thereof are described in PCT patent application WO 2010/077634, WO 2007/005874. WO 2011/066389, and US 2013/034559, which are incorporated herein by reference.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibodies useful in this invention including compositions containing such antibodies, may be used in combination with a taxane to treat cancer.
  • the anti-PD-1 antibody is MDX-1106.
  • Alternative names for “MDX-1106” include MDX-1106-04, ONO-4538, BMS-936558, or nivolumab.
  • the anti-PD-1 antibody is nivolumab (CAS Registry Number: 946414-94-4).
  • an isolated anti-PD-1 antibody comprising a heavy chain variable region comprising the heavy chain variable region amino acid sequence from SEQ ID NO: 1 and/or a light chain variable region comprising the light chain variable region amino acid sequence from SEQ ID NO:2.
  • an isolated anti-PD-1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and/or a light chain sequence, wherein:
  • the heavy chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the heavy chain sequence:
  • the light chain sequences has at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the light chain sequence:
  • SEQ ID NO: 2 EIVLTQSPATLSLSPGERATLSCRASQSVSSYLAWYQQKPGQAPRLLIYD ASNRATGIPARFSGSGSGTDFTLTISSLEPEDFAVYYCQQSSNWPRTFGQ GTKVEIKRTVAAPSVFIFPPSDEQLKSGTASVVCLLNNFYPREAKVQWKV DNALQSGNSQESVTEQDSKDSTYSLSSTLTLSKADYEKHKVYACEVTHQG LSSPVTKSFNRGEC.
  • the antibody in the formulation comprises at least one tryptophan (e.g., at least two, at least three, or at least four) in the heavy and/or light chain sequence.
  • amino acid tryptophan is in the HVR regions, framework regions and/or constant regions of the antibody.
  • the antibody comprises two or three tryptophan residues in the HVR regions.
  • the antibody in the formulation is an anti-PD-L1 antibody.
  • PD-L1 programmeed death ligand 1
  • PDL1, B7-H1, B7-4, CD274, and B7-H is a transmembrane protein, and its interaction with PD-1 inhibits T-cell activation and cytokine production.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody described herein binds to human PD-L1.
  • Examples of anti-PD-L1 antibodies that can be used in the methods described herein are described in PCT patent application WO 2010/077634 A1 and U.S. Pat. No. 8,217,149, which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody is capable of inhibiting binding between PD-L1 and PD-1 and/or between PD-L1 and B7-1.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a monoclonal antibody.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody is an antibody fragment selected from the group consisting of Fab, Fab′-SH, Fv, scFv, and (Fab′) 2 fragments.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a humanized antibody. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a human antibody.
  • Anti-PD-L1 antibodies described in WO 2010/077634 A1 and U.S. Pat. No. 8,217,149 may be used in the methods described herein.
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region sequence of SEQ ID NO:3 and/or a light chain variable region sequence of SEQ ID NO:4.
  • an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain variable region and/or a light chain variable region sequence, wherein:
  • the heavy chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97% at least 98% A, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the heavy chain sequence:
  • the light chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the light chain sequence:
  • the anti-PD-L1 antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region comprising an HVR-H1, HVR-H2 and HVR-H3 sequence, wherein:
  • the HVR-H1 sequence is GFTFSX 1 SWIH;
  • the HVR-H2 sequence is AWIX 2 PYGGSX 3 YYADSVKG;
  • the HVR-H3 sequence is RHWPGGFDY;
  • the polypeptide further comprises variable region heavy chain framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs according to the formula: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4).
  • the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences.
  • the framework sequences are VH subgroup III consensus framework.
  • at least one of the framework sequences is the following:
  • HC-FR1 is EVQLVESGGGLVQPGGSLRLSCAAS (SEQ ID NQ: 9)
  • HC-FR2 is WVRQAPGKGLEWV (SEQ ID NO: 10)
  • HC-FR3 is RFTISADTSKNTAYLQMNSLRAEDTAVYYCAR (SEQ ID NO: 11)
  • HC-FR4 is WGQGTLVTVSA.
  • the heavy chain polypeptide is further combined with a variable region light chain comprising an HVR-L1, HVR-L2 and HVR-L3, wherein:
  • the light chain further comprises variable region light chain framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs according to the formula: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4).
  • the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences.
  • the framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework.
  • at least one of the framework sequence is the following:
  • LC-FR1 is DIQMTQSPSSLSASVGDRVTITC (SEQ ID NO: 16)
  • LC-FR2 is WYQQKPGKAPKLLIY (SEQ ID NO: 17)
  • LC-FR3 is GVPSRFSGSGSGTDFTLTISSLQPEDFATYYC (SEQ ID NO: 18)
  • LC-FR4 is FGQGTKVEIKR.
  • an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody or antigen binding fragment comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein:
  • the heavy chain comprises an HVR-H1, HVR-H2 and HVR-H3, wherein further:
  • the HVR-H1 sequence is GFTFSX 1 SWIH;
  • the HVR-H2 sequence is AWIX 2 PYGGSX 3 YYADSVKG (iii) (SEQ ID NO: 7) the HVR-H3 sequence is RHWPGGFDY, and
  • the light chain comprises an HVR-L1, HVR-L2 and HVR-L3, wherein further.
  • the heavy chain variable region comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4), and the light chain variable regions comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4).
  • the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences.
  • the heavy chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat subgroup I, II, or III sequence. In a still further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequence is a VH subgroup III consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the heavy chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 8, 9, 10 and 11. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat kappa I, II, II or IV subgroup sequence. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the light chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 15, 16, 17 and 18.
  • the antibody further comprises a human or murine constant region.
  • the human constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4.
  • the human constant region is IgG1.
  • the murine constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2A, IgG2B, IgG3.
  • the murine constant region if IgG2A.
  • the antibody has reduced or minimal effector function.
  • the minimal effector function results from an “effector-less Fc mutation” or aglycosylation.
  • the effector-less Fc mutation is an N297A or D265A/N297A substitution in the constant region.
  • an anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein:
  • sequence identity is 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or 100%.
  • the heavy chain variable region comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4), and the light chain variable regions comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4).
  • the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences.
  • the heavy chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat subgroup I, II, or III sequence.
  • the heavy chain framework sequence is a VH subgroup III consensus framework.
  • one or more of the heavy chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 8. 9, 10 and 11.
  • the light chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat kappa I, II, II or IV subgroup sequence.
  • the light chain framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework.
  • one or more of the light chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 15, 16, 17 and 18.
  • the antibody further comprises a human or murine constant region.
  • the human constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4.
  • the human constant region is IgG1.
  • the murine constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2A, IgG2B, IgG3.
  • the murine constant region if IgG2A.
  • the antibody has reduced or minimal effector function.
  • the minimal effector function results from an “effector-less Fc mutation” or aglycosylation.
  • the effector-less Fc mutation is an N297A or D265A/N297A substitution in the constant region.
  • an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein:
  • the heavy chain sequence has at least 85% sequence identity to the heavy chain sequence:
  • the sequence identity is 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or 100%.
  • the heavy chain variable region comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4)
  • the light chain variable regions comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4).
  • the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences.
  • the heavy chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat subgroup I, II, or III sequence.
  • the heavy chain framework sequence is a VH subgroup III consensus framework.
  • one or more of the heavy chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 8, 9, 10 and WGQGTLVTVSS (SEQ ID NO:27).
  • the light chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat kappa I, II, II or IV subgroup sequence. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the light chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 15, 16, 17 and 18.
  • the antibody further comprises a human or murine constant region.
  • the human constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4.
  • the human constant region is IgG1.
  • the murine constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2A. IgG2B, IgG3.
  • the murine constant region if IgG2A.
  • the antibody has reduced or minimal effector function.
  • the minimal effector function results from production in prokaryotic cells.
  • the minimal effector function results from an “effector-less Fc mutation” or aglycosylation.
  • the effector-less Fc mutation is an N297A or D265A/N297A substitution in the constant region.
  • the heavy chain variable region comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4), and the light chain variable regions comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4).
  • the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences.
  • the heavy chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat subgroup I, II, or III sequence. In a still further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequence is a VH subgroup III consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the heavy chain framework sequences is the following:
  • HC-FR1 (SEQ ID NO: 29) EVQLVESGGGLVQPGGSLRLSCAASGFTFS HC-FR2 (SEQ ID NO: 30) WVRQAPGKGLEWVA HC-FR3 (SEQ ID NO: 10) RFTISADTSKNTAYLQMNSLRAEDTAVYYCAR HC-FR4 (SEQ ID NO: 27) WGQGTLVTVSS.
  • the light chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat kappa I, II, II or IV subgroup sequence. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the light chain framework sequences is the following:
  • LC-FR1 (SEQ ID NO: 15) DIQMTQSPSSLSASVGDRVTITC LC-FR2 (SEQ ID NO: 16) WYQQKPGKAPKLLIY LC-FR3 (SEQ ID NO: 17) GVPSRFSGSGSGTDFTLTISSLQPEDFATYYC LC-FR4 (SEQ ID NO: 28) FGQGTKVEIK.
  • the antibody further comprises a human or murine constant region.
  • the human constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4.
  • the human constant region is IgG1.
  • the murine constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2A, IgG2B, IgG3.
  • the murine constant region if IgG2A.
  • the antibody has reduced or minimal effector function.
  • the minimal effector function results from an “effector-less Fc mutation” or aglycosylation.
  • the effector-less Fc mutation is an N297A or D265A/N297A substitution in the constant region.
  • an anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein:
  • the heavy chain further comprises an HVR-H1, HVR-H2 and an HVR-H3 sequence having at least 85% sequence identity to GFTFSDSWIH (SEQ ID NO:19), AWISPYGGSTYYADSVKG (SEQ ID NO:20) and RHWPGGFDY (SEQ ID NO:21), respectively, and/or
  • the light chain further comprises an HVR-L1, HVR-L2 and an HVR-L3 sequence having at least 85% sequence identity to RASQDVSTAVA (SEQ ID NO:22), SASFLYS (SEQ ID NO:23) and QQYLYHPAT (SEQ ID NO:24), respectively.
  • sequence identity is 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or 100%.
  • the heavy chain variable region comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4), and the light chain variable regions comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4).
  • the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences.
  • the heavy chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat subgroup I, II, or III sequence.
  • the heavy chain framework sequence is a VH subgroup III consensus framework.
  • one or more of the heavy chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 8, 9, 10 and WGQGTLVTVSSASTK (SEQ ID NO:31).
  • the light chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat kappa I, II, II or IV subgroup sequence. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the light chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 15, 16, 17 and 18. In a still further specific aspect, the antibody further comprises a human or murine constant region. In a still further aspect, the human constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4. In a still further specific aspect, the human constant region is IgG1.
  • the murine constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2A, IgG2B, IgG3. In a still further aspect, the murine constant region if IgG2A. In a still further specific aspect, the antibody has reduced or minimal effector function. In a still further specific aspect the minimal effector function results from an “effector-less Fc mutation” or aglycosylation. In still a further embodiment, the effector-less Fc mutation is an N297A or D265A/N297A substitution in the constant region.
  • an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence wherein:
  • the heavy chain sequence has at least 85% sequence identity to the heavy chain sequence:
  • the light chain sequences has at least 85% sequence identity to the light chain sequence
  • an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein the light chain variable region sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4.
  • an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein the heavy chain variable region sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:26.
  • an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein the light chain variable region sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4 and the heavy chain variable region sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:26.
  • an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain sequence, wherein:
  • the heavy chain sequence has at least 85% sequence identity to the heavy chain sequence:
  • an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain sequence, wherein the light chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at east 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, or at least 99% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:33.
  • an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain sequence, wherein the heavy chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, or at least 99% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:32.
  • an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain sequence, wherein the light chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, or at least 99% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:33 and the heavy chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, or at least 99% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:32.
  • the isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody is aglycosylated.
  • Glycosylation of antibodies is typically either N-linked or O-linked.
  • N-linked refers to the attachment of the carbohydrate moiety to the side chain of an asparagine residue.
  • the tripeptide sequences asparagine-X-serine and asparagine-X-threonine, where X is any amino acid except proline, are the recognition sequences for enzymatic attachment of the carbohydrate moiety to the asparagine side chain.
  • X is any amino acid except proline
  • O-linked glycosylation refers to the attachment of one of the sugars N-aceylgalactosamine, galactose, or xylose to a hydroxyamino acid, most commonly serine or threonine, although 5-hydroxyproline or 5-hydroxylysine may also be used. Removal of glycosylation sites form an antibody is conveniently accomplished by altering the amino acid sequence such that one of the above-described tripeptide sequences (for N-linked glycosylation sites) is removed. The alteration may be made by substitution of an asparagine, serine or threonine residue within the glycosylation site another amino acid residue (e.g., glycine, alanine or a conservative substitution).
  • the isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody can bind to a human PD-L1, for example a human PD-L1 as shown in UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot Accession No. Q9NZQ7.1, or a variant thereof.
  • nucleic acid encoding any of the antibodies described herein.
  • nucleic acid further comprises a vector suitable for expression of the nucleic acid encoding any of the previously described anti-PD-L1 antibodies.
  • the vector is in a host cell suitable for expression of the nucleic acid.
  • the host cell is a eukaryotic cell or a prokaryotic cell.
  • the eukaryotic cell is a mammalian cell, such as Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) cell.
  • the antibody or antigen binding fragment thereof may be made using methods known in the art, for example, by a process comprising culturing a host cell containing nucleic acid encoding any of the previously described anti-PD-L1 antibodies or antigen-binding fragment in a form suitable for expression, under conditions suitable to produce such antibody or fragment, and recovering the antibody or fragment.
  • the antibodies described herein are prepared using techniques available in the art for generating antibodies, exemplary methods of which are described in more detail in the following sections.
  • the antibody is directed against an antigen of interest (e.g., PD-L1 (such as a human PD-L1), PD1 (such as human PD-L1). PD-L2 (such as human PD-L2), etc.).
  • an antigen of interest e.g., PD-L1 (such as a human PD-L1), PD1 (such as human PD-L1).
  • PD-L2 such as human PD-L2
  • the antigen is a biologically important polypeptide and administration of the antibody to a mammal suffering from a disorder can result in a therapeutic benefit in that mammal.
  • an antibody provided herein has a dissociation constant (Kd) of ⁇ 1 ⁇ M, ⁇ 150 nM, ⁇ 100 nM, ⁇ 50 nM, ⁇ 10 nM, ⁇ 1 nM, ⁇ 0.1 nM, ⁇ 0.01 nM, or ⁇ 0.001 nM (e.g. 10 ⁇ 5 M or less, e.g. from 10 ⁇ 8 M to 10 ⁇ 13 M, e.g., from 10 ⁇ 9 M to 10 ⁇ 13 M).
  • Kd dissociation constant
  • Kd is measured by a radiolabeled antigen binding assay (RIA) performed with the Fab version of an antibody of interest and its antigen as described by the following assay.
  • Solution binding affinity of Fabs for antigen is measured by equilibrating Fab with a minimal concentration of ( 125 I)-labeled antigen in the presence of a titration series of unlabeled antigen, then capturing bound antigen with an anti-Fab antibody-coated plate (see, e.g., Chen et al., J. Mol. Biol. 293:865-881(1999)).
  • MICROTITER® multi-well plates (Thermo Scientific) are coated overnight with 5 ⁇ g/ml of a capturing anti-Fab antibody (Cappel Labs) in 50 mM sodium carbonate (pH 9.6), and subsequently blocked with 2% (w/v) bovine serum albumin in PBS for two to five hours at room temperature (approximately 23° C.).
  • a non-adsorbent plate (Nunc #269620)
  • 100 ⁇ M or 26 ⁇ M [ 125 I]-antigen are mixed with serial dilutions of a Fab of interest.
  • the Fab of interest is then incubated overnight; however, the incubation may continue for a longer period (e.g., about 65 hours) to ensure that equilibrium is reached. Thereafter, the mixtures are transferred to the capture plate for incubation at room temperature (e.g., for one hour). The solution is then removed and the plate washed eight times with 0.1% polysorbate 20 (TWEEN-20®) in PBS. When the plates have dried, 150 ⁇ l/well of scintillant (MICROSCINT-20TM; Packard) is added, and the plates are counted on a TOPCOUNTTM gamma counter (Packard) for ten minutes. Concentrations of each Fab that give less than or equal to 20% of maximal binding are chosen for use in competitive binding assays.
  • Kd is measured using surface plasmon resonance assays using a BIACORE-2000 or a BIACORE®-3000 (BIAcore, Inc., Piscataway, N.J.) at 25° C. with immobilized antigen CM5 chips at approximately 10 response units (RU).
  • CM5 carboxymethylated dextran biosensor chips
  • EDC N-ethyl-N′-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-carbodiimide hydrochloride
  • NHS N-hydroxysuccinimide
  • Antigen is diluted with 10 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.8, to 5 ⁇ g/ml (approximately 0.2 ⁇ M) before injection at a flow rate of 5 ⁇ l/minute to achieve approximately 10 response units (RU) of coupled protein. Following the injection of antigen, 1 M ethanolamine is injected to block unreacted groups. For kinetics measurements, two-fold serial dilutions of Fab (0.78 nM to 500 nM) are injected in PBS with 0.05% polysorbate 20 (TWEEN-20TM) surfactant (PBST) at 25° C. at a flow rate of approximately 25 ⁇ l/min.
  • TWEEN-20TM polysorbate 20
  • association rates (k on ) and dissociation rates (k off ) are calculated using a simple one-to-one Langmuir binding model (BIACORE® Evaluation Software version 3.2) by simultaneously fitting the association and dissociation sensorgrams.
  • the equilibrium dissociation constant (Kd) is calculated as the ratio k on /k off See, e.g., Chen et al., J. Mol. Biol. 293:865-881 (1999).
  • Soluble antigens or fragments thereof, optionally conjugated to other molecules, can be used as immunogens for generating antibodies.
  • immunogens for transmembrane molecules, such as receptors, fragments of these (e.g., the extracellular domain of a receptor) can be used as the immunogen.
  • transmembrane molecules such as receptors
  • fragments of these e.g., the extracellular domain of a receptor
  • cells expressing the transmembrane molecule can be used as the immunogen.
  • Such cells can be derived from a natural source (e.g., cancer cell lines) or may be cells which have been transformed by recombinant techniques to express the transmembrane molecule.
  • Other antigens and forms thereof useful for preparing antibodies will be apparent to those in the art.
  • Polyclonal antibodies are preferably raised in animals by multiple subcutaneous (sc) or intraperitoneal (i.p.) injections of the relevant antigen and an adjuvant. It may be useful to conjugate the relevant antigen to a protein that is immunogenic in the species to be immunized, e.g., keyhole limpet hemocyanin, serum albumin, bovine thyroglobulin, or soybean trypsin inhibitor using a bifunctional or derivatizing agent, for example, maleimidobenzoyl sulfosuccinimide ester (conjugation through cysteine residues), N-hydroxysuccinimide (through lysine residues), glutaraidehyde, succinic anhydride, SOCl 2 , or R 1 N ⁇ C ⁇ NR, where R and R 1 are different alkyl groups.
  • a protein that is immunogenic in the species to be immunized e.g., keyhole limpet hemocyanin, serum albumin, bovine th
  • Animals are immunized against the antigen, immunogenic conjugates, or derivatives by combining, e.g., 100 ⁇ g or 5 ⁇ g of the protein or conjugate (for rabbits or mice, respectively) with 3 volumes of Freund's complete adjuvant and injecting the solution intradermally at multiple sites.
  • the animals are boosted with 1/5 to 1/10 the original amount of peptide or conjugate in Freund's complete adjuvant by subcutaneous injection at multiple sites.
  • Seven to 14 days later the animals are bled and the serum is assayed for antibody titer. Animals are boosted until the titer plateaus.
  • the animal is boosted with the conjugate of the same antigen, but conjugated to a different protein and/or through a different cross-linking reagent.
  • Conjugates also can be made in recombinant cell culture as protein fusions.
  • aggregating agents such as alum are suitably used to enhance the immune response.
  • Monoclonal antibodies of the invention can be made using the hybridoma method first described by Kohler et al., Nature, 256:495 (1975), and further described, for example, in Hongo et al., Hybridoma, 14 (3): 253-260 (1995), Harlow et al., Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual . (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, 2nd ed. 1988); Hammerling et al., in: Monoclonal Antibodies and T - Cell Hybridomas 563-681 (Elsevier. N.Y., 1981), and Ni, Xiandai Mianyixue, 26(4):265-268 (2006) regarding human-human hybridomas. Additional methods include those described, for example, in U.S. Pat.
  • Antibodies are raised in animals by multiple subcutaneous (SC) or intraperitoneal (IP) injections of a polypeptide of the invention or a fragment thereof, and an adjuvant, such as monophosphoryl lipid A (MPL)/trehalose dicrynomycolate (TDM) (Ribi Immunochem. Research, Inc., Hamilton, Mont.).
  • a polypeptide of the invention e.g., antigen
  • a polypeptide of the invention e.g., antigen
  • a polypeptide of the invention e.g., antigen
  • Serum from immunized animals is assayed for anti-antigen antibodies, and booster immunizations are optionally administered.
  • Lymphocytes from animals producing anti-antigen antibodies are isolated. Alternatively, lymphocytes may be immunized in vitro.
  • Lymphocytes are then fused with myeloma cells using a suitable fusing agent, such as polyethylene glycol, to form a hybridoma cell.
  • a suitable fusing agent such as polyethylene glycol
  • Myeloma cells may be used that fuse efficiently, support stable high-level production of antibody by the selected antibody-producing cells, and are sensitive to a medium such as HAT medium.
  • Exemplary myeloma cells include, but are not limited to, murine myeloma lines, such as those derived from MOPC-21 and MPC-11 mouse tumors available from the Salk Institute Cell Distribution Center, San Diego, Calif.
  • the hybridoma cells thus prepared are seeded and grown in a suitable culture medium, e.g., a medium that contains one or more substances that inhibit the growth or survival of the unfused, parental myeloma cells.
  • a suitable culture medium e.g., a medium that contains one or more substances that inhibit the growth or survival of the unfused, parental myeloma cells.
  • the culture medium for the hybridomas typically will include hypoxanthine, aminopterin, and thymidine (HAT medium), which substances prevent the growth of HGPRT-deficient cells.
  • serum-free hybridoma cell culture methods are used to reduce use of animal-derived serum such as fetal bovine serum, as described, for example, in Even et al., Trends in Biotechnology, 24(3), 105-108 (2006).
  • Oligopeptides as tools for improving productivity of hybridoma cell cultures are described in Franek, Trends in Monoclonal Antibody Research, 111-122 (2005). Specifically, standard culture media are enriched with certain amino acids (alanine, serine, asparagine, proline), or with protein hydrolyzate fractions, and apoptosis may be significantly suppressed by synthetic oligopeptides, constituted of three to six amino acid residues. The peptides are present at millimolar or higher concentrations.
  • Culture medium in which hybridoma cells are growing may be assayed for production of monoclonal antibodies that bind to an antibody of the invention.
  • the binding specificity of monoclonal antibodies produced by hybridoma cells may be determined by immunoprecipitation or by an in vitro binding assay, such as radioimmunoassay (RIA) or enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay (ELISA).
  • RIA radioimmunoassay
  • ELISA enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay
  • the binding affinity of the monoclonal antibody can be determined, for example, by Scatchard analysis. See, e.g., Munson et al., Anal. Biochem., 107:220 (1980).
  • hybridoma cells After hybridoma cells are identified that produce antibodies of the desired specificity, affinity, and/or activity, the clones may be subcloned by limiting dilution procedures and grown by standard methods. See, e.g., Goding, supra. Suitable culture media for this purpose include, for example, D-MEM or RPMI-1640 medium.
  • hybridoma cells may be grown in vivo as ascites tumors in an animal. Monoclonal antibodies secreted by the subclones are suitably separated from the culture medium, ascites fluid, or serum by conventional immunoglobulin purification procedures such as, for example, protein A-Sepharose, hydroxylapatite chromatography, gel electrophoresis, dialysis, or affinity chromatography.
  • the method includes using minimal salts, such as lyotropic salts, in the binding process and preferably also using small amounts of organic solvents in the elution process.
  • Antibodies of the invention may be isolated by screening combinatorial libraries for antibodies with the desired activity or activities. For example, a variety of methods are known in the art for generating phage display libraries and screening such libraries for antibodies possessing the desired binding characteristics. Additional methods are reviewed, e.g., in Hoogenboom et al., in Methods in Molecular Biology 178:1-37 (O'Brien et al., ed., Human Press, Totowa, N.J., 2001) and further described, e.g., in McCafferty et al., Nature 348:552-554; Clackson et al., Nature 352: 624-628 (1991); Marks et al., J. Mol. Biol.
  • repertoires of VH and VL genes are separately cloned by polymerase chain reaction (PCR) and recombined randomly in phage libraries, which can then be screened for antigen-binding phage as described in Winter et al., Ann. Rev. Immunol., 12: 433-455 (1994).
  • Phage typically display antibody fragments, either as single-chain Fv (scFv) fragments or as Fab fragments.
  • scFv single-chain Fv
  • Libraries from immunized sources provide high-affinity antibodies to the immunogen without the requirement of constructing hybridomas.
  • naive repertoire can be cloned (e.g., from human) to provide a single source of antibodies to a wide range of non-self and also self-antigens without any immunization as described by Griffiths et al., EMBO J, 12: 725-734 (1993).
  • naive libraries can also be made synthetically by cloning unrearranged V-gene segments from stem cells, and using PCR primers containing random sequence to encode the highly variable CDR3 regions and to accomplish rearrangement in vitro, as described by Hoogenboom and Winter, J. Mol. Biol., 227: 381-388 (1992).
  • Patent publications describing human antibody phage libraries include, for example: U.S. Pat. No. 5,750,373, and US Patent Publication Nos. 2005/0079574, 2005/0119455, 2005/0266000, 2007/0117126, 2007/0160598, 2007/0237764, 2007/0292936, and 2009/0002360.
  • Antibodies or antibody fragments isolated from human antibody libraries are considered human antibodies or human antibody fragments herein.
  • an antibody provided herein is a chimeric antibody.
  • Certain chimeric antibodies are described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. No. 4,816,567; and Morrison et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 81:6851-6855 (1984).
  • a chimeric antibody comprises a non-human variable region (e.g., a variable region derived from a mouse, rat, hamster, rabbit, or non-human primate, such as a monkey) and a human constant region.
  • a chimeric antibody is a “class switched” antibody in which the class or subclass has been changed from that of the parent antibody. Chimeric antibodies include antigen-binding fragments thereof.
  • a chimeric antibody is a humanized antibody.
  • a non-human antibody is humanized to reduce immunogenicity to humans, while retaining the specificity and affinity of the parental non-human antibody.
  • a humanized antibody comprises one or more variable domains in which HVRs, e.g., CDRs, (or portions thereof) are derived from a non-human antibody, and FRs (or portions thereof) are derived from human antibody sequences.
  • a humanized antibody optionally will also comprise at least a portion of a human constant region.
  • some FR residues in a humanized antibody are substituted with corresponding residues from a non-human antibody (e.g., the antibody from which the HVR residues are derived), for example, to restore or improve antibody specificity or affinity.
  • Human framework regions that may be used for humanization include but are not limited to: framework regions selected using the “best-fit” method (see, e.g., Sims et al. J. Immunol. 151:2296 (1993)); framework regions derived from the consensus sequence of human antibodies of a particular subgroup of light or heavy chain variable regions (see, e.g., Carter et al. Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 89:4285 (1992); and Presta et al. J. Immunol., 151:2623 (1993)); human mature (somatically mutated) framework regions or human germline framework regions (see, e.g., Almagro and Fransson, Front. Biosci.
  • an antibody provided herein is a human antibody.
  • Human antibodies can be produced using various techniques known in the art. Human antibodies are described generally in van Dijk and van de Winkel, Curr. Opin. Pharmacol. 5: 368-74 (2001) and Lonberg, Curr. Opin. Immunol. 20:450-459 (2008).
  • Human antibodies may be prepared by administering an immunogen to a transgenic animal that has been modified to produce intact human antibodies or intact antibodies with human variable regions in response to antigenic challenge.
  • Such animals typically contain all or a portion of the human immunoglobulin loci, which replace the endogenous immunoglobulin loci, or which are present extrachromosomally or integrated randomly into the animal's chromosomes.
  • the endogenous immunoglobulin loci have generally been inactivated.
  • Human antibodies can also be made by hybridoma-based methods. Human myeloma and mouse-human heteromyeloma cell lines for the production of human monoclonal antibodies have been described. (See, e.g., Kozbor J. Immunol., 133: 3001 (1984); Brodeur et al., Monoclonal Antibody Production Techniques and Applications , pp. 51-63 (Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, 1987); and Boemer et al., J. Immunol., 147: 86 (1991).) Human antibodies generated via human B-cell hybridoma technology are also described in Li et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 103:3557-3562 (2006).
  • Additional methods include those described, for example, in U.S. Pat. No. 7,189,826 (describing production of monoclonal human IgM antibodies from hybridoma cell lines) and Ni, Xiandai Mianyixue, 26(4):265-268 (2006) (describing human-human hybridomas).
  • Human hybridoma technology Trioma technology
  • Vollmers and Brandlein, Histology and Histopathology, 20(3):927-937 (2005) and Vollmers and Brandlein, Methods and Findings in Experimental and Clinical Pharmacology, 27(3):185-91 (2005).
  • Human antibodies may also be generated by isolating Fv clone variable domain sequences selected from human-derived phage display libraries. Such variable domain sequences may then be combined with a desired human constant domain. Techniques for selecting human antibodies from antibody libraries are described below.
  • Antibody fragments may be generated by traditional means, such as enzymatic digestion, or by recombinant techniques. In certain circumstances there are advantages of using antibody fragments, rather than whole antibodies. The smaller size of the fragments allows for rapid clearance, and may lead to improved access to solid tumors. For a review of certain antibody fragments, see Hudson et al. (2003) Nat. Med. 9:129-134.
  • F(ab′) 2 fragments can be isolated directly from recombinant host cell culture.
  • Fab and F(ab′) 2 fragment with increased in vivo half-life comprising salvage receptor binding epitope residues are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,869,046.
  • Other techniques for the production of antibody fragments will be apparent to the skilled practitioner.
  • an antibody is a single chain Fv fragment (scFv). See, for example, WO 93/16185; U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,571,894; and 5,587,458.
  • Fv and scFv are the only species with intact combining sites that are devoid of constant regions; thus, they may be suitable for reduced nonspecific binding during in vivo use, scFv fusion proteins may be constructed to yield fusion of an effector protein at either the amino or the carboxy terminus of an scFv. See Antibody Engineering , ed. Borrebaeck, supra.
  • the antibody fragment may also be a “linear antibody,” e.g., as described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,641,870, for example. Such linear antibodies may be monospecific or bispecific.
  • Multispecific antibodies have binding specificities for at least two different epitopes, where the epitopes are usually from different antigens. While such molecules normally will only bind two different epitopes (i.e. bispecific antibodies, BsAbs), antibodies with additional specificities such as trispecific antibodies are encompassed by this expression when used herein.
  • Bispecific antibodies can be prepared as full-length antibodies or antibody fragments (e.g. F(ab′) 2 bispecific antibodies).
  • bispecific antibodies are known in the art. Traditional production of full length bispecific antibodies is based on the coexpression of two immunoglobulin heavy chain-light chain pairs, where the two chains have different specificities (see, e.g., Millstein et al., Nature, 305:537-539 (1983)). Because of the random assortment of immunoglobulin heavy and light chains, these hybridomas (quadromas) produce a potential mixture of 10 different antibody molecules, of which only one has the correct bispecific structure. Purification of the correct molecule, which is usually done by affinity chromatography steps, is rather cumbersome, and the product yields are low. Similar procedures are disclosed in WO 93/08829, and in Traunecker et al., EMBO J., 10:3655-3659 (1991).
  • bispecific antibodies One approach known in the art for making bispecific antibodies is the “knobs-into-holes” or “protuberance-into-cavity” approach (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,731,168).
  • two immunoglobulin polypeptides e.g., heavy chain polypeptides
  • An interface of one immunoglobulin polypeptide interacts with a corresponding interface on the other immunoglobulin polypeptide, thereby allowing the two immunoglobulin polypeptides to associate.
  • interfaces may be engineered such that a “knob” or “protuberance” (these terms may be used interchangeably herein) located in the interface of one immunoglobulin polypeptide corresponds with a “hole” or “cavity” (these terms may be used interchangeably herein) located in the interface of the other immunoglobulin polypeptide.
  • the hole is of identical or similar size to the knob and suitably positioned such that when the two interfaces interact, the knob of one interface is positionable in the corresponding hole of the other interface. Without wishing to be bound to theory, this is thought to stabilize the heteromultimer and favor formation of the heteromultimer over other species, for example homomultimers.
  • this approach may be used to promote the heteromultimerization of two different immunoglobulin polypeptides, creating a bispecific antibody comprising two immunoglobulin polypeptides with binding specificities for different epitopes.
  • a knob may be constructed by replacing a small amino acid side chain with a larger side chain.
  • a hole may be constructed by replacing a large amino acid side chain with a smaller side chain.
  • Knobs or holes may exist in the original interface, or they may be introduced synthetically.
  • knobs or holes may be introduced synthetically by altering the nucleic acid sequence encoding the interface to replace at least one “original” amino acid residue with at least one “import” amino acid residue. Methods for altering nucleic acid sequences may include standard molecular biology techniques well known in the art. The side chain volumes of various amino acid residues are shown in the following table.
  • original residues have a small side chain volume (e.g., alanine, asparagine, aspartic acid, glycine, serine, threonine, or valine), and import residues for forming a knob are naturally occurring amino acids and may include arginine, phenylalanine, tyrosine, and tryptophan.
  • original residues have a large side chain volume (e.g., arginine, phenylalanine, tyrosine, and tryptophan), and import residues for forming a hole are naturally occurring amino acids and may include alanine, serine, threonine, and valine.
  • original residues for forming a knob or hole are identified based on the three-dimensional structure of the heteromultimer.
  • Techniques known in the art for obtaining a three-dimensional structure may include X-ray crystallography and NMR.
  • the interface is the CH3 domain of an immunoglobulin constant domain.
  • the CH3/CH3 interface of human IgG 1 involves sixteen residues on each domain located on four anti-parallel ⁇ -strands.
  • mutated residues are preferably located on the two central anti-parallel ⁇ -strands to minimize the risk that knobs can be accommodated by the surrounding solvent, rather than the compensatory holes in the partner CH3 domain.
  • the mutations forming corresponding knobs and holes in two immunoglobulin polypeptides correspond to one or more pairs provided in the following table.
  • an immunoglobulin polypeptide comprises a CH3 domain comprising one or more amino acid substitutions listed in Table 2 above.
  • a bispecific antibody comprises a first immunoglobulin polypeptide comprising a CH3 domain comprising one or more amino acid substitutions listed in the left column of Table 2, and a second immunoglobulin polypeptide comprising a CH3 domain comprising one or more corresponding amino acid substitutions listed in the right column of Table 2.
  • polynucleotides encoding modified immunoglobulin polypeptides with one or more corresponding knob- or hole-forming mutations may be expressed and purified using standard recombinant techniques and cell systems known in the art. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,731,168; 5,807,706; 5,821,333; 7,642,228; 7,695,936; 8,216,805; U.S. Pub. No. 2013/0089553; and Spiess et al., Nature Biotechnology 31: 753-758, 2013.
  • Modified immunoglobulin polypeptides may be produced using prokaryotic host cells, such as E.
  • knob-and-hole-bearing immunoglobulin polypeptides may be expressed in host cells in co-culture and purified together as a heteromultimer, or they may be expressed in single cultures, separately purified, and assembled in vitro.
  • two strains of bacterial host cells one expressing an immunoglobulin polypeptide with a knob, and the other expressing an immunoglobulin polypeptide with a hole
  • the two strains may be mixed in a specific ratio, e.g., so as to achieve equal expression levels in culture.
  • the two strains may be mixed in a 50:50, 60:40, or 70:30 ratio.
  • the cells may be lysed together, and protein may be extracted.
  • Standard techniques known in the art that allow for measuring the abundance of homo-multimeric vs. hetero-multimeric species may include size exclusion chromatography.
  • each modified immunoglobulin polypeptide is expressed separately using standard recombinant techniques, and they may be assembled together in vitro. Assembly may be achieved, for example, by purifying each modified immunoglobulin polypeptide, mixing and incubating them together in equal mass, reducing disulfides (e.g., by treating with dithiothreitol), concentrating, and reoxidizing the polypeptides.
  • bispecific antibodies may be purified using standard techniques including cation-exchange chromatography and measured using standard techniques including size exclusion chromatography. For a more detailed description of these methods, see Speiss et al., Nat. Biotechnol. 31:753-8, 2013.
  • modified immunoglobulin polypeptides may be expressed separately in CHO cells and assembled in vitro using the methods described above.
  • antibody variable domains with the desired binding specificities are fused to immunoglobulin constant domain sequences.
  • the fusion preferably is with an immunoglobulin heavy chain constant domain, comprising at least part of the hinge, CH2, and CH3 regions. It is typical to have the first heavy-chain constant region (CH1) containing the site necessary for light chain binding, present in at least one of the fusions.
  • DNAs encoding the immunoglobulin heavy chain fusions and, if desired, the immunoglobulin light chain are inserted into separate expression vectors, and are co-transfected into a suitable host organism.
  • the bispecific antibodies are composed of a hybrid immunoglobulin heavy chain with a first binding specificity in one arm, and a hybrid immunoglobulin heavy chain-light chain pair (providing a second binding specificity) in the other arm. It was found that this asymmetric structure facilitates the separation of the desired bispecific compound from unwanted immunoglobulin chain combinations, as the presence of an immunoglobulin light chain in only one half of the bispecific molecule provides for a facile way of separation. This approach is disclosed in WO 94/04690. For further details of generating bispecific antibodies see, for example, Suresh et al., Methods in Enzymology, 121:210 (1986).
  • the interface between a pair of antibody molecules can be engineered to maximize the percentage of heterodimers which are recovered from recombinant cell culture.
  • One interface comprises at least a part of the C H 3 domain of an antibody constant domain.
  • one or more small amino acid side chains from the interface of the first antibody molecule are replaced with larger side chains (e.g. tyrosine or tryptophan).
  • Compensatory “cavities” of identical or similar size to the large side chain(s) are created on the interface of the second antibody molecule by replacing large amino acid side chains with smaller ones (e.g. alanine or threonine). This provides a mechanism for increasing the yield of the heterodimer over other unwanted end-products such as homodimers.
  • Bispecific antibodies include cross-linked or “heteroconjugate” antibodies.
  • one of the antibodies in the heteroconjugate can be coupled to avidin, the other to biotin.
  • Such antibodies have, for example, been proposed to target immune system cells to unwanted cells (U.S. Pat. No. 4,676,980), and for treatment of HIV infection (WO 91/00360, WO 92/200373, and EP 03089).
  • Heteroconjugate antibodies may be made using any convenient cross-linking methods. Suitable cross-linking agents are well known in the art, and are disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 4,676,980, along with a number of cross-linking techniques.
  • bispecific antibodies can be prepared using chemical linkage.
  • Brennan et al., Science, 229: 81 (1985) describe a procedure wherein intact antibodies are proteolytically cleaved to generate F(ab′) 2 fragments. These fragments are reduced in the presence of the dithiol complexing agent sodium arsenite to stabilize vicinal dithiols and prevent intermolecular disulfide formation.
  • the Fab′ fragments generated are then converted to thionitrobenzoate (TNB) derivatives.
  • One of the Fab′-TNB derivatives is then reconverted to the Fab′-thiol by reduction with mercaptoethylamine and is mixed with an equimolar amount of the other Fab′-TNB derivative to form the bispecific antibody.
  • the bispecific antibodies produced can be used as agents for the selective immobilization of enzymes.
  • bispecific antibodies have been produced using leucine zippers.
  • the leucine zipper peptides from the Fos and Jun proteins were linked to the Fab′ portions of two different antibodies by gene fusion.
  • the antibody homodimers were reduced at the hinge region to form monomers and then re-oxidized to form the antibody heterodimers. This method can also be utilized for the production of antibody homodimers.
  • the fragments comprise a heavy-chain variable domain (VH) connected to a light-chain variable domain (V L ) by a linker which is too short to allow pairing between the two domains on the same chain. Accordingly, the V H and V L domains of one fragment are forced to pair with the complementary V L and VH domains of another fragment, thereby forming two antigen-binding sites.
  • VH heavy-chain variable domain
  • V L light-chain variable domain
  • Another strategy for making bispecific antibody fragments by the use of single-chain Fv (sFv) dimers has also been reported. See Gruber et al, J. Immunol, 152:5368 (1994).
  • bispecific T cell engager or BiTE® approach
  • BiTE® bispecific T cell engager
  • This approach utilizes two antibody variable domains arranged on a single polypeptide.
  • a single polypeptide chain includes two single chain Fv (scFv) fragments, each having a variable heavy chain (V H ) and a variable light chain (V L ) domain separated by a polypeptide linker of a length sufficient to allow intramolecular association between the two domains.
  • This single polypeptide further includes a polypeptide spacer sequence between the two scFv fragments.
  • Each scFv recognizes a different epitope, and these epitopes may be specific for different cell types, such that cells of two different cell types are brought into close proximity or tethered when each scFv is engaged with its cognate epitope.
  • One particular embodiment of this approach includes a scFv recognizing a cell-surface antigen expressed by an immune cell, e.g., a CD3 polypeptide on a T cell, linked to another scFv that recognizes a cell-surface antigen expressed by a target cell, such as a malignant or tumor cell.
  • the bispecific T cell engager may be expressed using any prokaryotic or eukaryotic cell expression system known in the art, e.g., a CHO cell line.
  • specific purification techniques see, e.g., EP1691833 may be necessary to separate monomeric bispecific T cell engagers from other multimeric species, which may have biological activities other than the intended activity of the monomer.
  • a solution containing secreted polypeptides is first subjected to a metal affinity chromatography, and polypeptides are eluted with a gradient of imidazole concentrations.
  • This eluate is further purified using anion exchange chromatography, and polypeptides are eluted using with a gradient of sodium chloride concentrations. Finally, this eluate is subjected to size exclusion chromatography to separate monomers from multimeric species.
  • Antibodies with more than two valencies are contemplated.
  • trispecific antibodies can be prepared. See, e.g., Tuft et al. J. Immunol. 147: 60 (1991).
  • an antibody of the invention is a single-domain antibody.
  • a single-domain antibody is a single polypeptide chain comprising all or a portion of the heavy chain variable domain or all or a portion of the light chain variable domain of an antibody.
  • a single-domain antibody is a human single-domain antibody (Domantis, Inc., Waltham, Mass.; see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 6,248,516 BI).
  • a single-domain antibody consists of all or a portion of the heavy chain variable domain of an antibody.
  • amino acid sequence modification(s) of the antibodies described herein are contemplated.
  • Amino acid sequence variants of the antibody may be prepared by introducing appropriate changes into the nucleotide sequence encoding the antibody, or by peptide synthesis. Such modifications include, for example, deletions from, and/or insertions into and/or substitutions of, residues within the amino acid sequences of the antibody. Any combination of deletion, insertion, and substitution can be made to arrive at the final construct, provided that the final construct possesses the desired characteristics.
  • the amino acid alterations may be introduced in the subject antibody amino acid sequence at the time that sequence is made.
  • antibody variants having one or more amino acid substitutions are provided.
  • Sites of interest for substitutional mutagenesis include the HVRs and FRs.
  • Conservative substitutions are shown in Table 1 under the heading of “conservative substitutions.” More substantial changes are provided in Table 1 under the heading of “exemplary substitutions,” and as further described below in reference to amino acid side chain classes.
  • Amino acid substitutions may be introduced into an antibody of interest and the products screened for a desired activity, e.g., retained/improved antigen binding, decreased immunogenicity, or improved ADCC or CDC.
  • Amino acids may be grouped according to common side-chain properties:
  • Non-conservative substitutions will entail exchanging a member of one of these classes for another class.
  • substitutional variant involves substituting one or more hypervariable region residues of a parent antibody (e.g., a humanized or human antibody).
  • a parent antibody e.g., a humanized or human antibody
  • the resulting variant(s) selected for further study will have modifications (e.g., improvements) in certain biological properties (e.g., increased affinity, reduced immunogenicity) relative to the parent antibody and/or will have substantially retained certain biological properties of the parent antibody.
  • An exemplary substitutional variant is an affinity matured antibody, which may be conveniently generated, e.g., using phage display-based affinity maturation techniques such as those described herein. Briefly, one or more HVR residues are mutated and the variant antibodies displayed on phage and screened for a particular biological activity (e.g. binding affinity).
  • Alterations may be made in HVRs, for example, to improve antibody affinity.
  • Such alterations may be made in HVR “hotspots,” i.e., residues encoded by codons that undergo mutation at high frequency during the somatic maturation process (see, e.g., Chowdhury, Methods Mol. Biol. 207:179-196 (2008)), and/or SDRs (a-CDRs), with the resulting variant VH or VL being tested for binding affinity.
  • HVR “hotspots” i.e., residues encoded by codons that undergo mutation at high frequency during the somatic maturation process (see, e.g., Chowdhury, Methods Mol. Biol. 207:179-196 (2008)), and/or SDRs (a-CDRs), with the resulting variant VH or VL being tested for binding affinity.
  • Affinity maturation by constructing and reselecting from secondary libraries has been described, e.g., in Hoogenboom e
  • affinity maturation diversity is introduced into the variable genes chosen for maturation by any of a variety of methods (e.g., error-prone PCR, chain shuffling, or oligonucleotide-directed mutagenesis).
  • a secondary library is then created. The library is then screened to identify any antibody variants with the desired affinity.
  • Another method to introduce diversity involves HVR-directed approaches, in which several HVR residues (e.g., 4-6 residues at a time) are randomized. HVR residues involved in antigen binding may be specifically identified, e.g., using alanine scanning mutagenesis or modeling. CDR-H3 and CDR-L3 in particular are often targeted.
  • substitutions, insertions, or deletions may occur within one or more HVRs so long as such alterations do not substantially reduce the ability of the antibody to bind antigen.
  • conservative alterations e.g., conservative substitutions as provided herein
  • Such alterations may be outside of HVR “hotspots” or SDRs.
  • each HVR either is unaltered, or contains no more than one, two or three amino acid substitutions.
  • a useful method for identification of residues or regions of an antibody that may be targeted for mutagenesis is called “alanine scanning mutagenesis” as described by Cunningham and Wells (1989) Science, 244:1081-1085.
  • a residue or group of target residues e.g., charged residues such as Arg, Asp, His, Lys, and Glu
  • a neutral or negatively charged amino acid e.g., alanine or polyalanine
  • Further substitutions may be introduced at the amino acid locations demonstrating functional sensitivity to the initial substitutions.
  • a crystal structure of an antigen-antibody complex to identify contact points between the antibody and antigen. Such contact residues and neighboring residues may be targeted or eliminated as candidates for substitution.
  • Variants may be screened to determine whether they contain the desired properties.
  • Amino acid sequence insertions include amino- and/or carboxyl-terminal fusions ranging in length from one residue to polypeptides containing a hundred or more residues, as well as intrasequence insertions of single or multiple amino acid residues.
  • terminal insertions include an antibody with an N-terminal methionyl residue.
  • Other insertional variants of the antibody molecule include the fusion to the N- or C-terminus of the antibody to an enzyme (e.g., for ADEPT) or a polypeptide which increases the serum half-life of the antibody.
  • an antibody provided herein is altered to increase or decrease the extent to which the antibody is glycosylated.
  • Addition or deletion of glycosylation sites to an antibody may be conveniently accomplished by altering the amino acid sequence such that one or more glycosylation sites is created or removed.
  • the carbohydrate attached thereto may be altered.
  • Native antibodies produced by mammalian cells typically comprise a branched, biantennary oligosaccharide that is generally attached by an N-linkage to Asn297 of the CH2 domain of the Fc region. See, e.g., Wright et al. TIBTECH 15:26-32 (1997).
  • the oligosaccharide may include various carbohydrates, e.g., mannose, N-acetyl glucosamine (GlcNAc), galactose, and sialic acid, as well as a fucose attached to a GlcNAc in the “stem” of the biantennary oligosaccharide structure.
  • modifications of the oligosaccharide in an antibody of the invention may be made in order to create antibody variants with certain improved properties.
  • antibody variants comprising an Fc region wherein a carbohydrate structure attached to the Fc region has reduced fucose or lacks fucose, which may improve ADCC function.
  • antibodies are contemplated herein that have reduced fusose relative to the amount of fucose on the same antibody produced in a wild-type CHO cell. That is, they are characterized by having a lower amount of fucose than they would otherwise have if produced by native CHO cells (e.g., a CHO cell that produce a native glycosylation pattern, such as, a CHO cell containing a native FUT8 gene).
  • the antibody is one wherein less than about 50%, 40%, 30%, 20%, 10%, or 5% of the N-linked glycans thereon comprise fucose.
  • the amount of fucose in such an antibody may be from 1% to 80%, from 1% to 65%, from 5% to 65% or from 20% to 40%.
  • the antibody is one wherein none of the N-linked glycans thereon comprise fucose, i.e., wherein the antibody is completely without fucose, or has no fucose or is afucosylated.
  • the amount of fucose is determined by calculating the average amount of fucose within the sugar chain at Asn297, relative to the sum of all glycostructures attached to Asn 297 (e.g. complex, hybrid and high mannose structures) as measured by MALDI-TOF mass spectrometry, as described in WO 2008/077546, for example.
  • Asn297 refers to the asparagine residue located at about position 297 in the Fc region (EU numbering of Fc region residues); however, Asn297 may also be located about ⁇ 3 amino acids upstream or downstream of position 297, i.e., between positions 294 and 300, due to minor sequence variations in antibodies. Such fucosylation variants may have improved ADCC function.
  • Examples of cell lines capable of producing defucosylated antibodies include Lec13 CHO cells deficient in protein fucosylation (Ripka et al. Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 249:533-545 (1986); US Pat Appl No US 2003/0157108 A1; and WO 2004/056312 A1, especially at Example 11), and knockout cell lines, such as alpha-1,6-fucosyltransferase gene, FUT8, knockout CHO cells (see, e.g., Yamane-Ohnuki et al. Biotech. Bioeng. 87: 614 (2004); Kanda, Y. et al., Biotechnol. Bioeng., 94(4):680-688 (2006); and WO2003/085107).
  • Antibody variants are further provided with bisected oligosaccharides, e.g., in which a biantennary oligosaccharide attached to the Fc region of the antibody is bisected by GlcNAc. Such antibody variants may have reduced fucosylation and/or improved ADCC function. Examples of such antibody variants are described, e.g., in WO 2003/011878; U.S. Pat. No. 6,602,684; US 2005/0123546, and Ferrara et al., Biotechnology and Bioengineering, 93(5): 851-861 (2006). Antibody variants with at least one galactose residue in the oligosaccharide attached to the Fc region are also provided. Such antibody variants may have improved CDC function. Such antibody variants are described, e.g., in WO 1997/30087; WO 1998/58964; and WO 1999/22764.
  • the antibody variants comprising an Fc region described herein are capable of binding to an Fc ⁇ RIII. In certain embodiments, the antibody variants comprising an Fc region described herein have ADCC activity in the presence of human effector cells or have increased ADCC activity in the presence of human effector cells compared to the otherwise same antibody comprising a human wild-type IgG1Fc region.
  • one or more amino acid modifications may be introduced into the Fc region of an antibody provided herein, thereby generating an Fc region variant.
  • the Fc region variant may comprise a human Fc region sequence (e.g., a human IgG1, IgG2, IgG3 or IgG4 Fc region) comprising an amino acid modification (e.g., a substitution) at one or more amino acid positions.
  • the invention contemplates an antibody variant that possesses some but not all effector functions, which make it a desirable candidate for applications in which the half life of the antibody in vivo is important yet certain effector functions (such as complement and ADCC) are unnecessary or deleterious.
  • In vitro and/or in vivo cytotoxicity assays can be conducted to confirm the reduction/depletion of CDC and/or ADCC activities.
  • Fc receptor (FcR) binding assays can be conducted to ensure that the antibody lacks Fc ⁇ R binding (hence likely lacking ADCC activity), but retains FcRn binding ability.
  • NK cells express Fc ⁇ RIII only, whereas monocytes express Fc ⁇ RI, Fc ⁇ RII, and Fc ⁇ RIII.
  • FcR expression on hematopoietic cells is summarized in Table 3 on page 464 of Ravetch and Kinet, Annu. Rev. Immunol. 9:457-492 (1991).
  • Non-limiting examples of in vitro assays to assess ADCC activity of a molecule of interest is described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,500,362 (see, e.g. Hellstrom et al. Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 83:7059-7063 (1986)) and Hellstrom, I et al., Proc.
  • non-radioactive assays methods may be employed (see, for example, ACTITM non-radioactive cytotoxicity assay for flow cytometry (CellTechnology, Inc. Mountain View, Calif.; and CytoTox 96® non-radioactive cytotoxicity assay (Promega, Madison, Wis.).
  • Useful effector cells for such assays include peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMC) and Natural Killer (NK) cells.
  • ADCC activity of the molecule of interest may be assessed in vivo, e.g., in an animal model such as that disclosed in Clynes et al. Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 95:652-656 (1998).
  • C1q binding assays may also be carried out to confirm that the antibody is unable to bind C1q and hence lacks CDC activity. See, e.g., C1q and C3c binding ELISA in WO 2006/029879 and WO 2005/100402.
  • a CDC assay may be performed (see, for example, Gazzano-Santoro et al., J. Immunol.
  • FcRn binding and in vivo clearance/half life determinations can also be performed using methods known in the art (see, e.g., Petkova et al., Int'l. Immunol. 18(12):1759-1769 (2006)).
  • Antibodies with reduced effector function include those with substitution of one or more of Fc region residues 238, 265, 269, 270, 297, 327 and 329 (U.S. Pat. No. 6,737,056).
  • Fc mutants include Fc mutants with substitutions at two or more of amino acid positions 265, 269, 270, 297 and 327, including the so-called “DANA” Fc mutant with substitution of residues 265 and 297 to alanine (U.S. Pat. No. 7,332,581).
  • an antibody variant comprises an Fc region with one or more amino acid substitutions which improve ADCC, e.g., substitutions at positions 298, 333, and/or 334 of the Fc region (EU numbering of residues).
  • the antibody comprising the following amino acid substitutions in its Fc region: S298A, E333A, and K334A.
  • alterations are made in the Fc region that result in altered (i.e., either improved or diminished) C1q binding and/or Complement Dependent Cytotoxicity (CDC), e.g., as described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,194,551, WO 99/51642, and Idusogie et al. J. Immunol. 164: 4178-4184 (2000).
  • CDC Complement Dependent Cytotoxicity
  • Antibodies with increased half lives and improved binding to the neonatal Fc receptor (FcRn), which is responsible for the transfer of maternal IgGs to the fetus are described in US2005/0014934A1 (Hinton et al.)).
  • Those antibodies comprise an Fc region with one or more substitutions therein which improve binding of the Fc region to FcRn.
  • Such Fc variants include those with substitutions at one or more of Fc region residues: 238, 256, 265, 272, 286, 303, 305, 307, 311, 312, 317, 340, 356, 360, 362, 376, 378, 380, 382, 413, 424 or 434, e.g., substitution of Fc region residue 434 (U.S. Pat. No. 7,371,826). See also Duncan & Winter, Nature 322:738-40 (1988); U.S. Pat. No. 5,648,260; U.S. Pat. No. 5,624,821; and WO 94/29351 concerning other examples of Fc region variants.
  • the antibodies of the invention can be further modified to contain additional nonproteinaceous moieties that are known in the art and readily available.
  • the moieties suitable for derivatization of the antibody are water soluble polymers.
  • water soluble polymers include, but are not limited to, polyethylene glycol (PEG), copolymers of ethylene glycol/propylene glycol, carboxymethylcellulose, dextran, polyvinyl alcohol, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, poly-1,3-dioxolane, poly-1,3,6-trioxane, ethylene/maleic anhydride copolymer, polyaminoacids (either homopolymers or random copolymers), and dextran or poly(n-vinyl pyrrolidone)polyethylene glycol, propropylene glycol homopolymers, prolypropylene oxide/ethylene oxide co-polymers, polyoxyethylated polyols (e.g., glycerol), poly
  • Polyethylene glycol propionaldehyde may have advantages in manufacturing due to its stability in water.
  • the polymer may be of any molecular weight, and may be branched or unbranched.
  • the number of polymers attached to the antibody may vary, and if more than one polymer are attached, they can be the same or different molecules. In general, the number and/or type of polymers used for derivatization can be determined based on considerations including, but not limited to, the particular properties or functions of the antibody to be improved, whether the antibody derivative will be used in a therapy under defined conditions, etc.
  • Antibodies may also be produced using recombinant methods.
  • nucleic acid encoding the antibody is isolated and inserted into a replicable vector for further cloning (amplification of the DNA) or for expression.
  • DNA encoding the antibody may be readily isolated and sequenced using conventional procedures (e.g., by using oligonucleotide probes that are capable of binding specifically to genes encoding the heavy and light chains of the antibody).
  • the vector components generally include, but are not limited to, one or more of the following: a signal sequence, an origin of replication, one or more marker genes, an enhancer element, a promoter, and a transcription termination sequence.
  • An antibody of the invention may be produced recombinantly not only directly, but also as a fusion polypeptide with a heterologous polypeptide, which is preferably a signal sequence or other polypeptide having a specific cleavage site at the N-terminus of the mature protein or polypeptide.
  • a heterologous polypeptide which is preferably a signal sequence or other polypeptide having a specific cleavage site at the N-terminus of the mature protein or polypeptide.
  • the heterologous signal sequence selected preferably is one that is recognized and processed (e.g., cleaved by a signal peptidase) by the host cell.
  • the signal sequence is substituted by a prokaryotic signal sequence selected, for example, from the group of the alkaline phosphatase, penicillinase, Ipp, or heat-stable enterotoxin II leaders.
  • a prokaryotic signal sequence selected, for example, from the group of the alkaline phosphatase, penicillinase, Ipp, or heat-stable enterotoxin II leaders.
  • yeast secretion the native signal sequence may be substituted by, e.g., the yeast invertase leader, a factor leader (including Saccharomyces and Kluyveromyces ⁇ -factor leaders), or acid phosphatase leader, the C. albicans glucoamylase leader, or the signal described in WO 90/13646.
  • mammalian signal sequences as well as viral secretory leaders for example, the herpes simplex gD signal, are available.
  • Both expression and cloning vectors contain a nucleic acid sequence that enables the vector to replicate in one or more selected host cells.
  • this sequence is one that enables the vector to replicate independently of the host chromosomal DNA, and includes origins of replication or autonomously replicating sequences.
  • origins of replication or autonomously replicating sequences are well known for a variety of bacteria, yeast, and viruses.
  • the origin of replication from the plasmid pBR322 is suitable for most Gram-negative bacteria, the 2 ⁇ , plasmid origin is suitable for yeast, and various viral origins (SV40, polyoma, adenovirus, VSV or BPV) are useful for cloning vectors in mammalian cells.
  • the origin of replication component is not needed for mammalian expression vectors (the SV40 origin may typically be used only because it contains the early promoter.
  • Selection genes may contain a selection gene, also termed a selectable marker.
  • Typical selection genes encode proteins that (a) confer resistance to antibiotics or other toxins, e.g., ampicillin, neomycin, methotrexate, or tetracycline, (b) complement auxotrophic deficiencies, or (c) supply critical nutrients not available from complex media, e.g., the gene encoding D-alanine racemase for Bacilli.
  • One example of a selection scheme utilizes a drug to arrest growth of a host cell. Those cells that are successfully transformed with a heterologous gene produce a protein conferring drug resistance and thus survive the selection regimen. Examples of such dominant selection use the drugs neomycin, mycophenolic acid and hygromycin.
  • Suitable selectable markers for mammalian cells are those that enable the identification of cells competent to take up antibody-encoding nucleic acid, such as DHFR, glutamine synthetase (GS), thymidine kinase, metallothionein-I and -II, preferably primate metallothionein genes, adenosine deaminase, omithine decarboxylase, etc.
  • cells transformed with the DHFR gene are identified by culturing the transformants in a culture medium containing methotrexate (Mtx), a competitive antagonist of DHFR. Under these conditions, the DHFR gene is amplified along with any other co-transformed nucleic acid.
  • Mtx methotrexate
  • a Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) cell line deficient in endogenous DHFR activity e.g., ATCC CRL-9096 may be used.
  • cells transformed with the GS gene are identified by culturing the transformants in a culture medium containing L-methionine sulfoximine (Msx), an inhibitor of GS. Under these conditions, the GS gene is amplified along with any other co-transformed nucleic acid.
  • the GS selection/amplification system may be used in combination with the DHFR selection/amplification system described above.
  • host cells transformed or co-transformed with DNA sequences encoding an antibody of interest, wild-type DHFR gene, and another selectable marker such as aminoglycoside 3′-phosphotransferase (APH) can be selected by cell growth in medium containing a selection agent for the selectable marker such as an aminoglycosidic antibiotic, e.g., kanamycin, neomycin, or G418. See U.S. Pat. No. 4,965,199.
  • APH aminoglycoside 3′-phosphotransferase
  • a suitable selection gene for use in yeast is the trp1 gene present in the yeast plasmid YRp7 (Stinchcomb et al., Nature, 282:39 (1979)).
  • the trp1 gene provides a selection marker for a mutant strain of yeast lacking the ability to grow in tryptophan, for example, ATCC No. 44076 or PEP4-1. Jones, Genetics, 85:12 (1977).
  • the presence of the trp1 lesion in the yeast host cell genome then provides an effective environment for detecting transformation by growth in the absence of tryptophan.
  • Leu2-deficient yeast strains (ATCC 20,622 or 38,626) are complemented by known plasmids bearing the Leu2 gene.
  • vectors derived from the 1.6 ⁇ m circular plasmid pKD1 can be used for transformation of Kluyveromyces yeasts.
  • an expression system for large-scale production of recombinant calf chymosin was reported for K. lactis . Van den Berg, Bio/Technology, 8:135 (1990).
  • Stable multi-copy expression vectors for secretion of mature recombinant human serum albumin by industrial strains of Kluyveromyces have also been disclosed. Fleer et al., Bio/Technology, 9:968-975 (1991).
  • Expression and cloning vectors generally contain a promoter that is recognized by the host organism and is operably linked to nucleic acid encoding an antibody.
  • Promoters suitable for use with prokaryotic hosts include the phoA promoter, ⁇ -lactamase and lactose promoter systems, alkaline phosphatase promoter, a tryptophan (trp) promoter system, and hybrid promoters such as the tac promoter.
  • trp tryptophan
  • Other known bacterial promoters are suitable. Promoters for use in bacterial systems also will contain a Shine-Dalgamo (S.D.) sequence operably linked to the DNA encoding an antibody.
  • S.D. Shine-Dalgamo
  • Promoter sequences are known for eukaryotes. Virtually all eukaryotic genes have an AT-rich region located approximately 25 to 30 bases upstream from the site where transcription is initiated. Another sequence found 70 to 80 bases upstream from the start of transcription of many genes is a CNCAAT region where N may be any nucleotide. At the 3′ end of most eukaryotic genes is an AATAAA sequence that may be the signal for addition of the poly A tail to the 3′ end of the coding sequence. All of these sequences are suitably inserted into eukaryotic expression vectors.
  • suitable promoter sequences for use with yeast hosts include the promoters for 3-phosphoglycerate kinase or other glycolytic enzymes, such as enolase, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, hexokinase, pyruvate decarboxylase, phosphofructokinase, glucose-6-phosphate isomerase, 3-phosphoglycerate mutase, pyruvate kinase, triosephosphate isomerase, phosphoglucose isomerase, and glucokinase.
  • 3-phosphoglycerate kinase or other glycolytic enzymes such as enolase, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, hexokinase, pyruvate decarboxylase, phosphofructokinase, glucose-6-phosphate isomerase, 3-phosphoglycerate mutase, pyruvate
  • yeast promoters which are inducible promoters having the additional advantage of transcription controlled by growth conditions, are the promoter regions for alcohol dehydrogenase 2, isocytochrome C, acid phosphatase, degradative enzymes associated with nitrogen metabolism, metallothionein, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, and enzymes responsible for maltose and galactose utilization.
  • Suitable vectors and promoters for use in yeast expression are further described in EP 73,657.
  • Yeast enhancers also are advantageously used with yeast promoters.
  • Antibody transcription from vectors in mammalian host cells can be controlled, for example, by promoters obtained from the genomes of viruses such as polyoma virus, fowlpox virus, adenovirus (such as Adenovirus 2), bovine papilloma virus, avian sarcoma virus, cytomegalovirus, a retrovirus, hepatitis-B virus, Simian Virus 40 (SV40), or from heterologous mammalian promoters, e.g., the actin promoter or an immunoglobulin promoter, from heat-shock promoters, provided such promoters are compatible with the host cell systems.
  • viruses such as polyoma virus, fowlpox virus, adenovirus (such as Adenovirus 2), bovine papilloma virus, avian sarcoma virus, cytomegalovirus, a retrovirus, hepatitis-B virus, Simian Virus 40 (SV40), or from hetero
  • the early and late promoters of the SV40 virus are conveniently obtained as an SV40 restriction fragment that also contains the SV40 viral origin of replication.
  • the immediate early promoter of the human cytomegalovirus is conveniently obtained as a HindIII E restriction fragment.
  • a system for expressing DNA in mammalian hosts using the bovine papilloma virus as a vector is disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 4,419,446. A modification of this system is described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,601,978. See also Reyes et al., Nature 297:598-601 (1982) on expression of human n-interferon cDNA in mouse cells under the control of a thymidine kinase promoter from herpes simplex virus. Alternatively, the Rous Sarcoma Virus long terminal repeat can be used as the promoter.
  • Enhancer sequences are now known from mammalian genes (globin, elastase, albumin, ⁇ -fetoprotein, and insulin). Typically, however, one will use an enhancer from a eukaryotic cell virus. Examples include the SV40 enhancer on the late side of the replication origin (bp 100-270), the cytomegalovirus early promoter enhancer, the polyoma enhancer on the late side of the replication origin, and adenovirus enhancers. See also Yaniv, Nature 297:17-18 (1982) on enhancing elements for activation of eukaryotic promoters. The enhancer may be spliced into the vector at a position 5′ or 3′ to the antibody-encoding sequence, but is preferably located at a site 5′ from the promoter.
  • Expression vectors used in eukaryotic host cells will also contain sequences necessary for the termination of transcription and for stabilizing the mRNA. Such sequences are commonly available from the 5′ and, occasionally 3′, untranslated regions of eukaryotic or viral DNAs or cDNAs. These regions contain nucleotide segments transcribed as polyadenylated fragments in the untranslated portion of the mRNA encoding antibody.
  • One useful transcription termination component is the bovine growth hormone polyadenylation region. See WO94/11026 and the expression vector disclosed therein.
  • Suitable host cells for cloning or expressing the DNA in the vectors herein are the prokaryote, yeast, or higher eukaryote cells described above.
  • Suitable prokaryotes for this purpose include eubacteria, such as Gram-negative or Gram-positive organisms, for example, Enterobacteriaceae such as Escherichia , e.g., E. coli, Enterobacter, Erwinia, Klebsiella, Proteus, Salmonella , e.g., Salmonella typhimurium, Serratia , e.g., Serratia marcescans , and Shigella , as well as Bacilli such as B. subtilis and B.
  • Enterobacteriaceae such as Escherichia , e.g., E. coli, Enterobacter, Erwinia, Klebsiella, Proteus
  • Salmonella e.g., Salmonella typhimurium
  • Serratia
  • E. coli cloning host is E. coli 294 (ATCC 31,446), although other strains such as E. coli B, E. coli X1776 (ATCC 31,537), and E. coli W3110 (ATCC 27,325) are suitable. These examples are illustrative rather than limiting.
  • Full length antibody, antibody fusion proteins, and antibody fragments can be produced in bacteria, in particular when glycosylation and Fc effector function are not needed, such as when the therapeutic antibody is conjugated to a cytotoxic agent (e.g., a toxin) that by itself shows effectiveness in tumor cell destruction.
  • a cytotoxic agent e.g., a toxin
  • Full length antibodies have greater half-life in circulation. Production in E. coli is faster and more cost efficient.
  • For expression of antibody fragments and polypeptides in bacteria see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,648,237 (Carter et. al.), U.S. Pat. No. 5,789,199 (Joly et al.), U.S. Pat. No.
  • eukaryotic microbes such as filamentous fungi or yeast are suitable cloning or expression hosts for antibody-encoding vectors.
  • Saccharomyces cerevisiae or common baker's yeast, is the most commonly used among lower eukaryotic host microorganisms.
  • a number of other genera, species, and strains are commonly available and useful herein, such as Schizosaccharomyces pombe; Kluyveromyces hosts such as, e.g., K. lactis, K fragilis (ATCC 12,424), K. bulgaricus (ATCC 16,045), K. wickeramii (ATCC 24,178), K.
  • Certain fungi and yeast strains may be selected in which glycosylation pathways have been “humanized,” resulting in the production of an antibody with a partially or fully human glycosylation pattern. See, e.g., Li et al., Nat. Biotech. 24:210-215 (2006) (describing humanization of the glycosylation pathway in Pichia pastoris ); and Gemgross et al., supra.
  • Suitable host cells for the expression of glycosylated antibody are also derived from multicellular organisms (invertebrates and vertebrates). Examples of invertebrate cells include plant and insect cells. Numerous baculoviral strains and variants and corresponding permissive insect host cells from hosts such as Spodoptera frugiperda (caterpillar), Aedes aegypti (mosquito), Aedes albopictus (mosquito), Drosophila melanogaster (fruitfly), and Bombyx mari have been identified.
  • a variety of viral strains for transfection are publicly available, e.g., the L-1 variant of Autographa californica NPV and the Bm-5 strain of Bombyx mori NPV, and such viruses may be used as the virus herein according to the invention, particularly for transfection of Spodoptera frugiperda cells.
  • Plant cell cultures of cotton, corn, potato, soybean, petunia, tomato, duckweed (Leninaceae), alfalfa ( M. truncatula ), and tobacco can also be utilized as hosts. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,959,177, 6,040,498, 6,420,548, 7,125,978, and 6,417,429 (describing PLANTIBODIESTM technology for producing antibodies in transgenic plants).
  • Vertebrate cells may be used as hosts, and propagation of vertebrate cells in culture (tissue culture) has become a routine procedure.
  • useful mammalian host cell lines are monkey kidney CV1 line transformed by SV40 (COS-7, ATCC CRL 1651); human embryonic kidney line (293 or 293 cells subcloned for growth in suspension culture, Graham et al., J. Gen Virol. 36:59 (1977)); baby hamster kidney cells (BHK, ATCC CCL 10); mouse sertoli cells (TM4, Mather, Biol. Reprod.
  • monkey kidney cells (CV1 ATCC CCL 70); African green monkey kidney cells (VERO-76, ATCC CRL-1587); human cervical carcinoma cells (HELA, ATCC CCL 2); canine kidney cells (MDCK, ATCC CCL 34); buffalo rat liver cells (BRL 3A, ATCC CRL 1442); human lung cells (W138, ATCC CCL 75); human liver cells (Hep G2, HB 8065); mouse mammary tumor (MMT 060562, ATCC CCL51); TRI cells (Mather et al., Annals N.Y. Acad. Sci. 383:44-68 (1982)); MRC 5 cells; FS4 cells; and a human hepatoma line (Hep G2).
  • CHO Chinese hamster ovary
  • DHFR-CHO cells Urlaub et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 77:4216 (1980)
  • myeloma cell lines such as NS0 and Sp2/0.
  • Yazaki and Wu Methods in Molecular Biology , Vol. 248 (B. K. C. Lo, ed., Humana Press, Totowa, N.J., 2003), pp. 255-268.
  • Host cells are transformed with the above-described expression or cloning vectors for antibody production and cultured in conventional nutrient media modified as appropriate for inducing promoters, selecting transformants, or amplifying the genes encoding the desired sequences.
  • the host cells used to produce an antibody of this invention may be cultured in a variety of media.
  • Commercially available media such as Ham's F10 (Sigma), Minimal Essential Medium ((MEM), (Sigma), RPMI-1640 (Sigma), and Dulbecco's Modified Eagle's Medium ((DMEM), Sigma) are suitable for culturing the host cells.
  • any of these media may be supplemented as necessary with hormones and/or other growth factors (such as insulin, transferrin, or epidermal growth factor), salts (such as sodium chloride, calcium, magnesium, and phosphate), buffers (such as HEPES), nucleotides (such as adenosine and thymidine), antibiotics (such as GENTAMYCINTM drug), trace elements (defined as inorganic compounds usually present at final concentrations in the micromolar range), and glucose or an equivalent energy source. Any other necessary supplements may also be included at appropriate concentrations that would be known to those skilled in the art.
  • the culture conditions such as temperature, pH, and the like, are those previously used with the host cell selected for expression, and will be apparent to the ordinarily skilled artisan.
  • the antibody can be produced intracellularly, in the periplasmic space, or directly secreted into the medium. If the antibody is produced intracellularly, as a first step, the particulate debris, either host cells or lysed fragments, are removed, for example, by centrifugation or ultrafiltration. Carter et al., Bio/Technology 10:163-167 (1992) describe a procedure for isolating antibodies which are secreted to the periplasmic space of E. coli Briefly, cell paste is thawed in the presence of sodium acetate (pH 3.5), EDTA, and phenylmethylsulfonylfluoride (PMSF) over about 30 min.
  • sodium acetate pH 3.5
  • EDTA EDTA
  • PMSF phenylmethylsulfonylfluoride
  • Cell debris can be removed by centrifugation.
  • supernatants from such expression systems are generally first concentrated using a commercially available protein concentration filter, for example, an Amicon or Millipore Pellicon ultrafiltration unit.
  • a protease inhibitor such as PMSF may be included in any of the foregoing steps to inhibit proteolysis and antibiotics may be included to prevent the growth of adventitious contaminants.
  • the antibody composition prepared from the cells can be purified using, for example, hydroxylapatite chromatography, hydrophobic interaction chromatography, gel electrophoresis, dialysis, and affinity chromatography, with affinity chromatography being among one of the typically preferred purification steps.
  • the suitability of protein A as an affinity ligand depends on the species and isotype of any immunoglobulin Fc domain that is present in the antibody.
  • Protein A can be used to purify antibodies that are based on human ⁇ 1, ⁇ 2, or ⁇ 4 heavy chains (Lindmark et al., J. Immunol. Meth. 62:1-13 (1983)). Protein G is recommended for all mouse isotypes and for human ⁇ 3 (Guss et al., EMBO J.
  • the matrix to which the affinity ligand is attached is most often agarose, but other matrices are available. Mechanically stable matrices such as controlled pore glass or poly(styrenedivinyl)benzene allow for faster flow rates and shorter processing times than can be achieved with agarose.
  • the antibody comprises a C M 3 domain
  • the Bakerbond ABXTM resin J. T. Baker, Phillipsburg, N.J. is useful for purification.
  • Antibodies produced as described above may be subjected to one or more “biological activity” assays to select an antibody with beneficial properties from a therapeutic perspective or selecting formulations and conditions that retain biological activity of the antibody.
  • the antibody may be tested for its ability to bind the antigen against which it was raised.
  • methods known in the art such as ELISA, Western Blot, etc. may be used.
  • the antigen binding properties of the antibody can be evaluated in an assay that detects the ability to bind to PD-L1.
  • the binding of the antibody may be determined by saturation binding; ELISA; and/or competition assays (e.g. RIA's), for example.
  • the antibody may be subjected to other biological activity assays, e.g., in order to evaluate its effectiveness as a therapeutic. Such assays are known in the art and depend on the target antigen and intended use for the antibody.
  • the biological effects of PD-L1 blockade by the antibody can be assessed in CD8+ T cells, a lymphocytic choriomeningitis virus (LCMV) mouse model and/or a syngeneic tumor model e.g., as described in U.S. Pat. No. 8,217,149.
  • LCMV lymphocytic choriomeningitis virus
  • a routine cross-blocking assay such as that described in Antibodies, A Laboratory Manual , Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, Ed Harlow and David Lane (1988), can be performed.
  • epitope mapping e.g. as described in Champe et al., J. Biol. Chem. 270:1388-1394 (1995), can be performed to determine whether the antibody binds an epitope of interest.
  • compositions and formulations comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or an antibody described herein (such as an anti-PD-L1 antibody) and, optionally, a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the invention also provides pharmaceutical compositions and formulations comprising taxanes, e.g., nab-paditaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel.
  • compositions and formulations as described herein can be prepared by mixing the active ingredients (e.g., a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or a taxane) having the desired degree of purity with one or more optional pharmaceutically acceptable carriers ( Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences 16th edition, Osol, A. Ed. (1980)), in the form of lyophilized formulations or aqueous solutions.
  • active ingredients e.g., a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or a taxane
  • optional pharmaceutically acceptable carriers Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences 16th edition, Osol, A. Ed. (1980)
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers are generally nontoxic to recipients at the dosages and concentrations employed, and include, but are not limited to: buffers such as phosphate, citrate, and other organic acids; antioxidants including ascorbic acid and methionine; preservatives (such as octadecyldimethylbenzyl ammonium chloride; hexamethonium chloride; benzalkonium chloride; benzethonium chloride; phenol, butyl or benzyl alcohol; alkyl parabens such as methyl or propyl paraben; catechol; resorcinol; cyclohexanol; 3-pentanol; and m-cresol); low molecular weight (less than about 10 residues) polypeptides; proteins, such as serum albumin, gelatin, or immunoglobulins; hydrophilic polymers such as polyvinylpyrrolidone; amino acids such as glycine, glutamine, asparagine, histidine, arg
  • sHASEGP soluble neutral-active hyaluronidase glycoproteins
  • rHuPH20 HYLENEX®, Baxter Intemational, Inc.
  • Certain exemplary sHASEGPs and methods of use, including rHuPH20, are described in US Patent Publication Nos. 2005/0260186 and 2006/0104968.
  • a sHASEGP is combined with one or more additional glycosaminoglycanases such as chondroitinases.
  • Exemplary lyophilized antibody formulations are described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,267,958.
  • Aqueous antibody formulations include those described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,171,586 and WO2006/044908, the latter formulations including a histidine-acetate buffer.
  • compositions and formulations herein may also contain more than one active ingredients as necessary for the particular indication being treated, preferably those with complementary activities that do not adversely affect each other.
  • active ingredients are suitably present in combination in amounts that are effective for the purpose intended.
  • Active ingredients may be entrapped in microcapsules prepared, for example, by coacervation techniques or by interfacial polymerization, for example, hydroxymethylcellulose or gelatin-microcapsules and poly-(methylmethacylate) microcapsules, respectively, in colloidal drug delivery systems (for example, liposomes, albumin microspheres, microemulsions, nano-particles and nanocapsules) or in macroemulsions.
  • colloidal drug delivery systems for example, liposomes, albumin microspheres, microemulsions, nano-particles and nanocapsules
  • Sustained-release preparations may be prepared. Suitable examples of sustained-release preparations include semipermeable matrices of solid hydrophobic polymers containing the antibody, which matrices are in the form of shaped articles, e.g. films, or microcapsules.
  • the formulations to be used for in vivo administration are generally sterile. Sterility may be readily accomplished, e.g., by filtration through sterile filtration membranes.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) or paclitaxel.
  • the treatment results in a response in the individual after treatment.
  • the response is a partial response.
  • the response is a complete response.
  • the treatment results in a sustained response (e.g., a sustained partial response or complete response) in the individual after cessation of the treatment.
  • the methods described herein may find use in treating conditions where enhanced immunogenicity is desired such as increasing tumor immunogenicity for the treatment of cancer.
  • methods of enhancing immune function in an individual having a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer comprising administering to the individual an effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., MPDL3280A) and a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., MPDL3280A
  • a taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®
  • Any of the PD-1 axis binding antagonists and the taxanes known in the art or described herein may be used in the methods.
  • the methods provided herein include administration of an effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist, and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist is an antibody, such as an antibody that is capable of inhibiting PD-L1 binding to PD-1 and B7.1, but does not disrupt binding of PD-1 to PD-L2.
  • the PD-L1 binding antagonist antibody is MPDL3280A, which may be administered at a dose of about 700 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks (e.g., about 750 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks, e.g., about 800 mg to about 850 mg every two weeks). In some embodiments, MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 840 mg every two weeks.
  • the therapeutically effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist may be administered to a human will be in the range of about 0.01 to about 50 mg/kg of patient body weight whether by one or more administrations.
  • the antagonist e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • the antagonist is administered in a dose of about 0.01 to about 45 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 40 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 35 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 30 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 25 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 20 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 15 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 10 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 5 mg/kg, or about 0.01 to about 1 mg/kg administered daily, for example.
  • the antagonist e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • a human is administered to a human at a dose of about 100 mg, about 200 mg, about 300 mg, about 400 mg, about 500 mg, about 600 mg, about 700 mg, about 800 mg, about 900 mg, about 1000 mg, about 1100 mg, about 1200 mg, about 1300 mg, about 1400 mg, or about 1500 mg.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • the dose may be administered as a single dose or as multiple doses (e.g., 2 or 3 doses), such as infusions.
  • the dose of the antibody administered in a combination treatment may be reduced as compared to a single treatment.
  • the method for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual comprises a dosing regimen comprising treatment cycles, wherein the individual is administered, on days 1 and 15 of each cycle, a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) at a dose of about 840 mg, wherein each cycle is 28 days (i.e., each cycle is repeated every 28 days).
  • a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • the methods provided herein include administration of an effective amount of a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel).
  • a taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel.
  • the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
  • the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 to about 125 mg/m 2 every week.
  • the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 every week.
  • the therapeutically effective amount of a taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)
  • a taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)
  • the therapeutically effective amount of a taxane administered to a human will be in the range of about 25 to about 300 mg/m 2 (e.g., about 25 mg/m 2 , about 50 mg/m 2 , about 75 mg/m 2 , about 100 mg/m 2 , about 125 mg/m 2 , about 150 mg/m 2 , about 175 mg/m 2 , about 200 mg/m 2 , about 225 mg/m 2 , about 250 mg/m 2 , about 275 mg/m 2 , or about 300 mg/m 2 ), whether by one or more administrations.
  • a taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)
  • ABRAXANE® nab
  • nab-paclitaxel ABRAXANE®
  • nab-paclitaxel ABRAXANE®
  • paclitaxel is administered at 200 mg/m 2 every three weeks.
  • the taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., an anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • the taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) are administered in a single dosing regimen.
  • the administration of these agents may be concurrent or separate within the context of the dosing regimen.
  • the methods provided herein include a dosing regimen comprising treatment cycles, wherein the individual is administered, on days 1 and 15 of each cycle, a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist at a dose of about 840 mg, and on days 1, 8, and 15 of each cycle, a taxane at a dose of about 100 mg/m 2 , each cycle being repeated every 28 days.
  • the methods further comprise administering an effective amount of a chemotherapeutic agent.
  • the chemotherapeutic agent is a platinum-based chemotherapeutic agent, such as carboplatin.
  • the individual is a human. In some embodiments, the individual is suffering from locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. In some embodiments, the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC. In some embodiments, the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. In some embodiments, the individual has never had prior targeted systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • the methods for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer (e.g., mTNBC) in an individual or for enhancing immune function in an individual having a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer can serve as a first-line therapy for the individual.
  • the individual has been treated with a cancer therapy before the combination treatment with a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
  • the individual has cancer that is resistant to one or more cancer therapies.
  • resistance to cancer therapy includes recurrence of cancer or refractory cancer. Recurrence may refer to the reappearance of cancer, in the original site or a new site, after treatment.
  • resistance to a cancer therapy includes progression of the cancer during treatment with the anti-cancer therapy.
  • resistance to a cancer therapy includes cancer that does not response to treatment. The cancer may be resistant at the beginning of treatment or it may become resistant during treatment. In some embodiments, the cancer is at early stage or at late stage.
  • the combination therapy of the invention comprises administration of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)
  • ABRAXANE® nab-paclitaxel
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane may be administered sequentially (at different times) or concurrently (at the same time).
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is in a separate composition as the taxane.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is in the same composition as the taxane.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane may be administered by the same route of administration or by different routes of administration.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is administered intravenously, intramuscularly, subcutaneously, topically, orally, transdermally, intraperitoneally, intraorbitally, by implantation, by inhalation, intrathecally, intraventricularly, or intranasally.
  • the taxane is administered intravenously, intramuscularly, subcutaneously, topically, orally, transdermally, intraperitoneally, intraorbitally, by implantation, by inhalation, intrathecally, intraventricularly, or intranasally.
  • An effective amount of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane may be administered for prevention or treatment of disease.
  • the appropriate dosage of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or the taxane may be determined based on the type of disease to be treated, the type of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane, the severity and course of the disease, the clinical condition of the individual, the individual's clinical history and response to the treatment, and the discretion of the attending physician.
  • the methods may further comprise an additional therapy.
  • the additional therapy may be radiation therapy, surgery (e.g., lumpectomy and a mastectomy), chemotherapy, gene therapy, DNA therapy, viral therapy, RNA therapy, immunotherapy, bone marrow transplantation, nanotherapy, monoclonal antibody therapy, or a combination of the foregoing.
  • the additional therapy may be in the form of adjuvant or neoadjuvant therapy.
  • the additional therapy is the administration of small molecule enzymatic inhibitor or anti-metastatic agent.
  • the additional therapy is the administration of side-effect limiting agents (e.g., agents intended to lessen the occurrence and/or severity of side effects of treatment, such as anti-nausea agents, etc.).
  • the additional therapy is radiation therapy. In some embodiments, the additional therapy is surgery. In some embodiments, the additional therapy is a combination of radiation therapy and surgery. In some embodiments, the additional therapy is gamma irradiation. In some embodiments, the additional therapy is therapy targeting PI3KAKT/mTOR pathway, HSP90 inhibitor, tubulin inhibitor, apoptosis inhibitor, and/or chemopreventative agent. The additional therapy may be one or more of the chemotherapeutic agents described herein.
  • the methods further comprise administering a platinum-based chemotherapeutic agent with the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and taxane.
  • the platinum-based chemotherapeutic agent is carboplatin. Dosages and administration of carboplatin are well-known in the art. An exemplary dosage of carboplatin is administered with a target area under the curve (AUC) of 6 mg/ml. In some embodiments, the carboplatin is administered intravenously every 3 weeks.
  • the methods include treating an individual suffering from mTNBC by administering anti-PD-L1 antibody MPDL3280A at 800 mg IV administered every two weeks (q2w), along with nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at 125 mg/m 2 IV every week (q1w), for three weeks within the context of a 4-week (28-day) treatment cycle, which may be repeated until there is loss of clinical benefit, complete response, remission, or otherwise, at the discretion of the attending physician.
  • Also provided herein are methods for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual comprising administering to the individual a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) and a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)) in conjunction with another anti-cancer agent or cancer therapy.
  • a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • a taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)
  • the methods comprise administering to the individual a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist, a taxane, and an additional therapeutic agent.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a chemotherapy or chemotherapeutic agent. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a radiation therapy or radiotherapeutic agent. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a targeted therapy or targeted therapeutic agent. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an immunotherapy or immunotherapeutic agent, for example a monoclonal antibody.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • a taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)
  • ABRAXANE® nab-paclitaxel
  • an activating co-stimulatory molecule may include CD40, CD226, CD28, OX40, GITR, CD137, CD27, HVEM, or CD127.
  • the agonist directed against an activating co-stimulatory molecule is an agonist antibody that binds to CD40, CD226, CD28, OX40, GITR, CD137, CD27, HVEM, or CD127.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • a taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)
  • an inhibitory co-stimulatory molecule may include CTLA-4 (also known as CD152), PD-1, TIM-3, BTLA, VISTA, LAG-3, B7-H3, B7-H4, IDO, TIGIT, MICA/B, or arginase.
  • the antagonist directed against an inhibitory co-stimulatory molecule is an antagonist antibody that binds to CTLA-4, PD-1, TIM-3, BTLA, VISTA, LAG-3, B7-H3, B7-H4, IDO, TIGIT, MICA/B, or arginase.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • a taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)
  • CTLA-4 also known as CD152
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with ipilimumab (also known as MDX-010, MDX-101, or YERVOY®).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with tremelimumab (also known as ticilimumab or CP-675,206).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antagonist directed against B7-H3 (also known as CD276), for example, a blocking antibody.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with MGA271.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antagonist directed against a TGF beta, for example, metelimumab (also known as CAT-192), fresolimumab (also known as GC1008), or LY2157299.
  • an antagonist directed against a TGF beta for example, metelimumab (also known as CAT-192), fresolimumab (also known as GC1008), or LY2157299.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment comprising adoptive transfer of a T cell (e.g., a cytotoxic T cell or CTL) expressing a chimeric antigen receptor (CAR).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment comprising adoptive transfer of a T cell comprising a dominant-negative TGF beta receptor, e.g, a dominant-negative TGF beta type II receptor.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment comprising a HERCREEM protocol (see, e.g., ClinicalTrials.gov Identifier NCT00889954).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an agonist directed against CD137 (also known as TNFRSF9, 4-1BB, or ILA), for example, an activating antibody.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with urelumab (also known as BMS-663513).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an agonist directed against CD40, for example, an activating antibody.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with CP-870893.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an agonist directed against OX40 (also known as CD134), for example, an activating antibody.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an anti-OX40 antibody (e.g., AgonOX).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an agonist directed against CD27, for example, an activating antibody.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with CDX-1127.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antagonist directed against indoleamine-2,3-dioxygenase (IDO).
  • IDO indoleamine-2,3-dioxygenase
  • with the IDO antagonist is 1-methyl-D-tryptophan (also known as I-D-MT).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody-drug conjugate.
  • the antibody-drug conjugate comprises mertansine or monomethyl auristatin E (MMAE).
  • MMAE monomethyl auristatin E
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with and anti-NaPi2b antibody-MMAE conjugate (also known as DNIB0600A or RG7599).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with trastuzumab emtansine (also known as T-DM1, ado-trastuzumab emtansine, or KADCYLA®, Genentech).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with DMUC5754A.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody-drug conjugate targeting the endothelin B receptor (EDNBR), for example, an antibody directed against EDNBR conjugated with MMAE.
  • EDNBR endothelin B receptor
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an angiogenesis inhibitor.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody directed against a VEGF, for example, VEGF-A.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A
  • a taxane e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)
  • bevacizumab also known as AVASTIN®, Genentech.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody directed against angiopoietin 2 (also known as Ang2).
  • angiopoietin 2 also known as Ang2
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with MEDI3617.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antineoplastic agent.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an agent targeting CSF-1R (also known as M-CSFR or CD115).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with anti-CSF-1 R (also known as IMC-CS4).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an interferon, for example interferon alpha or interferon gamma.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with Roferon-A (also known as recombinant Interferon alpha-2a).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with GM-CSF (also known as recombinant human granulocyte macrophage colony stimulating factor, rhu GM-CSF, sargramostim, or LEUKINE®).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with IL-2 (also known as aldesleukin or PROLEUKIN®).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with IL-12. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody targeting CD20. In some embodiments, the antibody targeting CD20 is obinutuzumab (also known as GA101 or GAZYVA®) or rituximab. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody targeting GITR. In some embodiments, the antibody targeting GITR is TRX518.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a cancer vaccine.
  • the cancer vaccine is a peptide cancer vaccine, which in some embodiments is a personalized peptide vaccine.
  • the peptide cancer vaccine is a multivalent long peptide, a multi-peptide, a peptide cocktail, a hybrid peptide, or a peptide-pulsed dendritic cell vaccine (see, e.g., Yamada et al., Cancer Sci, 104:14-21, 2013).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an adjuvant.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment comprising a TLR agonist, for example, Poly-ICLC (also known as HILTONOL®), LPS, MPL, or CpG ODN.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with tumor necrosis factor (TNF) alpha.
  • TNF tumor necrosis factor
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with IL-1.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with HMGB1.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an IL-10 antagonist. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an IL-4 antagonist. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an IL-13 antagonist. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an HVEM antagonist.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an ICOS agonist, e.g., by administration of ICOS-L, or an agonistic antibody directed against ICOS.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment targeting CX3CL1.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment targeting CXCL9.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment targeting CXCL10.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment targeting CCL5. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an LFA-1 or ICAM1 agonist. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a Selectin agonist.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a targeted therapy.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of B-Raf.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with vemurafenib (also known as ZELBORAF®).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with dabrafenib (also known as TAFINLAR®).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with erlotinib (also known as TARCEVA®).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of a MEK, such as MEK1 (also known as MAP2K1) or MEK2 (also known as MAP2K2).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with cobimetinib (also known as GDC-0973 or XL-518).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with trametinib (also known as MEKINIST®). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of K-Ras. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of c-Met. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with onartuzumab (also known as MetMAb). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of Alk.
  • trametinib also known as MEKINIST®
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of K-Ras.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with AF802 (also known as CH5424802 or alectinib).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of a phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase (P13K).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with BKM120.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with idelalisib (also known as GS-1101 or CAL-101).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with perifosine (also known as KRX-0401). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of an Akt. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist may be administered in conjunction with MK2206. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with GSK690693. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with GDC-0941.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of mTOR.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with sirolimus (also known as rapamycin).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with temsirolimus (also known as CCI-779 or TORISEL®).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with everolimus (also known as RAD001).
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with ridaforolimus (also known as AP-23573, MK-8669, or deforolimus). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with OSI-027. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with AZD8055. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with INK128. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a dual PI3K/mTOR inhibitor.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with XL765. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with GDC-0980. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with BEZ235 (also known as NVP-BEZ235). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with BGT226. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with GSK2126458.
  • a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with PF-04691502. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with PF-05212384 (also known as PKI-587).
  • an article of manufacture or a kit comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) and/or a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)).
  • the article of manufacture or kit further comprises package insert comprising instructions for using the PD-1 axis binding antagonist in conjunction with a a taxane to treat or delay progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual or to enhance immune function of an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • Any of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or taxanes described herein may be included in the article of manufacture or kits.
  • the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane are in the same container or separate containers.
  • Suitable containers include, for example, bottles, vials, bags and syringes.
  • the container may be formed from a variety of materials such as glass, plastic (such as polyvinyl chloride or polyolefin), or metal alloy (such as stainless steel or hastelloy).
  • the container holds the formulation and the label on, or associated with, the container may indicate directions for use.
  • the article of manufacture or kit may further include other materials desirable from a commercial and user standpoint, including other buffers, diluents, filters, needles, syringes, and package inserts with instructions for use.
  • the article of manufacture further includes one or more of another agent (e.g., a chemotherapeutic agent, and anti-neoplastic agent).
  • another agent e.g., a chemotherapeutic agent, and anti-neoplastic agent.
  • suitable containers for the one or more agent include, for example, bottles, vials, bags and syringes.
  • Example 1 Combination Treatment with Anti-Pd-L1 Antibody and Nab-Paclitaxel (Abraxane®) Achieved Response in a Phase Ib Clinical Trial for Patients with Metastatic Triple-Negative Breast Cancer (mTNBC)
  • Metastatic triple-negative breast cancer is associated with poor prognosis and is characterized by a high mutation rate, increased levels of tumor-infiltrating lymphocytes, and high PD-L1 expression levels.
  • MPDL3280A is a humanized monoclonal antibody that can restore tumor-specific T-cell immunity by inhibiting the binding of PD-L1 to PD-1 and has demonstrated durable responses as a monotherapy in mTNBC. This study is the first combination trial of a checkpoint inhibitor with chemotherapy in patients with mTNBC.
  • This arm of a multi-center, multi-arm phase Ib study evaluated MPDL3280A in combination with weekly nab-paclitaxel in patients with mTNBC.
  • Primary endpoints were safety and tolerability, with secondary endpoints of PK and clinical activity.
  • Key eligibility criteria included measurable disease; Eastern Cooperative Oncology Group (ECOG) performance status of 0 or 1; and ⁇ 2 prior cytotoxic regimens.
  • Patients received atezolizumab 800 mg once every two weeks (on days 1 and 15) with nab-paditaxel 125 mg/m 2 weekly (on days 1, 8, and 15) for 3 weeks in 4-week cycles, continued until loss of clinical benefit.
  • MPDL3280A could be continued as monotherapy.
  • ORR was assessed by Response Evaluation Criteria In Solid Tumors (RECIST) v1.1.
  • PD-L1 expression was scored at 4 diagnostic levels based on PD-L1 staining on tumor cells and tumor-infiltrating immune cells in an immunohistochemical (IHC) assay.
  • Example 2 A Combination Treatment Regimen of Anti-PD-L1 Antibody and Nab-Paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) as a First-Line Therapy for Patients with mTNBC
  • a combination treatment regimen of MPDL3280A and nab-paclitaxel can serve as a first-line therapy for patients with mTNBC.
  • Patients with histologically documented locally advanced or metastatic TNBC; no prior systemic therapy for advanced TNBC; ECOG performance status of 0 or 1; and measurable disease per RECIST v1.1 may be dosed with MPDL3280A (840 mg) on days 1 and 15, plus nab-paclitaxel (100 mg/m 2 ) on days 1, 8, and 15. All treatments are given on a 28-day cycle. Patients may be stratified by the presence of liver metastases, prior taxane therapy, and the PD-L1 status of tumor-infiltrating immune cells (IC0 vs IC1/2/3), which can be centrally evaluated by IHC. To capture pseudo-progression and delayed responses to MPDL3280A, patients with radiographic progression may continue to receive open-label MPDL3280A alone or with nab-paclitaxel until unacceptable toxicity or loss of clinical benefit.
  • MPDL3280A 840 mg
  • nab-paclitaxel 100 mg/m 2
  • IHC tumor-infiltrating immune cells

Abstract

The invention provides methods and compositions for treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer and for enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. The methods comprise administering a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.

Description

    SEQUENCE LISTING
  • The instant application contains a Sequence Listing which has been submitted electronically in ASCII format and is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety. Said ASCII copy, created on Nov. 7, 2017, is named 50474-119002_Sequence_Listing_11_7_17_ST25 and is 23,460 bytes in size.
  • FIELD OF THE INVENTION
  • This invention relates to methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers and for enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer by administering a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • The provision of two distinct signals to T-cells is a widely accepted model for lymphocyte activation of resting T lymphocytes by antigen-presenting cells (APCs). This model further provides for the discrimination of self from non-self and immune tolerance. The primary signal, or antigen-specific signal, is transduced through the T-cell receptor (TCR) following recognition of foreign antigen peptide presented in the context of the major histocompatibility-complex (MHC). The second signal, or co-stimulatory signal, is delivered to T-cells by co-stimulatory molecules expressed on APCs and induces T-cells to promote clonal expansion, cytokine secretion and effector function. In the absence of co-stimulation, T-cells can become refractory to antigen stimulation, which results in a tolerogenic response to either foreign or endogenous antigens.
  • In the two-signal model, T-cells receive both positive and negative secondary co-stimulatory signals. The regulation of such positive and negative signals is critical to maximize the host's protective immune responses, while maintaining immune tolerance and preventing autoimmunity. Negative secondary signals seem necessary for induction of T-cell tolerance, while positive signals promote T-cell activation. While the simple two-signal model still provides a valid explanation for naïve lymphocytes, a host's immune response is a dynamic process, and co-stimulatory signals can also be provided to antigen-exposed T-cells.
  • The mechanism of co-stimulation is of therapeutic interest because the manipulation of co-stimulatory signals provides a means to either enhance or terminate cell-based immune response. T cell dysfunction or anergy occurs concurrently with an induced and sustained expression of the inhibitory receptor, programmed death 1 polypeptide (PD-1), which binds to ligands that include PD-L1 and PD-L2. PD-L1 is overexpressed in many cancers and is often associated with poor prognosis. The majority of tumor-infiltrating T lymphocytes predominantly express PD-1, in contrast to T lymphocytes in normal tissues and peripheral blood T lymphocytes, indicating that up-regulation of PD-1 on tumor-reactive T cells can contribute to impaired anti-tumor immune responses. This may be due to exploitation of PD-L1 signaling mediated by PD-L1-expressing tumor cells interacting with PD-1-expressing T cells, resulting in attenuation of T cell activation and evasion of immune surveillance. Therefore, inhibition of the PD-L1/PD-1 interaction may enhance CD8+ T cell-mediated killing of tumors.
  • An optimal therapeutic treatment may combine blockade of PD-1 receptor/ligand interaction with an agent that directly inhibits tumor growth. There remains a need for an optimal therapy for treating, stabilizing, preventing, and/or delaying development of various cancers (e.g., locally advanced or metastatic breast, e.g., metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC)).
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • This invention relates to methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers (e.g., metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC)) and for enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer by administering a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
  • In one aspect, the invention features a method for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer (e.g., mTNBC) in an individual comprising administering to the individual an effective amount of a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist, and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • In some embodiments of the above aspect, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to its ligand binding partners. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L1.
  • In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L2. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to both PD-L1 and PD-L2. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is an antibody. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of MDX 1106 (nivolumab), MK-3475 (pembrolizumab), CT-011 (pidilizumab), MEDI-0680 (AMP-514), PDR001, REGN2810, and BGB-108.
  • In other embodiments of the above aspect, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to PD-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to B7-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to both PD-1 and B7-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is an antibody. In some embodiments, the antibody is selected from the group consisting of: MPDL3280A (atezolizumab), YW243.55.S70, MDX-1105, MED14736 (durvalumab), and MSB0010718C (avelumab). In some embodiments, the antibody is MPDL3280A. In some embodiments, MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 700 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks (e.g., about 750 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks, e.g., about 800 mg to about 850 mg every two weeks). In some embodiments, MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 840 mg every two weeks.
  • In some embodiments, the antibody comprises a heavy chain comprising an HVR-H1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:19, HVR-H2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:20, and HVR-H3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:21; and a light chain comprising an HVR-L1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:22, HVR-L2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:23, and HVR-L3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:24. In some embodiments, the antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:25 and a light chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4.
  • In some embodiments of the above aspect, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L2 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an antibody. In some embodiments, the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an immunoadhesin.
  • In any of the preceding embodiments of the above aspect, the locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer may be, without limitation, triple-negative breast cancer (TNBC) or metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC).
  • In any of the preceding embodiments of the above aspect, the individual has locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer or has been diagnosed with locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. In some embodiments, the cancer cells in the individual express PD-L1. In some embodiments, the expression of PD-L1 may be determined by an immunohistochemistry (IHC) assay.
  • In any of the preceding embodiments of the above aspect, the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens (e.g., 0, 1, or 2 prior cytotoxic treatment regimen(s)) for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • In any of the preceding embodiments of the above aspect, the individual has never had prior systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer (e.g., mTNBC). Accordingly, in any of the methods described herein, the administration of an effective amount of a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be a first-line therapy for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • In any of the preceding embodiments of the above aspect, the treatment may result in a response in the individual. In some embodiments, the response is a complete response. In some embodiments, the response is a sustained response after cessation of the treatment. In some embodiments, the response is a complete response that is sustained after cessation of the treatment. In other embodiments, the response is a partial response. In some embodiments, the response is a partial response that is sustained after cessation of the treatment.
  • In any of the preceding embodiments of the above aspect, the taxane is administered before the PD-1 axis binding antagonist, simultaneous with the PD-1 axis binding antagonist, or after the PD-1 axis binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 50 mg/m2 to about 175 mg/m2 every week (e.g., about 75 mg/m2 to about 150 mg/m2 every week, e.g., about 80 mg/m2 to about 125 mg/m2 every week, e.g., about 100 mg/m2 to about 125 mg/m2 every week). In some embodiments, the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 every week. In some embodiments, the taxane is paclitaxel.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a method for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the method comprises a dosing regimen comprising treatment cycles, wherein the individual is administered, on days 1 and 15 of each cycle, a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist at a dose of about 840 mg, and on days 1, 8, and 15 of each cycle, a taxane at a dose of about 100 mg/m2, each cycle being repeated every 28 days. In some embodiments, the cycle is repeated until there is loss of clinical benefit. In some embodiments, cycles are repeated in which only the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is administered. In some embodiments, the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. In some embodiments, the individual has never had prior targeted systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a method of enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer, the method comprising administering an effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane. In some embodiments, CD8+ T cells in the individual have enhanced priming, activation, proliferation, and/or cytolytic activity relative to prior to the administration of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane. In some embodiments, the number of CD8+ T cells is elevated relative to prior to administration of the combination. In some embodiments, the CD8+ T cell is an antigen-specific CD8+ T cell. In some embodiments, Treg function is suppressed relative to prior to the administration of the combination. In some embodiments, T cell exhaustion is decreased relative to prior to the administration of the combination. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • In some embodiments of the above aspect, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to its ligand binding partners. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L1. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L2. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to both PD-L1 and PD-L2. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is an antibody. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of MDX 1106 (nivolumab), MK-3475 (pembrolizumab), CT-011 (pidilizumab), MEDI-0680 (AMP-514), PDR001, REGN2810, and BGB-108.
  • In other embodiments of the above aspect, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to PD-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to B7-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to both PD-1 and B7-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is an antibody. In some embodiments, the antibody is selected from the group consisting of: MPDL3280A (atezolizumab), YW243.55.S70, MDX-1105, MED14736 (durvalumab), and MSB0010718C (avelumab). In some embodiments, the antibody is MPDL3280A. In some embodiments, MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 700 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks (e.g., about 750 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks, e.g., about 800 mg to about 850 mg every two weeks). In some embodiments, MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 840 mg every two weeks.
  • In some embodiments, the antibody comprises a heavy chain comprising an HVR-H1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:19, HVR-H2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:20, and HVR-H3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:21; and a light chain comprising an HVR-L1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:22, HVR-L2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:23, and HVR-L3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:24. In some embodiments, the antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:25 and a light chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4.
  • In other embodiments of the above aspect, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L2 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an antibody. In some embodiments, the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an immunoadhesin.
  • In any of the preceding embodiments of the above aspect, the locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer may be, without limitation, triple-negative breast cancer (TNBC) or metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC).
  • In some embodiments, the cancer cells in the individual express PD-L1. In some embodiments, the expression of PD-L1 may be determined by an immunohistochemistry (IHC) assay.
  • In any of the preceding embodiments of the above aspect, the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens (e.g., 0, 1, or 2 prior cytotoxic treatment regimen(s)) for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • In any of the preceding embodiments of the above aspect, the individual has never had prior systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer (e.g., mTNBC).
  • In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 50 mg/m2 to about 175 mg/m2 every week (e.g., about 75 mg/m2 to about 150 mg/m2 every week, e.g., about 80 mg/m2 to about 125 mg/m2 every week, e.g., about 100 mg/m2 to about 125 mg/m2 every week). In some embodiments, the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 every week. In some embodiments, the taxane is paclitaxel.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a method of enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer, wherein the method comprises a dosing regimen comprising treatment cycles, wherein the individual is administered, on days 1 and 15 of each cycle, a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist at a dose of about 840 mg, and on days 1, 8, and 15 of each cycle, a taxane at a dose of about 100 mg/m2, each cycle being repeated every 28 days. In some embodiments, the CD8+ T cells in the individual have enhanced priming, activation, proliferation, and/or cytolytic activity relative to prior to the administration of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane. In some embodiments, the number of CD8+ T cells is elevated relative to prior to administration of the combination. In some embodiments, the CD8+ T cell is an antigen-specific CD8+ T cell. In some embodiments, Treg function is suppressed relative to prior to the administration of the combination. In some embodiments, T cell exhaustion is decreased relative to prior to the administration of the combination. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • In some embodiments, the locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer may be, without limitation, TNBC or mTNBC. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. In some embodiments, the individual has never had prior targeted systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
  • In some embodiments of any one of the above aspects, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or the taxane are administered intravenously, intramuscularly, subcutaneously, topically, orally, transdermally, intraperitoneally, intraorbitally, by implantation, by inhalation, intrathecally, intraventricularly, or intranasally.
  • In some embodiments of any one of the above aspects, the method may further comprise administering an effective amount of a chemotherapeutic agent.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a use of a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist in the manufacture of a medicament for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the medicament comprises the human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and wherein the treatment comprises administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
  • In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A. In some embodiments, the medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg. In some embodiments, the treatment comprises administration of the medicament once every two weeks to the individual. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the treatment comprises administration of the composition to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every week to the individual. In some embodiments, the medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg, taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), and the treatment comprises administration of the medicament once every two weeks to the individual and administration of the composition once every week to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a use of a taxane in the manufacture of a medicament for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the medicament comprises the taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carder, and wherein the treatment comprises administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the treatment comprises administration of the medicament to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the treatment comprises administration of the medicament once every week to the individual. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A. In some embodiments, the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg. In some embodiments, the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual. In some embodiments, the medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg, and the treatment comprises administration of the medicament once every week and administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual. In some embodiments, the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a composition comprising a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier for use in treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the treatment comprises administration of said composition in combination with a second composition, wherein the second composition comprises a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A. In some embodiments, the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg. In some embodiments, the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the second composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2. In some embodiments, the treatment comprises administration of the second composition once every week to the individual. In some embodiments, the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg, the second composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2, and the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every two weeks and administration of the second composition once every week to the individual.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a composition comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier for use in treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the treatment comprises administration of said composition in combination with a second composition, wherein the second composition comprises a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2. In some embodiments, the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every week to the individual. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A. In some embodiments, the second composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg. In some embodiments, the treatment comprises administration of the second composition once every two weeks to the individual. In some embodiments, the composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2, the second composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg, and the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every week and administration of the second composition once every two weeks to the individual.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a kit comprising a medicament comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and a package insert comprising instructions for administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A. In some embodiments, the medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg. In some embodiments, the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the medicament once every two weeks to the individual. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2. In some embodiments, the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the composition once every week to the individual. In some embodiments, the medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg, the composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2, and the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the medicament once every two weeks and administration of the composition once every week to the individual.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a kit comprising a first medicament comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and a second medicament comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In some embodiments, the kit further comprises a package insert comprising instructions for administration of the first medicament and the second medicament for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A. In some embodiments, the first medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg. In some embodiments, the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the first medicament once every two weeks to the individual. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the second medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2. In some embodiments, the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the second medicament once every week to the individual. In some embodiments, the first medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg, the second medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2, and the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the first medicament once every two weeks and administration of the second medicament once every week to the individual.
  • In another aspect, the invention features a kit comprising a medicament comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and a package insert comprising instructions for administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2. In some embodiments, the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the medicament once every week to the individual. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A. In some embodiments, the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg. In some embodiments, the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual. In some embodiments, the medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2, the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg, and the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the medicament once every week and administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual.
  • In any one of the preceding aspects, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist may be selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist, and a PD-L2 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to its ligand binding partners. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L1. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L2. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to both PD-L1 and PD-L2. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is an antibody. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of MDX 1106 (nivolumab), MK-3475 (pembrolizumab), CT-011 (pidilizumab), MEDI-0680 (AMP-514), PDR001, REGN2810, and BGB-108. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to PD-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to B7-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to both PD-1 and B7-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is an antibody. In some embodiments, the antibody is selected from the group consisting of: MPDL3280A (atezolizumab), YW243.55.S70, MDX-1105, MED14736 (durvalumab), and MSB0010718C (avelumab). In some embodiments, the antibody comprises a heavy chain comprising an HVR-H1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:19, HVR-H2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:20, and HVR-H3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:21; and a light chain comprising an HVR-L1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:22, HVR-L2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:23, and HVR-L3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:24. In some embodiments, the antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:25 and a light chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4.
  • In any one of the preceding aspects, the taxane may be nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel. In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the taxane is paclitaxel.
  • It is to be understood that one, some, or all of the properties of the various embodiments described herein may be combined to form other embodiments of the present invention. These and other aspects of the invention will become apparent to one of skill in the art. These and other embodiments of the invention are further described by the detailed description that follows.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF EMBODIMENTS OF THE INVENTION I. Definitions
  • Before describing the invention in detail, it is to be understood that this invention is not limited to particular compositions or biological systems, which can, of course, vary. It is also to be understood that the terminology used herein is for the purpose of describing particular embodiments only, and is not intended to be limiting.
  • As used in this specification and the appended claims, the singular forms “a,” “an,” and “the” include plural referents unless the content clearly dictates otherwise. Thus, for example, reference to “a molecule” optionally includes a combination of two or more such molecules, and the like.
  • The term “about” as used herein refers to the usual error range for the respective value readily known to the skilled person in this technical field. Reference to “about” a value or parameter herein includes (and describes) embodiments that are directed to that value or parameter per se.
  • It is understood that aspects and embodiments of the invention described herein include “comprising,” “consisting,” and “consisting essentially of” aspects and embodiments.
  • The term “PD-1 axis binding antagonist” refers to a molecule that inhibits the interaction of a PD-1 axis binding partner with either one or more of its binding partner, so as to remove T-cell dysfunction resulting from signaling on the PD-1 signaling axis—with a result being to restore or enhance T-cell function (e.g., proliferation, cytokine production, and/or target cell killing). As used herein, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist includes a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist, and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
  • The term “PD-1 binding antagonist” refers to a molecule that decreases, blocks, inhibits, abrogates or interferes with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-1 with one or more of its binding partners, such as PD-L1 and/or PD-L2. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-1 to one or more of its binding partners. In a specific aspect, the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L1 and/or PD-L2. For example, PD-1 binding antagonists include anti-PD-1 antibodies, antigen-binding fragments thereof, immunoadhesins, fusion proteins, oligopeptides, and other molecules that decrease, block, inhibit, abrogate or interfere with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-1 with PD-L1 and/or PD-L2. In one embodiment, a PD-1 binding antagonist reduces the negative co-stimulatory signal mediated by or through cell surface proteins expressed on T lymphocytes mediated signaling through PD-1 so as render a dysfunctional T-cell less dysfunctional (e.g., enhancing effector responses to antigen recognition). In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is an anti-PD-1 antibody. In a specific aspect, a PD-1 binding antagonist is MDX-1106 (nivolumab) described herein. In another specific aspect, a PD-1 binding antagonist is MK-3475 (pembrolizumab) described herein. In another specific aspect, a PD-1 binding antagonist is CT-011 (pidilizumab) described herein. In another specific aspect, a PD-1 binding antagonist is MEDI-0680 (AMP-514) described herein. In another specific aspect, a PD-1 binding antagonist is PDR001 described herein. In another specific aspect, a PD-1 binding antagonist is REGN2810 described herein. In another specific aspect, a PD-1 binding antagonist is BGB-108 described herein.
  • The term “PD-L1 binding antagonist” refers to a molecule that decreases, blocks, inhibits, abrogates or interferes with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-L1 with either one or more of its binding partners, such as PD-1 and/or B7-1. In some embodiments, a PD-L1 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to its binding partners. In a specific aspect, the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits binding of PD-L1 to PD-1 and/or B7-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonists include anti-PD-L1 antibodies, antigen-binding fragments thereof, immunoadhesins, fusion proteins, oligopeptides and other molecules that decrease, block, inhibit, abrogate or interfere with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-L1 with one or more of its binding partners, such as PD-1 and/or B7-1. In one embodiment, a PD-L1 binding antagonist reduces the negative co-stimulatory signal mediated by or through cell surface proteins expressed on T lymphocytes mediated signaling through PD-L1 so as to render a dysfunctional T-cell less dysfunctional (e.g., enhancing effector responses to antigen recognition). In some embodiments, a PD-L1 binding antagonist is an anti-PD-L1 antibody. In a specific aspect, an anti-PD-L1 antibody is MPDL3280A (atezolizumab, marketed as TECENTRIQ™ with a WHO Drug Information (International Nonproprietary Names for Pharmaceutical Substances), Recommended INN: List 74, Vol. 29, No. 3, 2015 (see page 387)) described herein. In another specific aspect, an anti-PD-L1 antibody is MDX-1105 described herein. In still another specific aspect, an anti-PD-L1 antibody is YW243.55.S70 described herein. In still another specific aspect, an anti-PD-L1 antibody is MED14736 (durvalumab) described herein. In still another specific aspect, an anti-PD-L1 antibody is MSB0010718C (avelumab) described herein.
  • The term “PD-L2 binding antagonist” refers to a molecule that decreases, blocks, inhibits, abrogates or interferes with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-L2 with either one or more of its binding partners, such as PD-1. In some embodiments, a PD-L2 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-L2 to one or more of its binding partners. In a specific aspect, the PD-L2 binding antagonist inhibits binding of PD-L2 to PD-1. In some embodiments, the PD-L2 antagonists include anti-PD-L2 antibodies, antigen binding fragments thereof, immunoadhesins, fusion proteins, oligopeptides and other molecules that decrease, block, inhibit, abrogate or interfere with signal transduction resulting from the interaction of PD-L2 with either one or more of its binding partners, such as PD-1. In one embodiment, a PD-L2 binding antagonist reduces the negative co-stimulatory signal mediated by or through cell surface proteins expressed on T lymphocytes mediated signaling through PD-L2 so as render a dysfunctional T-cell less dysfunctional (e.g., enhancing effector responses to antigen recognition). In some embodiments, a PD-L2 binding antagonist is an immunoadhesin.
  • A “taxane” as used herein is a diterpene which may bind to tubulin, promoting microtubule assembly and stabilization and/or prevent microtubule depolymerization. Taxanes included herein include taxoid 10-deacetylbaccatin III and/or derivatives thereof. Examplary taxanes include, but are not limited to, paclitaxel (i.e., TAXOL®, CAS #33069-62-4), docetaxel (i.e., TAXOTERE®, CAS #114977-28-5), larotaxel, cabazitaxel, milataxel, tesetaxel, and/or orataxel. In some embodiments, the taxane is an albumin-coated nanoparticle (e.g., nano-albumin bound (nab)-paclitaxel, i.e., ABRAXANE® and/or nab-docetaxel, ABI-008). In some embodiments, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some embodiments, the taxane is formulated in CREMAPHOR® (e.g., TAXOL®) and/or in Tween such as polysorbate 80 (e.g., TAXOTERE®).
  • In some embodiments, the taxane is liposome-encapsulated taxane. In some embodiments, the taxane is a prodrug form and/or conjugated form of taxane (e.g., DHA covalently conjugated to paclitaxel, paclitaxel poliglumex, and/or linoleyl carbonate-paclitaxel). In some embodiments, the paclitaxel is formulated with substantially no surfactant (e.g., in the absence of CREMAPHOR and/or Tween-such as TOCOSOL® paclitaxel).
  • The term “dysfunction” in the context of immune dysfunction, refers to a state of reduced immune responsiveness to antigenic stimulation. The term includes the common elements of both “exhaustion” and/or “anergy” in which antigen recognition may occur, but the ensuing immune response is ineffective to control infection or tumor growth.
  • The term “dysfunctional,” as used herein, also includes refractory or unresponsive to antigen recognition, specifically, impaired capacity to translate antigen recognition into down-stream T-cell effector functions, such as proliferation, cytokine production (e.g., IL-2) and/or target cell killing.
  • The term “anergy” refers to the state of unresponsiveness to antigen stimulation resulting from incomplete or insufficient signals delivered through the T-cell receptor (e.g., increase in intracellular Ca+2 in the absence of ras-activation). T cell anergy can also result upon stimulation with antigen in the absence of co-stimulation, resulting in the cell becoming refractory to subsequent activation by the antigen even in the context of co-stimulation. The unresponsive state can often be overridden by the presence of Interleukin-2. Anergic T-cells do not undergo clonal expansion and/or acquire effector functions.
  • The term “exhaustion” refers to T cell exhaustion as a state of T cell dysfunction that arises from sustained TCR signaling that occurs during many chronic infections and cancer. It is distinguished from anergy in that it arises not through incomplete or deficient signaling, but from sustained signaling. It is defined by poor effector function, sustained expression of inhibitory receptors and a transcriptional state distinct from that of functional effector or memory T cells. Exhaustion prevents optimal control of infection and tumors. Exhaustion can result from both extrinsic negative regulatory pathways (e.g., immunoregulatory cytokines) as well as cell intrinsic negative regulatory (costimulatory) pathways (PD-1, B7-H3, B7-H4, etc.).
  • “Enhancing T-cell function” means to induce, cause or stimulate a T-cell to have a sustained or amplified biological function, or renew or reactivate exhausted or inactive T-cells. Examples of enhancing T-cell function include: increased secretion of γ-interferon from CD8+ T-cells, increased proliferation, increased antigen responsiveness (e.g., viral, pathogen, or tumor clearance) relative to such levels before the intervention. In one embodiment, the level of enhancement is as least 50%, alternatively 60%, 70%, 80%, 90%, 100%, 120%, 150%, or 200% enhancement. The manner of measuring this enhancement is known to one of ordinary skill in the art.
  • A “T cell dysfunctional disorder” is a disorder or condition of T-cells characterized by decreased responsiveness to antigenic stimulation. In a particular embodiment, a T-cell dysfunctional disorder is a disorder that is specifically associated with inappropriate increased signaling through PD-1. In another embodiment, a T-cell dysfunctional disorder is one in which T-cells are anergic or have decreased ability to secrete cytokines, proliferate, or execute cytolytic activity. In a specific aspect, the decreased responsiveness results in ineffective control of a pathogen or tumor expressing an immunogen. Examples of T cell dysfunctional disorders characterized by T-cell dysfunction include unresolved acute infection, chronic infection and tumor immunity.
  • “Tumor immunity” refers to the process in which tumors evade immune recognition and clearance. Thus, as a therapeutic concept, tumor immunity is “treated” when such evasion is attenuated, and the tumors are recognized and attacked by the immune system. Examples of tumor recognition include tumor binding, tumor shrinkage and tumor clearance.
  • “Immunogenicity” refers to the ability of a particular substance to provoke an immune response. Tumors are immunogenic and enhancing tumor immunogenicity aids in the clearance of the tumor cells by the immune response. Examples of enhancing tumor immunogenicity include treatment with a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
  • “Sustained response” refers to the sustained effect on reducing tumor growth after cessation of a treatment. For example, the tumor size may remain to be the same or smaller as compared to the size at the beginning of the administration phase. In some embodiments, the sustained response has a duration at least the same as the treatment duration, at least 1.5×, 2.0×, 2.5×, or 3.0× length of the treatment duration.
  • As used herein, “reducing or inhibiting cancer relapse” means to reduce or inhibit tumor or cancer relapse or tumor or cancer progression. As disclosed herein, cancer relapse and/or cancer progression include, without limitation, cancer metastasis.
  • As used herein, “complete response” or “CR” refers to disappearance of all target lesions.
  • As used herein, “partial response” or “PR” refers to at least a 30% decrease in the sum of the longest diameters (SLD) of target lesions, taking as reference the baseline SLD.
  • As used herein, “stable disease” or “SD” refers to neither sufficient shrinkage of target lesions to qualify for PR, nor sufficient increase to qualify for PD, taking as reference the smallest SLD since the treatment started.
  • As used herein, “progressive disease” or “PD” refers to at least a 20% increase in the SLD of target lesions, taking as reference the smallest SLD recorded since the treatment started or the presence of one or more new lesions.
  • As used herein, “progression free survival” (PFS) refers to the length of time during and after treatment during which the disease being treated (e.g., cancer) does not get worse. Progression-free survival may include the amount of time patients have experienced a complete response or a partial response, as well as the amount of time patients have experienced stable disease.
  • As used herein, “overall response rate” or “objective response rate” (ORR) refers to the sum of complete response (CR) rate and partial response (PR) rate.
  • As used herein, “overall survival” (OS) refers to the percentage of individuals in a group who are likely to be alive after a particular duration of time.
  • The term “pharmaceutical formulation” refers to a preparation which is in such form as to permit the biological activity of the active ingredient to be effective, and which contains no additional components which are unacceptably toxic to a subject to which the formulation would be administered. Such formulations are sterile. “Pharmaceutically acceptable” excipients (vehicles, additives) are those which can reasonably be administered to a subject mammal to provide an effective dose of the active ingredient employed.
  • As used herein, the term “treatment” refers to clinical intervention designed to alter the natural course of the individual or cell being treated during the course of clinical pathology. Desirable effects of treatment include decreasing the rate of disease progression, ameliorating or palliating the disease state, and remission or improved prognosis. For example, an individual is successfully “treated” if one or more symptoms associated with cancer are mitigated or eliminated, including, but are not limited to, reducing the proliferation of (or destroying) cancerous cells, decreasing symptoms resulting from the disease, increasing the quality of life of those suffering from the disease, decreasing the dose of other medications required to treat the disease, and/or prolonging survival of individuals.
  • As used herein, “delaying progression” of a disease means to defer, hinder, slow, retard, stabilize, and/or postpone development of the disease (such as cancer). This delay can be of varying lengths of time, depending on the history of the disease and/or individual being treated. As is evident to one skilled in the art, a sufficient or significant delay can, in effect, encompass prevention, in that the individual does not develop the disease. For example, a late stage cancer, such as development of metastasis, may be delayed.
  • An “effective amount” is at least the minimum amount required to effect a measurable improvement or prevention of a particular disorder. An effective amount herein may vary according to factors such as the disease state, age, sex, and weight of the patient, and the ability of the agent to elicit a desired response in the individual. An effective amount is also one in which any toxic or detrimental effects of the treatment are outweighed by the therapeutically beneficial effects. For prophylactic use, beneficial or desired results include results such as eliminating or reducing the risk, lessening the severity, or delaying the onset of the disease, including biochemical, histological and/or behavioral symptoms of the disease, its complications and intermediate pathological phenotypes presenting during development of the disease. For therapeutic use, beneficial or desired results include clinical results such as decreasing one or more symptoms resulting from the disease, increasing the quality of life of those suffering from the disease, decreasing the dose of other medications required to treat the disease, and enhancing effect of another medication such as via targeting, delaying the progression of the disease, and/or prolonging survival. In the case of a cancer or a tumor, an effective amount of the drug may have the effect in reducing the number of cancer cells; reducing the tumor size; inhibiting (i.e., slow to some extent or desirably stop) cancer cell infiltration into peripheral organs: inhibit (i.e., slow to some extent and desirably stop) tumor metastasis; inhibiting to some extent tumor growth; and/or relieving to some extent one or more of the symptoms associated with the disorder. An effective amount can be administered in one or more administrations. For purposes of this invention, an effective amount of drug, compound, or pharmaceutical composition is an amount sufficient to accomplish prophylactic or therapeutic treatment either directly or indirectly. As is understood in the clinical context, an effective amount of a drug, compound, or pharmaceutical composition may or may not be achieved in conjunction with another drug, compound, or pharmaceutical composition. Thus, an “effective amount” may be considered in the context of administering one or more therapeutic agents, and a single agent may be considered to be given in an effective amount if, in conjunction with one or more other agents, a desirable result may be or is achieved.
  • As used herein, “in conjunction with” refers to administration of one treatment modality in addition to another treatment modality. As such, “in conjunction with” refers to administration of one treatment modality before, during, or after administration of the other treatment modality to the individual.
  • A “disorder” is any condition that would benefit from treatment including, but not limited to, chronic and acute disorders or diseases including those pathological conditions which predispose the mammal to the disorder in question.
  • The terms “cell proliferative disorder” and “proliferative disorder” refer to disorders that are associated with some degree of abnormal cell proliferation. In one embodiment, the cell proliferative disorder is cancer. In one embodiment, the cell proliferative disorder is a tumor.
  • The term “tumor,” as used herein, refers to all neoplastic cell growth and proliferation, whether malignant or benign, and all pre-cancerous and cancerous cells and tissues. The terms “cancer,” “cancerous,” “cell proliferative disorder,” “proliferative disorder,” and “tumor” are not mutually exclusive as referred to herein.
  • The terms “cancer” and “cancerous” refer to or describe the physiological condition in mammals that is typically characterized by unregulated cell growth. The term “breast cancer” includes, but is not limited to, HER2+ breast cancer and triple-negative breast cancer (TNBC), which is a form of breast cancer in which the cancer cells are negative for estrogen receptors (ER−), progesterone receptors (PR−), and HER2 (HER2−), and which may be locally advanced, unresectable, and/or metastatic (e.g., metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC)). The methods described herein are suitable for treatment of various stages of cancer, including cancers that are locally advanced and/or metastatic. In cancer staging, locally advanced is generally defined as cancer that has spread from a localized area to nearby tissues and/or lymph nodes. In the Roman numeral staging system, locally advanced usually is classified in Stage II or III. Cancer which is metastatic is a stage where the cancer spreads throughout the body to distant tissues and organs (stage IV).
  • The term “cytotoxic agent” as used herein refers to any agent that is detrimental to cells (e.g., causes cell death, inhibits proliferation, or otherwise hinders a cellular function). Cytotoxic agents include, but are not limited to, radioactive isotopes (e.g., At211, I131, I125, Y90, Re186, Re188, Sm153, Bi212, P32, Pb212 and radioactive isotopes of Lu); chemotherapeutic agents; growth inhibitory agents; enzymes and fragments thereof such as nucleolytic enzymes; and toxins such as small molecule toxins or enzymatically active toxins of bacterial, fungal, plant or animal origin, including fragments and/or variants thereof. Exemplary cytotoxic agents can be selected from anti-microtubule agents, platinum coordination complexes, alkylating agents, antibiotic agents, topoisomerase II inhibitors, antimetabolites, topoisomerase I inhibitors, hormones and hormonal analogues, signal transduction pathway inhibitors, non-receptor tyrosine kinase angiogenesis inhibitors, immunotherapeutic agents, proapoptotic agents, inhibitors of LDH-A, inhibitors of fatty acid biosynthesis, cell cycle signalling inhibitors, HDAC inhibitors, proteasome inhibitors, and inhibitors of cancer metabolism. In one embodiment the cytotoxic agent is a platinum-based chemotherapeutic agent. In one embodiment the cytotoxic agent is an antagonist of EGFR. In one embodiment the cytotoxic agent is N-(3-ethynylphenyl)-6,7-bis(2-methoxyethoxy)quinazolin-4-amine (e.g., erlotinib, TARCEVA™). In one embodiment the cytotoxic agent is a RAF inhibitor. In one embodiment, the RAF inhibitor is a BRAF and/or CRAF inhibitor. In one embodiment the RAF inhibitor is vemurafenib. In one embodiment the cytotoxic agent is a PI3K inhibitor.
  • As used herein, the term “chemotherapeutic agent” includes compounds useful in the treatment of cancer, such as mTNBC. Examples of chemotherapeutic agents include erlotinib (TARCEVA®, Genentech/OSI Pharm.), bortezomib (VELCADE®, Millennium Pharm.), disulfiram, epigallocatechin gallate, salinosporamide A, carfilzomib, 17-AAG (geldanamycin), radicicol, lactate dehydrogenase A (LDH-A), fulvestrant (FASLODEX®, AstraZeneca), sunitib (SUTENT®, Pfizer/Sugen), letrozole (FEMARA®, Novartis), imatinib mesylate (GLEEVEC®, Novartis), finasunate (VATALANIB®, Novartis), oxaliplatin (ELOXATIN®, Sanofi), 5-FU (5-fluorouracil), leucovorin, rapamycin (Sirolimus, RAPAMUNE®, Wyeth), Lapatinib (TYKERB®, GSK572016, Glaxo Smith Kline), lonafamib (SCH 66336), sorafenib (NEXAVAR®, Bayer Labs), gefitinib (IRESSA®, AstraZeneca), AG1478, alkylating agents such as thiotepa and CYTOXAN® cyclosphosphamide; alkyl sulfonates such as busulfan, improsulfan and piposulfan; aziridines such as benzodopa, carboquone, meturedopa, and uredopa; ethylenimines and methylamelamines including altretamine, triethylenemelamine, triethylenephosphoramide, triethylenethiophosphoramide and trimethylomelamine; acetogenins (especially bullatacin and bullatacinone); a camptothecin (including topotecan and irinotecan); bryostatin; callystatin; CC-1065 (including its adozelesin, carzelesin and bizelesin synthetic analogs); cryptophycins (particularly cryptophycin 1 and cryptophycin 8); adrenocorticosteroids (including prednisone and prednisolone); cyproterone acetate; 5α-reductases including finasteride and dutasteride); vorinostat, romidepsin, panobinostat, valproic acid, mocetinostat dolastatin; aldesleukin, talc duocarmycin (including the synthetic analogs, KW-2189 and CB1-TM1); eleutherobin; pancratistatin; a sarcodictyin; spongistatin; nitrogen mustards such as chlorambucil, chlomaphazine, chlorophosphamide, estramustine, ifosfamide, mechlorethamine, mechlorethamine oxide hydrochloride, melphalan, novembichin, phenesterine, prednimustine, trofosfamide, uracil mustard; nitrosoureas such as carmustine, chlorozotocin, fotemustine, lomustine, nimustine, and ranimnustine; antibiotics such as the enediyne antibiotics (e.g., calicheamicin, especially calicheamicin γ1 I and calicheamicin ω1I (Angew Chem. Intl. Ed. Engl. 33:183-186 (1994)); dynemicin, including dynemicin A; bisphosphonates, such as clodronate; an esperamicin; as well as neocarzinostatin chromophore and related chromoprotein enediyne antibiotic chromophores), aclacinomysins, actinomycin, authramycin, azaserine, bleomycins, cactinomycin, carabicin, caminomycin, carzinophilin, chromomycinis, dactinomycin, daunorubicin, detorubicin, 6-diazo-5-oxo-L-norleucine, ADRIAMYCIN® (doxorubicin), morpholino-doxorubicin, cyanomorpholino-doxorubicin, 2-pyrrolino-doxorubicin and deoxydoxorubicin), epirubicin, esorubicin, idarubicin, marcellomycin, mitomycins such as mitomycin C, mycophenolic acid, nogalamycin, olivomycins, peplomycin, porfiromycin, puromycin, quelamycin, rodorubicin, streptonigrin, streptozocin, tubercidin, ubenimex, zinostatin, zorubicin; anti-metabolites such as methotrexate and 5-fluorouracil (5-FU); folic acid analogs such as denopterin, methotrexate, pteropterin, trimetrexate; purine analogs such as fludarabine, 6-mercaptopurine, thiamiprine, thioguanine; pyrimidine analogs such as ancitabine, azacitidine, 6-azauridine, carmofur, cytarabine, dideoxyuridine, doxifluridine, enocitabine, floxuridine; androgens such as calusterone, dromostanolone propionate, epitiostanol, mepitiostane, testoladone; anti-adrenals such as aminoglutethimide, mitotane, trilostane; folic acid replenisher such as frolinic acid; aceglatone; aldophosphamide glycoside; aminolevulinic acid; eniluracil; amsacrine; bestrabucil; bisantrene; edatraxate; defofamine; demecolcine; diaziquone; elfomithine; elliptinium acetate; an epothilone; etoglucid; gallium nitrate; hydroxyurea; lentinan; lonidainine; maytansinoids such as maytansine and ansamitocins; mitoguazone; mitoxantrone; mopidamnol; nitraerine; pentostatin; phenamet; pirarubicin; losoxantrone; podophyllinic acid; 2-ethylhydrazide; procarbazine; PSK® polysaccharide complex (JHS Natural Products, Eugene, Oreg.); razoxane; rhizoxin; sizofuran; spirogermanium; tenuazonic acid; triaziquone; 2,2′,2″-tnchlorotriethylamine; trichothecenes (especially T-2 toxin, verracurin A, roridin A and anguidine); urethan; vindesine; dacarbazine; mannomustine; mitobronitol; mitolactol; pipobroman; gacytosine; arabinoside (“Ara-C”); cyclophosphamide; thiotepa; taxanes; chloranmbucil; GEMZAR® (gemcitabine); 6-thioguanine; mercaptopunne; methotrexate; vinblastine; etoposide (VP-16); ifosfamide; mitoxantrone; vincristine; NAVELBINE® (vinorelbine); novantrone; teniposide; edatrexate; daunomycin; aminopterin; capecitabine (XELODA®); ibandronate; CPT-11; topoisomerase inhibitor RFS 2000; difluoromethylomithine (DMFO); retinoids such as retinoic acid; and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, acids and derivatives of any of the above.
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include “platinum-based” chemotherapeutic agents, which comprise an organic compound which contains platinum as an integral part of the molecule. Typically platinum-based chemotherapeutic agents are coordination complexes of platinum. Platinum-based chemotherapeutic agents are sometimes called “platins” in the art. Examples of platinum-based chemotherapeutic agents include, but are not limited to, carboplatin, cisplatin, and oxaliplatin.
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include (i) anti-hormonal agents that act to regulate or inhibit hormone action on tumors such as anti-estrogens and selective estrogen receptor modulators (SERMs), including, for example, tamoxifen (including NOLVADEX®; tamoxifen citrate), raloxifene, droloxifene, iodoxyfene, 4-hydroxytamoxifen, trioxifene, keoxifene. LY117018, onapristone, and FARESTON® (toremifine citrate); (ii) aromatase inhibitors that inhibit the enzyme aromatase, which regulates estrogen production in the adrenal glands, such as, for example, 4(5)-imidazoles, aminoglutethimide. MEGASE® (megestrol acetate), AROMASIN® (exemestane; Pfizer), formestanie, fadrozole, RIVISOR® (vorozole), FEMARA® (letrozole; Novartis), and ARIMIDEX® (anastrozole; AstraZeneca); (iii) anti-androgens such as flutamide, nilutamide, bicalutamide, leuprolide and goserelin; buserelin, tripterelin, medroxyprogesterone acetate, diethylstilbestrol, premarin, fluoxymesterone, all transretionic acid, fenretinide, as well as troxacitabine (a 1,3-dioxolane nucleoside cytosine analog); (iv) protein kinase inhibitors; (v) lipid kinase inhibitors; (vi) antisense oligonucleotides, particularly those which inhibit expression of genes in signaling pathways implicated in aberrant cell proliferation, such as, for example, PKC-alpha, Ralf and H-Ras; (vii) ribozymes such as VEGF expression inhibitors (e.g., ANGIOZYME®) and HER2 expression inhibitors; (viii) vaccines such as gene therapy vaccines, for example, ALLOVECTIN®, LEUVECTIN®, and VAXID®; PROLEUKIN®, rIL-2; a topoisomerase 1 inhibitor such as LURTOTECAN®; ABARELIX® rmRH; and (ix) pharmaceutically acceptable salts, acids and derivatives of any of the above.
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include antibodies such as alemtuzumab (Campath), bevacizumab (AVASTIN®, Genentech); cetuximab (ERBITUX®, Imclone); panitumumab (VECTIBIX®, Amgen), rituximab (RITUXAN®, Genentech/Biogen Idec), pertuzumab (OMNITARG®, 2C4, Genentech), trastuzumab (HERCEPTIN®, Genentech), tositumomab (Bexxar, Corixia), and the antibody drug conjugate, gemtuzumab ozogamicin (MYLOTARG, Wyeth). Additional humanized monoclonal antibodies with therapeutic potential as agents in combination with the compounds of the invention include: apolizumab, aselizumab, atlizumab, bapineuzumab, bivatuzumab mertansine, cantuzumab mertansine, cedelizumab, certolizumab pegol, cidfusituzumab, cidtuzumab, daclizumab, eculizumab, efalizumab, epratuzumab, erlizumab, felvizumab, fontolizumab, gemtuzumab ozogamicin, inotuzumab ozogamicin, ipilimumab, labetuzumab, lintuzumab, matuzumab, mepolizumab, motavizumab, motovizumab, natalizumab, nimotuzumab, nolovizumab, numavizumab, ocrelizumab, omalizumab, palivizumab, pascolizumab, pecfusituzumab, pectuzumab, pexelizumab, ralivizumab, ranibizumab, reslivizumab, reslizumab, resyvizumab, rovelizumab, ruplizumab, sibrotuzumab, siplizumab, sontuzumab, tacatuzumab tetraxetan, tadocizumab, talizumab, tefibazumab, tocilizumab, toralizumab, tucotuzumab celmoleukin, tucusituzumab, umavizumab, urtoxazumab, ustekinumab, visilizumab, and the anti-interleukin-12 (ABT-874/J695, Wyeth Research and Abbott Laboratories) which is a recombinant exclusively human-sequence, full-length IgG, A antibody genetically modified to recognize interleukin-12 p40 protein.
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include “EGFR inhibitors,” which refers to compounds that bind to or otherwise interact directly with EGFR and prevent or reduce its signaling activity, and is alternatively referred to as an “EGFR antagonist.” Examples of such agents include antibodies and small molecules that bind to EGFR. Examples of antibodies which bind to EGFR include MAb 579 (ATCC CRL HB 8506), MAb 455 (ATCC CRL HB8507), MAb 225 (ATCC CRL 8508), MAb 528 (ATCC CRL 8509) (see, U.S. Pat. No. 4,943,533) and variants thereof, such as chimerized 225 (C225 or Cetuximab; ERBUTIX®) and reshaped human 225 (H225) (see, e.g., WO 96/40210, Imclone Systems Inc.); IMC-11F8, a fully human, EGFR-targeted antibody (Imclone); antibodies that bind type II mutant EGFR (U.S. Pat. No. 5,212,290); humanized and chimeric antibodies that bind EGFR as described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,891,996; and human antibodies that bind EGFR, such as ABX-EGF or Panitumumab (see WO98/50433, Abgenix/Amgen); EMD 55900 (Stragliotto et al., Eur. J. Cancer 32A:636-640 (1996)); EMD7200 (matuzumab) a humanized EGFR antibody directed against EGFR that competes with both EGF and TGF-alpha for EGFR binding (EMD/Merck); human EGFR antibody, HuMax-EGFR (GenMab); fully human antibodies known as E1.1, E2.4, E2.5, E6.2, E6.4, E2.11, E6. 3 and E7.6. 3 and described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,235,883; MDX-447 (Medarex Inc); and mAb 806 or humanized mAb 806 (Johns et al., J. Biol. Chem. 279(29):30375-30384 (2004)). The anti-EGFR antibody may be conjugated with a cytotoxic agent, thus generating an immunoconjugate (see, e.g., EP659439A2, Merck Patent GmbH). EGFR antagonists include small molecules such as compounds described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,616,582, 5,457,105, 5,475,001, 5,654,307, 5,679,683, 6,084,095, 6,265,410, 6,455,534, 6,521,620, 6,596,726, 6,713,484, 5,770,599, 6,140,332, 5,866,572, 6,399,602, 6,344,459, 6,602,863, 6,391,874, 6,344,455, 5,760,041, 6,002,008, and 5,747,498, as well as the following PCT publications: WO98/14451, WO98/50038, WO99/09016, and WO99/24037. Particular small molecule EGFR antagonists include OSI-774 (CP-358774, erlotinib, TARCEVA® Genentech/OSI Pharmaceuticals); PD 183805 (CI 1033, 2-propenamide, N-[4-[(3-chloro-4-fluorophenyl)amino]-7-[3-(4-morpholinyl)propoxy]-6-quinazolinyl]-, dihydrochloride. Pfizer Inc.); ZD1839, gefitinib (IRESSA®) 4-(3′-Chloro-4′-fluoroanilino)-7-methoxy-6-(3-morpholinopropoxy)quinazoline. AstraZeneca); ZM 105180 ((6-amino-4-(3-methylphenyl-amino)-quinazoline, Zeneca); BIBX-1382 (N8-(3-chloro-4-fluoro-phenyl)-N2-(1-methyl-piperidin-4-yl)-pyrimido[5,4-d]pyrimidine-2,8-diamine, Boehringer Ingelheim); PKI-166 ((R)-4-[4-[(1-phenylethyl)amino]-1H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrimidin-6-yl]-phenol); (R)-6-(4-hydroxyphenyl)-4-[(1-phenylethyl)amino]-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d]pyrmidine); CL-387785 (N-[4-[(3-bromophenyl)amino]-6-quinazolinyl]-2-butynamide); EKB-569 (N-[4-[(3-chloro-4-fluorophenyl)amino]-3-cyano-7-ethoxy-6-quinolinyl]-4-(dimethylamino)-2-butenamide) (Wyeth); AG1478 (Pfizer); AG1571 (SU 5271; Pfizer); dual EGFR/HER2 tyrosine kinase inhibitors such as lapatinib (TYKERB®, GSK572016 or N-[3-chloro-4-[(3 fluorophenyl)methoxy]phenyl]-6[5[[[2methylsulfonyl)ethyl]amino]methyl]-2-furanyl]-4-quinazolinamine).
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include “tyrosine kinase inhibitors” including the EGFR-targeted drugs noted in the preceding paragraph; small molecule HER2 tyrosine kinase inhibitor such as TAK165 available from Takeda; CP-724,714, an oral selective inhibitor of the ErbB2 receptor tyrosine kinase (Pfizer and OSI); dual-HER inhibitors such as EKB-569 (available from Wyeth) which preferentially binds EGFR but inhibits both HER2 and EGFR-overexpressing cells; lapatinib (GSK572016; available from Glaxo-SmithKline), an oral HER2 and EGFR tyrosine kinase inhibitor; PKI-166 (available from Novartis); pan-HER inhibitors such as canertinib (CI-1033; Pharmacia); Raf-1 inhibitors such as antisense agent ISIS-5132 available from ISIS Pharmaceuticals which inhibit Raf-1 signaling; non-HER-targeted tyrosine kinase inhibitors such as imatinib mesylate (GLEEVEC®, available from Glaxo SmithKline); multi-targeted tyrosine kinase inhibitors such as sunitinib (SUTENT®, available from Pfizer); VEGF receptor tyrosine kinase inhibitors such as vatalanib (PTK787/ZK222584, available from Novartis/Schering AG); MAPK extracellular regulated kinase I inhibitor CI-1040 (available from Pharmacia); quinazolines, such as PD 153035,4-(3-chloroanilino) quinazoline; pyridopyrimidines; pyrimidopyrimidines; pyrrolopyrimidines, such as CGP 59326, CGP 60261 and CGP 62706; pyrazolopyrimidines, 4-(phenylamino)-7H-pyrrolo[2,3-d] pyrimidines; curcumin (diferuloyl methane, 4,5-bis (4-fluoroanilino)phthalimide); tyrphostines containing nitrothiophene moieties: PD-0183805 (Warner-Lamber); antisense molecules (e.g., those that bind to HER-encoding nucleic acid); quinoxalines (U.S. Pat. No. 5,804,396); tryphostins (U.S. Pat. No. 5,804,396); ZD6474 (Astra Zeneca); PTK-787 (Novartis/Schering AG); pan-HER inhibitors such as CI-1033 (Pfizer); Affinitac (ISIS 3521; Isis/Lilly); imatinib mesylate (GLEEVEC®); PKI 166 (Novartis); GW2016 (Glaxo SmithKline); CI-1033 (Pfizer); EKB-569 (Wyeth); Semaxinib (Pfizer); ZD6474 (AstraZeneca); PTK-787 (Novartis/Schering AG); INC-1C11 (Imclone), rapamycin (sirolimus, RAPAMUNE®); or as described in any of the following patent publications: U.S. Pat. No. 5,804,396; WO 1999/09016 (American Cyanamid); WO 1998/43960 (American Cyanamid); WO 1997/38983 (Warner Lambert); WO 1999/06378 (Wamer Lambert); WO 1999/06396 (Warner Lambert); WO 1996/30347 (Pfizer, Inc); WO 1996/33978 (Zeneca); WO 1996/3397 (Zeneca) and WO 1996/33980 (Zeneca).
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include dexamethasone, interferons, colchicine, metoprine, cyclosporine, amphotericin, metronidazole, alemtuzumab, alitretinoin, allopurinol, amifostine, arsenic trioxide, asparaginase, BCG live, bevacuzimab, bexarotene, cladribine, clofarabine, darbepoetin alfa, denileukin, dexrazoxane, epoetin alfa, elotinib, filgrastim, histrelin acetate, ibritumomab, interferon alfa-2a, interferon alfa-2b, lenalidomide, levamisole, mesna, methoxsalen, nandrolone, nelarabine, nofetumomab, oprelvekin, palifermin, pamidronate, pegademase, pegaspargase, pegfilgrastim, pemetrexed disodium, plicamycin, porfimer sodium, quinacrine, rasburicase, sargramostim, temozolomide, VM-26, 6-TG, toremifene, tretinoin, ATRA, valrubicin, zoledronate, and zoledronic acid, and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include hydrocortisone, hydrocortisone acetate, cortisone acetate, tixocortol pivalate, triamcinolone acetonide, triamcinolone alcohol, mometasone, amcinonide, budesonide, desonide, fluocinonide, fluocinolone acetonide, betamethasone, betamethasone sodium phosphate, dexamethasone, dexamethasone sodium phosphate, fluocortolone, hydrocortisone-17-butyrate, hydrocortisone-17-valerate, aclometasone dipropionate, betamethasone valerate, betamethasone dipropionate, prednicarbate, clobetasone-17-butyrate, clobetasol-17-propionate, fluocortolone caproate, fluocortolone pivalate and fluprednidene acetate; immune selective anti-inflammatory peptides (ImSAIDs) such as phenylalanine-glutamine-glycine (FEG) and its D-isomeric form (feG) (IMULAN BioTherapeutics, LLC); anti-rheumatic drugs such as azathioprine, ciclosporin (cyclosporine A), D-penicillamine, gold salts, hydroxychloroquine, leflunomideminocycline, sulfasalazine, tumor necrosis factor alpha (TNFα) blockers such as etanercept (Enbrel), infliximab (Remicade), adalimumab (Humira), certolizumab pegol (Cimzia), golimumab (Simponi), Interleukin 1 (IL-1) blockers such as anakinra (Kineret), T cell costimulation blockers such as abatacept (Orencia), Interleukin 6 (IL-6) blockers such as tocilizumab (ACTEMERA®); Interleukin 13 (IL-13) blockers such as lebrikizumab; Interferon alpha (IFN) blockers such as rontalizumab; Beta 7 integrin blockers such as rhuMAb Beta7; IgE pathway blockers such as Anti-M1 prime; Secreted homotrimeric LTa3 and membrane bound heterotrimer LTa1/=2 blockers such as Anti-lymphotoxin alpha (LTa); radioactive isotopes (e.g., At211, I131, I125, Y90, Re186, Re188, Sm153, Bi212, P32, Pb212 and radioactive isotopes of Lu); miscellaneous investigational agents such as thioplatin, PS-341, phenylbutyrate, ET-18-OCH3, or famesyl transferase inhibitors (L-739749, L-744832); polyphenols such as quercetin, resveratrol, piceatannol, epigallocatechine gallate, theaflavins, flavanols, procyanidins, betulinic acid and derivatives thereof; autophagy inhibitors such as chloroquine; delta-9-tetrahydrocannabinol (dronabinol, MARINOL®); beta-lapachone; lapachol; colchicines; betulinic acid; acetylcamptothecin, scopolectin, and 9-aminocamptothecin); podophyllotoxin; tegafur (UFTORAL®); bexarotene (TARGRETIN®); bisphosphonates such as clodronate (for example, BONEFOS® or OSTAC®), etidronate (DIDROCAL®). NE-58095, zoledronic acid/zoledronate (ZOMETA®), alendronate (FOSAMAX®), pamidronate (AREDIA®), tiludronate (SKELID®), or risedronate (ACTONEL®); and epidermal growth factor receptor (EGF-R); vaccines such as THERATOPE® vaccine; perifosine, COX-2 inhibitor (e.g., celecoxib or etoricoxib), proteosome inhibitor (e.g. PS341); CCI-779; tipifamib (R11577); orafenib, ABT510; Bcl-2 inhibitor such as oblimersen sodium (GENASENSE®); pixantrone; famesyltransferase inhibitors such as lonafamib (SCH 6636, SARASAR™); and pharmaceutically acceptable salts, acids or derivatives of any of the above; as well as combinations of two or more of the above such as CHOP, an abbreviation for a combined therapy of cyclophosphamide, doxorubicin, vincristine, and prednisolone; and FOLFOX, an abbreviation for a treatment regimen with oxaliplatin (ELOXATIN™) combined with 5-FU and leucovorin.
  • Chemotherapeutic agents also include non-steroidal anti-inflammatory drugs with analgesic, antipyretic and anti-inflammatory effects. NSAIDs include non-selective inhibitors of the enzyme cyclooxygenase. Specific examples of NSAIDs include aspirin, propionic acid derivatives such as ibuprofen, fenoprofen, ketoprofen, flurbiprofen, oxaprozin and naproxen, acetic acid derivatives such as indomethacin, sulindac, etodolac, diclofenac, enolic acid derivatives such as piroxicam, meloxicam, tenoxicam, droxicam, lomoxicam and isoxicam, fenamic acid derivatives such as mefenamic acid, meclofenamic acid, flufenamic acid, tolfenamic acid, and COX-2 inhibitors such as celecoxib, etoricoxib, lumiracoxib, parecoxib, rofecoxib, rofecoxib, and valdecoxib. NSAIDs can be indicated for the symptomatic relief of conditions such as rheumatoid arthritis, osteoarthritis, inflammatory arthropathies, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriatic arthritis, Reiter's syndrome, acute gout, dysmenorrhoea, metastatic bone pain, headache and migraine, postoperative pain, mild-to-moderate pain due to inflammation and tissue injury, pyrexia, ileus, and renal colic.
  • A “growth inhibitory agent” when used herein refers to a compound or composition which inhibits growth of a cell either in vitro or in vivo. In one embodiment, a growth inhibitory agent is growth inhibitory antibody that prevents or reduces proliferation of a cell expressing an antigen to which the antibody binds. In another embodiment, the growth inhibitory agent may be one which significantly reduces the percentage of cells in S phase. Examples of growth inhibitory agents include agents that block cell cycle progression (at a place other than S phase), such as agents that induce G1 arrest and M-phase arrest. Classical M-phase blockers include the vincas (vincristine and vinblastine), taxanes, and topoisomerase II inhibitors such as doxorubicin, epirubicin, daunorubicin, etoposide, and bleomycin. Those agents that arrest G1 also spill over into S-phase arrest, for example, DNA alkylating agents such as tamoxifen, prednisone, dacarbazine, mechlorethamine, cisplatin, methotrexate, 5-fluorouracil, and ara-C. Further information can be found in Mendelsohn and Israel, eds., The Molecular Basis of Cancer, Chapter 1, entitled “Cell cycle regulation, oncogenes, and antineoplastic drugs” by Murakami et al. (W.B. Saunders, Philadelphia, 1995), e.g., p. 13.
  • By “radiation therapy” is meant the use of directed gamma rays or beta rays to induce sufficient damage to a cell so as to limit its ability to function normally or to destroy the cell altogether. It will be appreciated that there will be many ways known in the art to determine the dosage and duration of treatment. Typical treatments are given as a one-time administration and typical dosages range from 10 to 200 units (Grays) per day.
  • An “individual” or a “subject” for purposes of treatment refers to any animal classified as a mammal, including humans, domestic and farm animals, and zoo, sports, or pet animals, such as dogs, horses, cats, cows, etc. Preferably, the mammal is human. A individual or subject may be a patient.
  • The term “antibody” herein is used in the broadest sense and specifically covers monoclonal antibodies (including full length monoclonal antibodies), polyclonal antibodies, multispecific antibodies (e.g., bispecific antibodies), and antibody fragments so long as they exhibit the desired biological activity.
  • An “isolated” antibody is one which has been identified and separated and/or recovered from a component of its natural environment. Contaminant components of its natural environment are materials which would interfere with research, diagnostic or therapeutic uses for the antibody, and may include enzymes, hormones, and other proteinaceous or nonproteinaceous solutes. In some embodiments, an antibody is purified (1) to greater than 95% by weight of antibody as determined by, for example, the Lowry method, and in some embodiments, to greater than 99% by weight; (2) to a degree sufficient to obtain at least 15 residues of N-terminal or internal amino acid sequence by use of, for example, a spinning cup sequenator, or (3) to homogeneity by SDS-PAGE under reducing or nonreducing conditions using, for example, Coomassie blue or silver stain. An isolated antibody includes the antibody in situ within recombinant cells since at least one component of the antibody's natural environment will not be present. Ordinarily, however, an isolated antibody will be prepared by at least one purification step.
  • “Native antibodies” are usually heterotetrameric glycoproteins of about 150,000 daltons, composed of two identical light (L) chains and two identical heavy (H) chains. Each light chain is linked to a heavy chain by one covalent disulfide bond, while the number of disulfide linkages varies among the heavy chains of different immunoglobulin isotypes. Each heavy and light chain also has regularly spaced intrachain disulfide bridges. Each heavy chain has at one end a variable domain (VH) followed by a number of constant domains. Each light chain has a variable domain at one end (VL) and a constant domain at its other end; the constant domain of the light chain is aligned with the first constant domain of the heavy chain, and the light chain variable domain is aligned with the variable domain of the heavy chain. Particular amino acid residues are believed to form an interface between the light chain and heavy chain variable domains.
  • The term “constant domain” refers to the portion of an immunoglobulin molecule having a more conserved amino acid sequence relative to the other portion of the immunoglobulin, the variable domain, which contains the antigen binding site. The constant domain contains the CH1, CH2 and CH3 domains (collectively, CH) of the heavy chain and the CHL (or CL) domain of the light chain.
  • The “variable region” or “variable domain” of an antibody refers to the amino-terminal domains of the heavy or light chain of the antibody. The variable domain of the heavy chain may be referred to as “VH.” The variable domain of the light chain may be referred to as “VL.” These domains are generally the most variable parts of an antibody and contain the antigen-binding sites.
  • The term “variable” refers to the fact that certain portions of the variable domains differ extensively in sequence among antibodies and are used in the binding and specificity of each particular antibody for its particular antigen. However, the variability is not evenly distributed throughout the variable domains of antibodies. It is concentrated in three segments called hypervariable regions (HVRs) both in the light-chain and the heavy-chain variable domains. The more highly conserved portions of variable domains are called the framework regions (FR). The variable domains of native heavy and light chains each comprise four FR regions, largely adopting a beta-sheet configuration, connected by three HVRs, which form loops connecting, and in some cases forming part of, the beta-sheet structure. The HVRs in each chain are held together in close proximity by the FR regions and, with the HVRs from the other chain, contribute to the formation of the antigen-binding site of antibodies (see Kabat et al., Sequences of Proteins of Immunological Interest, Fifth Edition, National Institute of Health, Bethesda, Md. (1991)). The constant domains are not involved directly in the binding of an antibody to an antigen, but exhibit various effector functions, such as participation of the antibody in antibody-dependent cellular toxicity.
  • The “light chains” of antibodies (immunoglobulins) from any mammalian species can be assigned to one of two clearly distinct types, called kappa (“κ”) and lambda (“λ”), based on the amino acid sequences of their constant domains.
  • The term IgG “isotype” or “subclass” as used herein is meant any of the subclasses of immunoglobulins defined by the chemical and antigenic characteristics of their constant regions.
  • Depending on the amino acid sequences of the constant domains of their heavy chains, antibodies (immunoglobulins) can be assigned to different classes. There are five major classes of immunoglobulins: IgA, IgD, IgE, IgG, and IgM, and several of these may be further divided into subclasses (isotypes), e.g., IgG1, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4, IgA1, and IgA2. The heavy chain constant domains that correspond to the different classes of immunoglobulins are called α, γ, ε, γ, and μ, respectively. The subunit structures and three-dimensional configurations of different classes of immunoglobulins are well known and described generally in, for example, Abbas et al. Cellular and Mol. Immunology, 4th ed. (W.B. Saunders, Co., 2000). An antibody may be part of a larger fusion molecule, formed by covalent or non-covalent association of the antibody with one or more other proteins or peptides.
  • The terms “full-length antibody,” “intact antibody,” and “whole antibody” are used herein interchangeably to refer to an antibody in its substantially intact form, not antibody fragments as defined below. The terms particularly refer to an antibody with heavy chains that contain an Fc region.
  • A “naked antibody” for the purposes herein is an antibody that is not conjugated to a cytotoxic moiety or radiolabel.
  • “Antibody fragments” comprise a portion of an intact antibody, preferably comprising the antigen-binding region thereof. In some embodiments, the antibody fragment described herein is an antigen-binding fragment. Examples of antibody fragments include Fab, Fab′, F(ab′)2, and Fv fragments; diabodies; linear antibodies; single-chain antibody molecules; and multispecific antibodies formed from antibody fragments.
  • Papain digestion of antibodies produces two identical antigen-binding fragments, called “Fab” fragments, each with a single antigen-binding site, and a residual “Fc” fragment, whose name reflects its ability to crystallize readily. Pepsin treatment yields an F(ab′)2 fragment that has two antigen-combining sites and is still capable of cross-linking antigen.
  • “Fv” is the minimum antibody fragment which contains a complete antigen-binding site. In one embodiment, a two-chain Fv species consists of a dimer of one heavy- and one light-chain variable domain in tight, non-covalent association. In a single-chain Fv (scFv) species, one heavy- and one light-chain variable domain can be covalently linked by a flexible peptide linker such that the light and heavy chains can associate in a “dimeric” structure analogous to that in a two-chain Fv species. It is in this configuration that the three HVRs of each variable domain interact to define an antigen-binding site on the surface of the VH-VL dimer. Collectively, the six HVRs confer antigen-binding specificity to the antibody. However, even a single variable domain (or half of an Fv comprising only three HVRs specific for an antigen) has the ability to recognize and bind antigen, although at a lower affinity than the entire binding site.
  • The Fab fragment contains the heavy- and light-chain variable domains and also contains the constant domain of the light chain and the first constant domain (CH1) of the heavy chain. Fab′ fragments differ from Fab fragments by the addition of a few residues at the carboxy terminus of the heavy chain CH1 domain including one or more cysteines from the antibody hinge region. Fab′-SH is the designation herein for Fab′ in which the cysteine residue(s) of the constant domains bear a free thiol group. F(ab′)2 antibody fragments originally were produced as pairs of Fab′ fragments which have hinge cysteines between them. Other chemical couplings of antibody fragments are also known.
  • “Single-chain Fv” or “scFv” antibody fragments comprise the VH and VL domains of antibody, wherein these domains are present in a single polypeptide chain. Generally, the scFv polypeptide further comprises a polypeptide linker between the VH and VL domains which enables the scFv to form the desired structure for antigen binding. For a review of scFv, see, e.g., PluckthUn, in The Pharmacology of Monoclonal Antibodies, vol. 113, Rosenburg and Moore eds., (Springer-Verlag, New York, 1994), pp. 269-315.
  • The term “diabodies” refers to antibody fragments with two antigen-binding sites, which fragments comprise a heavy-chain variable domain (VH) connected to a light-chain variable domain (VL) in the same polypeptide chain (VH-VL). By using a linker that is too short to allow pairing between the two domains on the same chain, the domains are forced to pair with the complementary domains of another chain and create two antigen-binding sites. Diabodies may be bivalent or bispecific. Diabodies are described more fully in, for example, EP 404,097; WO 1993/01161; Hudson et al., Nat. Med. 9:129-134 (2003); and Hollinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 90: 6444-6448 (1993). Triabodies and tetrabodies are also described in Hudson et al., Nat. Med. 9:129-134 (2003).
  • The term “monoclonal antibody” as used herein refers to an antibody obtained from a population of substantially homogeneous antibodies, e.g., the individual antibodies comprising the population are identical except for possible mutations, e.g., naturally occurring mutations, that may be present in minor amounts. Thus, the modifier “monoclonal” indicates the character of the antibody as not being a mixture of discrete antibodies. In certain embodiments, such a monoclonal antibody typically includes an antibody comprising a polypeptide sequence that binds a target, wherein the target-binding polypeptide sequence was obtained by a process that includes the selection of a single target binding polypeptide sequence from a plurality of polypeptide sequences. For example, the selection process can be the selection of a unique clone from a plurality of clones, such as a pool of hybridoma clones, phage clones, or recombinant DNA clones. It should be understood that a selected target binding sequence can be further altered, for example, to improve affinity for the target, to humanize the target binding sequence, to improve its production in cell culture, to reduce its immunogenicity in vivo, to create a multispecific antibody, etc., and that an antibody comprising the altered target binding sequence is also a monoclonal antibody of this invention. In contrast to polyclonal antibody preparations, which typically include different antibodies directed against different determinants (epitopes), each monoclonal antibody of a monoclonal antibody preparation is directed against a single determinant on an antigen. In addition to their specificity, monoclonal antibody preparations are advantageous in that they are typically uncontaminated by other immunoglobulins.
  • The modifier “monoclonal” indicates the character of the antibody as being obtained from a substantially homogeneous population of antibodies, and is not to be construed as requiring production of the antibody by any particular method. For example, the monoclonal antibodies to be used in accordance with the invention may be made by a variety of techniques, including, for example, the hybridoma method (e.g., Kohler and Milstein, Nature, 256:495-97 (1975); Hongo et al., Hybridoma, 14 (3): 253-260 (1995), Harlow et al., Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, 2nd ed. 1988); Hammerling et al., in: Monoclonal Antibodies and T-Cell Hybridomas 563-681 (Elsevier, N.Y., 1981)), recombinant DNA methods (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,816,567), phage-display technologies (see, e.g., Clackson et al., Nature, 352: 624-628 (1991); Marks et al., J. Mol. Biol. 222: 581-597 (1992); Sidhu et al., J. Mol. Biol. 338(2): 299-310 (2004); Lee et al., J. Mol. Biol. 340(5): 1073-1093 (2004); Fellouse, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 101(34): 12467-12472 (2004); and Lee et al., J. Immunol. Methods 284(1-2): 119-132 (2004), and technologies for producing human or human-like antibodies in animals that have parts or all of the human immunoglobulin loci or genes encoding human immunoglobulin sequences (see, e.g., WO 1998/24893; WO 1996/34096; WO 1996/33735; WO 1991/10741; Jakobovits et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 90: 2551 (1993); Jakobovits et al., Nature 362: 255-258 (1993); Bruggemann et al., Year in Immunol. 7:33 (1993); U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,545,807; 5,545,806; 5,569,825; 5,625,126; 5,633,425; and U.S. Pat. No. 5,661,016; Marks et al., Bio/Technology 10: 779-783 (1992); Lonberg et al., Nature 368: 856-859 (1994); Morrison, Nature 368: 812-813 (1994); Fishwild et al., Nature Biotechnol. 14: 845-851 (1996); Neuberger, Nature Biotechnol. 14: 826 (1996); and Lonberg et al., Intern. Rev. Immunol. 13: 65-93 (1995).
  • The monoclonal antibodies herein specifically include “chimeric” antibodies in which a portion of the heavy and/or light chain is identical with or homologous to corresponding sequences in antibodies derived from a particular species or belonging to a particular antibody class or subclass, while the remainder of the chain(s) is identical with or homologous to corresponding sequences in antibodies derived from another species or belonging to another antibody class or subclass, as well as fragments of such antibodies, so long as they exhibit the desired biological activity (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,816,567; and Morrison et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 81:6851-6855 (1984)). Chimeric antibodies include PRIMATTZED® antibodies wherein the antigen-binding region of the antibody is derived from an antibody produced by, e.g., immunizing macaque monkeys with the antigen of interest.
  • “Humanized” forms of non-human (e.g., murine) antibodies are chimeric antibodies that contain minimal sequence derived from non-human immunoglobulin. In one embodiment, a humanized antibody is a human immunoglobulin (recipient antibody) in which residues from a HVR of the recipient are replaced by residues from a HVR of a non-human species (donor antibody) such as mouse, rat, rabbit, or nonhuman primate having the desired specificity, affinity, and/or capacity. In some instances, FR residues of the human immunoglobulin are replaced by corresponding non-human residues. Furthermore, humanized antibodies may comprise residues that are not found in the recipient antibody or in the donor antibody. These modifications may be made to further refine antibody performance. In general, a humanized antibody will comprise substantially all of at least one, and typically two, variable domains, in which all or substantially all of the hypervariable loops correspond to those of a non-human immunoglobulin, and all or substantially all of the FRs are those of a human immunoglobulin sequence. The humanized antibody optionally will also comprise at least a portion of an immunoglobulin constant region (Fc), typically that of a human immunoglobulin. For further details, see, e.g., Jones et al., Nature 321:522-525 (1986); Riechmann et al., Nature 332:323-329 (1988); and Presta, Curr. Op. Struct. Biol. 2:593-596 (1992). See also, for example, Vaswani and Hamilton, Ann. Allergy, Asthma & Immunol. 1:105-115 (1998); Harris, Biochem. Soc. Transactions 23:1035-1038 (1995); Hurle and Gross, Curr. Op. Biotech. 5:428-433 (1994); and U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,982,321 and 7,087,409.
  • A “human antibody” is one which possesses an amino acid sequence which corresponds to that of an antibody produced by a human and/or has been made using any of the techniques for making human antibodies as disclosed herein. This definition of a human antibody specifically excludes a humanized antibody comprising non-human antigen-binding residues. Human antibodies can be produced using various techniques known in the art, including phage-display libraries. Hoogenboom and Winter, J. Mol. Biol., 227:381 (1991); Marks et al., J. Mol. Biol., 222:581 (1991). Also available for the preparation of human monoclonal antibodies are methods described in Cole et al., Monoclonal Antibodies and Cancer Therapy, Alan R. Liss, p. 77 (1985); Boemer et al., J. Immunol., 147(1):86-95 (1991). See also van Dijk and van de Winkel, Curr. Opin. Pharmacol., 5: 368-74 (2001). Human antibodies can be prepared by administering the antigen to a transgenic animal that has been modified to produce such antibodies in response to antigenic challenge, but whose endogenous loci have been disabled, e.g., immunized xenomice (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,075,181 and 6,150,584 regarding XENOMOUSE™ technology). See also, for example, Li et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 103:3557-3562 (2006) regarding human antibodies generated via a human B-cell hybridoma technology.
  • A “species-dependent antibody” is one which has a stronger binding affinity for an antigen from a first mammalian species than it has for a homologue of that antigen from a second mammalian species. Normally, the species-dependent antibody “binds specifically” to a human antigen (e.g., has a binding affinity (Kd) value of no more than about 1×10−7 M, preferably no more than about 1×10−8 M and preferably no more than about 1×10−9 M) but has a binding affinity for a homologue of the antigen from a second nonhuman mammalian species which is at least about 50 fold, or at least about 500 fold, or at least about 1000 fold, weaker than its binding affinity for the human antigen. The species-dependent antibody can be any of the various types of antibodies as defined above, but preferably is a humanized or human antibody.
  • The term “hypervariable region,” “HVR,” or “HV,” when used herein refers to the regions of an antibody variable domain which are hypervariable in sequence and/or form structurally defined loops. Generally, antibodies comprise six HVRs; three in the VH (H1, H2, H3), and three in the VL (L1, L2, L3). In native antibodies, H3 and L3 display the most diversity of the six HVRs, and H3 in particular is believed to play a unique role in conferring fine specificity to antibodies. See, e.g., Xu et al., Immunity 13:37-45 (2000); Johnson and Wu, in Methods in Molecular Biology 248:1-25 (Lo, ed., Human Press, Totowa, N.J., 2003). Indeed, naturally occurring camelid antibodies consisting of a heavy chain only are functional and stable in the absence of light chain. See, e.g., Hamers-Casterman et al., Nature 363:446-448 (1993); Sheriff et al., Nature Struct. Biol. 3:733-736 (1996).
  • A number of HVR delineations are in use and are encompassed herein. The Kabat Complementarity Determining Regions (CDRs) are based on sequence variability and are the most commonly used (Kabat et al., Sequences of Proteins of Immunological Interest, 5th Ed. Public Health Service, National Institutes of Health, Bethesda, Md. (1991)). Chothia refers instead to the location of the structural loops (Chothia and Lesk J. Mol. Biol. 196:901-917 (1987)). The AbM HVRs represent a compromise between the Kabat HVRs and Chothia structural loops, and are used by Oxford Molecular's AbM antibody modeling software. The “contact” HVRs are based on an analysis of the available complex crystal structures. The residues from each of these HVRs are noted below.
  • Loop Kabat AbM Chothia Contact
    L1 L24-L34 L24-L34 L26-L32 L30-L36
    L2 L50-L56 L50-L56 L50-L52 L46-L55
    L3 L89-L97 L89-L97 L91-L96 L89-L96
    H1 H31-H35B H26-H35B H26-H32 H30-H35B
    (Kabat Numbering)
    H1 H31-H35 H26-H35 H26-H32 H30-H35
    (Chothia Numbering)
    H2 H50-H65 H50-H58 H53-H55 H47-H58
    H3 H95-H102 H95-H102 H96-H101 H93-H101
  • HVRs may comprise “extended HVRs” as follows: 24-36 or 24-34 (L1), 46-56 or 50-56 (L2) and 89-97 or 89-96 (L3) in the VL and 26-35 (H1), 50-65 or 49-65 (H2) and 93-102, 94-102, or 95-102 (H3) in the VH. The variable domain residues are numbered according to Kabat et al., supra, for each of these definitions.
  • “Framework” or “FR” residues are those variable domain residues other than the HVR residues as herein defined.
  • The term “variable domain residue numbering as in Kabat” or “amino acid position numbering as in Kabat,” and variations thereof, refers to the numbering system used for heavy chain variable domains or light chain variable domains of the compilation of antibodies in Kabat et al., supra. Using this numbering system, the actual linear amino acid sequence may contain fewer or additional amino acids corresponding to a shortening of, or insertion into, a FR or HVR of the variable domain. For example, a heavy chain variable domain may include a single amino acid insert (residue 52a according to Kabat) after residue 52 of H2 and inserted residues (e.g. residues 82a, 82b, and 82c, etc. according to Kabat) after heavy chain FR residue 82. The Kabat numbering of residues may be determined for a given antibody by alignment at regions of homology of the sequence of the antibody with a “standard” Kabat numbered sequence.
  • The Kabat numbering system is generally used when referring to a residue in the variable domain (approximately residues 1-107 of the light chain and residues 1-113 of the heavy chain) (e.g., Kabat et al., Sequences of Immunological Interest. 5th Ed. Public Health Service, National Institutes of Health, Bethesda, Md. (1991)). The “EU numbering system” or “EU index” is generally used when referring to a residue in an immunoglobulin heavy chain constant region (e.g., the EU index reported in Kabat et al., supra). The “EU index as in Kabat” refers to the residue numbering of the human IgG1 EU antibody.
  • The expression “linear antibodies” refers to the antibodies described in Zapata et al. (1995 Protein Eng, 8(10):1057-1062). Briefly, these antibodies comprise a pair of tandem Fd segments (VH-CH1-VH-CH1) which, together with complementary light chain polypeptides, form a pair of antigen binding regions. Linear antibodies can be bispecific or monospecific.
  • As used herein, the term “binds”, “specifically binds to” or is “specific for” refers to measurable and reproducible interactions such as binding between a target and an antibody, which is determinative of the presence of the target in the presence of a heterogeneous population of molecules including biological molecules. For example, an antibody that binds to or specifically binds to a target (which can be an epitope) is an antibody that binds this target with greater affinity, avidity, more readily, and/or with greater duration than it binds to other targets. In one embodiment, the extent of binding of an antibody to an unrelated target is less than about 10% of the binding of the antibody to the target as measured, e.g., by a radioimmunoassay (RIA). In certain embodiments, an antibody that specifically binds to a target has a dissociation constant (Kd) of ≦1 μM, ≦100 nM, ≦10 nM, ≦1 nM, or ≦0.1 nM. In certain embodiments, an antibody specifically binds to an epitope on a protein that is conserved among the protein from different species. In another embodiment, specific binding can include, but does not require exclusive binding.
  • II. PD-1 Axis Binding Antagonists
  • Provided herein are methods for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer (e.g., mTNBC) in an individual comprising administering to the individual an effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane. Also provided herein are methods of enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer (e.g., mTNBC) comprising administering to the individual an effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an taxane. For example, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist includes a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist and a PD-L2 binding antagonist. PD-1 (programmed death 1) is also referred to in the art as “programmed cell death 1,” “PDCD1,” “CD279,” and “SLEB2.” An exemplary human PD-1 is shown in UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot Accession No. Q15116. PD-L1 (programmed death ligand 1) is also referred to in the art as “programmed cell death 1 ligand 1,” “PDCD1 LG1,” “CD274,” “B7-H,” and “PDL1.” An exemplary human PD-L1 is shown in UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot Accession No. Q9NZQ7.1. PD-L2 (programmed death ligand 2) is also referred to in the art as “programmed cell death 1 ligand 2,” “PDCDILG2,” “CD273,” “B7-DC,” “Btdc,” and “PDL2.” An exemplary human PD-L2 is shown in UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot Accession No. Q9BQ51. In some embodiments, PD-1, PD-L1, and PD-L2 are human PD-1, PD-L1 and PD-L2.
  • In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-1 to its ligand binding partners. In a specific aspect the PD-1 ligand binding partners are PD-L1 and/or PD-L2. In another embodiment, a PD-L1 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to its binding partners. In a specific aspect, PD-L1 binding partners are PD-1 and/or B7-1. In another embodiment, the PD-L2 binding antagonist is a molecule that inhibits the binding of PD-L2 to its binding partners. In a specific aspect, a PD-L2 binding partner is PD-1. The antagonist may be an antibody, an antigen binding fragment thereof, an immunoadhesin, a fusion protein, or oligopeptide.
  • In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is an anti-PD-1 antibody (e.g., a human antibody, a humanized antibody, or a chimeric antibody). In some embodiments, the anti-PD-1 antibody is selected from the group consisting of MDX 1106 (nivolumab), MK-3475 (pembrolizumab), CT-011 (pidilizumab), MEDI-0680 (AMP-514), PDR001, REGN2810, and BGB-108. In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is an immunoadhesin (e.g., an immunoadhesin comprising an extracellular or PD-1 binding portion of PD-L1 or PD-L2 fused to a constant region (e.g., an Fc region of an immunoglobulin sequence). In some embodiments, the PD-1 binding antagonist is AMP-224. In some embodiments, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is anti-PD-L1 antibody. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is selected from the group consisting of MPDL3280A, YW243.55.S70, MDX-1105, MEDI4736 (durvalumab), and MSB0010718C (avelumab). Antibody YW243.55.S70 is an anti-PD-L1 described in WO 2010/077634. MDX-1105, also known as BMS-936559, is an anti-PD-L1 antibody described in WO02007/005874. MED14736 is an anti-PD-L1 monoclonal antibody described in WO2011/066389 and US2013/034559. MDX-1106, also known as MDX-1106-04, ONO-4538, BMS-936558, or nivolumab, is an anti-PD-1 antibody described in WO2006/121168. MK-3475, also known as lambrolizumab, is an anti-PD-1 antibody described in WO2009/114335. CT-011, also known as hBAT, hBAT-1 or pidilizumab, is an anti-PD-1 antibody described in WO2009/101611. AMP-224, also known as B7-DCIg, is a PD-L2-Fc fusion soluble receptor described in WO2010/027827 and WO2011/066342.
  • In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is an anti-PD-L1 antibody. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is capable of inhibiting binding between PD-L1 and PD-1 and/or between PD-L1 and B7-1. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a monoclonal antibody. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is an antibody fragment selected from the group consisting of Fab, Fab′-SH, Fv, scFv, and (Fab′)2 fragments. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a humanized antibody. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a human antibody.
  • Examples of anti-PD-L1 antibodies useful for the methods of this invention, and methods for making thereof are described in PCT patent application WO 2010/077634, WO 2007/005874. WO 2011/066389, and US 2013/034559, which are incorporated herein by reference. The anti-PD-L1 antibodies useful in this invention, including compositions containing such antibodies, may be used in combination with a taxane to treat cancer.
  • Anti-PD-1 Antibodies
  • In some embodiments, the anti-PD-1 antibody is MDX-1106. Alternative names for “MDX-1106” include MDX-1106-04, ONO-4538, BMS-936558, or nivolumab. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-1 antibody is nivolumab (CAS Registry Number: 946414-94-4). In a still further embodiment, provided is an isolated anti-PD-1 antibody comprising a heavy chain variable region comprising the heavy chain variable region amino acid sequence from SEQ ID NO: 1 and/or a light chain variable region comprising the light chain variable region amino acid sequence from SEQ ID NO:2. In a still further embodiment, provided is an isolated anti-PD-1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and/or a light chain sequence, wherein:
  • (a) the heavy chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the heavy chain sequence:
  • (SEQ ID NO: 1)
    QVQLVESGGGVVQPGRSLRLDCKASGITFSNSGMHWVRQAPGKGLEWVAV
    IWYDGSKRYYADSVKGRFTISRDNSKNTLFLQMNSLRAEDTAVYYCATND
    DYWGQGTLVTVSSASTKGPSVFPLAPCSRSTSESTAALGCLVKDYFPEPV
    TVSWNSGALTSGVHTFPAVLQSSGLYSLSSVVTVPSSSLGTKTYTCNVDH
    KPSNTKVDKRVESKYGPPCPPCPAPEFLGGPSVFLFPPKPKDTLMISRTP
    EVTCVVVDVSQEDPEVQFNWYVDGVEVHNAKTKPREEQFNSTYRVVSVLT
    VLHQDWLNGKEYKCKVSNKGLPSSIEKTISKAKGQPREPQVYTLPPSQEE
    MTKNQVSLTCLVKGFYPSDIAVEWESNGQPENNYKTTPPVLDSDGSFFLY
    SRLTVDKSRWQEGNVFSCSVMHEALHNHYTQKSLSLSLGK,

    and
  • (b) the light chain sequences has at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the light chain sequence:
  • (SEQ ID NO: 2)
    EIVLTQSPATLSLSPGERATLSCRASQSVSSYLAWYQQKPGQAPRLLIYD
    ASNRATGIPARFSGSGSGTDFTLTISSLEPEDFAVYYCQQSSNWPRTFGQ
    GTKVEIKRTVAAPSVFIFPPSDEQLKSGTASVVCLLNNFYPREAKVQWKV
    DNALQSGNSQESVTEQDSKDSTYSLSSTLTLSKADYEKHKVYACEVTHQG
    LSSPVTKSFNRGEC.
  • Anti-PD-L1 Antibodies
  • In some embodiments, the antibody in the formulation comprises at least one tryptophan (e.g., at least two, at least three, or at least four) in the heavy and/or light chain sequence. In some embodiments, amino acid tryptophan is in the HVR regions, framework regions and/or constant regions of the antibody. In some embodiments, the antibody comprises two or three tryptophan residues in the HVR regions. In some embodiments, the antibody in the formulation is an anti-PD-L1 antibody. PD-L1 (programmed death ligand 1), also known as PDL1, B7-H1, B7-4, CD274, and B7-H, is a transmembrane protein, and its interaction with PD-1 inhibits T-cell activation and cytokine production. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody described herein binds to human PD-L1. Examples of anti-PD-L1 antibodies that can be used in the methods described herein are described in PCT patent application WO 2010/077634 A1 and U.S. Pat. No. 8,217,149, which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
  • In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is capable of inhibiting binding between PD-L1 and PD-1 and/or between PD-L1 and B7-1. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a monoclonal antibody. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is an antibody fragment selected from the group consisting of Fab, Fab′-SH, Fv, scFv, and (Fab′)2 fragments. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a humanized antibody. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody is a human antibody.
  • Anti-PD-L1 antibodies described in WO 2010/077634 A1 and U.S. Pat. No. 8,217,149 may be used in the methods described herein. In some embodiments, the anti-PD-L1 antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region sequence of SEQ ID NO:3 and/or a light chain variable region sequence of SEQ ID NO:4. In a still further embodiment, provided is an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain variable region and/or a light chain variable region sequence, wherein:
  • (a) the heavy chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97% at least 98% A, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the heavy chain sequence:
  • (SEQ ID NO: 3)
    EVQLVESGGGLVQPGGSLRLSCAASGFTFSDSWIHWVRQAPGKGLEWVAW
    ISPYGGSTYYADSVKGRFTISADTSKNTAYLQMNSLRAEDTAVYYCARRH
    WPGGFDYWGQGTLVTVSA,

    and
  • (b) the light chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the light chain sequence:
  • (SEQ ID NO: 4)
    DIQMTQSPSSLSASVGDRVTITCRASQDVSTAVAWYQQKPGKAPKLLIYS
    ASFLYSGVPSRFSGSGSGTDFTLTISSLQPEDFATYYCQQYLYHPATFGQ
    GTKVEIKR.
  • In one embodiment, the anti-PD-L1 antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region comprising an HVR-H1, HVR-H2 and HVR-H3 sequence, wherein:
  • (a)
    (SEQ ID NO: 5)
    the HVR-H1 sequence is GFTFSX1SWIH;
    (b)
    (SEQ ID NO: 6)
    the HVR-H2 sequence is AWIX2PYGGSX3YYADSVKG;
    (c)
    (SEQ ID NO: 7)
    the HVR-H3 sequence is RHWPGGFDY;
  • further wherein: X1 is D or G; X2 is S or L; X3 is T or S. In one specific aspect, X1 is D; X2 is S and X3 is T.
  • In another aspect, the polypeptide further comprises variable region heavy chain framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs according to the formula: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4). In yet another aspect, the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences. In a further aspect, the framework sequences are VH subgroup III consensus framework. In a still further aspect, at least one of the framework sequences is the following:
  • (SEQ ID NQ: 8)
    HC-FR1 is EVQLVESGGGLVQPGGSLRLSCAAS
    (SEQ ID NQ: 9)
    HC-FR2 is WVRQAPGKGLEWV
    (SEQ ID NO: 10)
    HC-FR3 is RFTISADTSKNTAYLQMNSLRAEDTAVYYCAR
    (SEQ ID NO: 11)
    HC-FR4 is WGQGTLVTVSA.
  • In a still further aspect, the heavy chain polypeptide is further combined with a variable region light chain comprising an HVR-L1, HVR-L2 and HVR-L3, wherein:
  • (a)
    (SEQ ID NO: 12)
    the HVR-L1 sequence is RASQX4X5X6TX7X8A;
    (b)
    (SEQ ID NO: 13)
    the HVR-L2 sequence is SASX9LX10S,;
    (c)
    (SEQ ID NO: 14)
    the HVR-L3 sequence is QQX11X12X13X14PX15T;

    wherein: X4 is D or V; X5 is V or I; X8 is S or N; X7 is A or F; X8 is V or L; X9 is F or T; X10 is Y or A; X11 is Y, G, F, or S; X12 is L, Y, F orW; X13 is Y, N, A, T, G, F or I; X14 is H, V, P, T or I; X15 is A, W, R, P or T. In a still further aspect, X4 is D; Xs is V; X6 is S; X7 is A; X8 is V; X9 is F; X10 is Y; X11 is Y; X12 is L; X13 is Y; X14 is H; X15 is A.
  • In a still further aspect, the light chain further comprises variable region light chain framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs according to the formula: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4). In a still further aspect, the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences. In a still further aspect, the framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework. In a still further aspect, at least one of the framework sequence is the following:
  • (SEQ ID NO: 15)
    LC-FR1 is DIQMTQSPSSLSASVGDRVTITC
    (SEQ ID NO: 16)
    LC-FR2 is WYQQKPGKAPKLLIY
    (SEQ ID NO: 17)
    LC-FR3 is GVPSRFSGSGSGTDFTLTISSLQPEDFATYYC
    (SEQ ID NO: 18)
    LC-FR4 is FGQGTKVEIKR.
  • In another embodiment, provided is an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody or antigen binding fragment comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein:
  • (a) the heavy chain comprises an HVR-H1, HVR-H2 and HVR-H3, wherein further:
  • (i)
    (SEQ ID NO: 5)
    the HVR-H1 sequence is GFTFSX1SWIH;
    (ii)
    (SEQ ID NO: 6)
    the HVR-H2 sequence is AWIX2PYGGSX3YYADSVKG
    (iii)
    (SEQ ID NO: 7)
    the HVR-H3 sequence is RHWPGGFDY,
    and
  • (b) the light chain comprises an HVR-L1, HVR-L2 and HVR-L3, wherein further.
  • (i)
    (SEQ ID NO: 12)
    the HVR-L1 sequence is RASQX4X5X6TX7X8A
    (ii)
    (SEQ ID NO: 13)
    the HVR-L2 sequence is SASX9LX10S;
    and
    (iii)
    (SEQ ID NO: 14)
    the HVR-L3 sequence is QQX11X12X13X14PX15T;

    wherein: X1 is D or G; X2 is S or L; X3 is T or S; X4 is D or V; X5 is V or I; X6 is S or N; X7 is A or F; X8 is V or L; X9 is F or T; X10 is Y or A; X11 is Y, G, F, or S; X12 is L, Y, F or W; X13 is Y, N, A, T, G, F or I; X14 is H, V, P, T or I; X15 is A, W, R, P or T. In a specific aspect, X1 is D; X12 is S and X13 is T. In another aspect. X4 is D; X5 is V; X6 is S; X7 is A; X8 is V; X9 is F; X10 is Y; X11 is Y; X12 is L; X13 is Y; X14 is H; X15 is A. In yet another aspect, X1 is D; X2 is S and X3 is T, X4 is D; X5 is V; X6 is S; X7 is A; X8 is V; X9 is F; X10 is Y; X11 is Y; X12 is L; X13 is Y; X14 is H and X15 is A.
  • In a further aspect, the heavy chain variable region comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4), and the light chain variable regions comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4). In a still further aspect, the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences. In a still further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat subgroup I, II, or III sequence. In a still further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequence is a VH subgroup III consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the heavy chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 8, 9, 10 and 11. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat kappa I, II, II or IV subgroup sequence. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the light chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 15, 16, 17 and 18.
  • In a still further specific aspect, the antibody further comprises a human or murine constant region. In a still further aspect, the human constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4. In a still further specific aspect, the human constant region is IgG1. In a still further aspect, the murine constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2A, IgG2B, IgG3. In a still further aspect, the murine constant region if IgG2A. In a still further specific aspect, the antibody has reduced or minimal effector function. In a still further specific aspect the minimal effector function results from an “effector-less Fc mutation” or aglycosylation. In still a further embodiment, the effector-less Fc mutation is an N297A or D265A/N297A substitution in the constant region.
  • In yet another embodiment, provided is an anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein:
      • (a) the heavy chain further comprises an HVR-H1, HVR-H2 and an HVR-H3 sequence having at least 85% sequence identity to GFTFSDSWIH (SEQ ID NO:19), AWISPYGGSTYYADSVKG (SEQ ID NO:20) and RHWPGGFDY (SEQ ID NO:21), respectively, or
      • (b) the light chain further comprises an HVR-L1, HVR-L2 and an HVR-L3 sequence having at least 85% sequence identity to RASQDVSTAVA (SEQ ID NO:22), SASFLYS (SEQ ID NO:23) and QQYLYHPAT (SEQ ID NO:24), respectively.
  • In a specific aspect, the sequence identity is 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or 100%.
  • In another aspect, the heavy chain variable region comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4), and the light chain variable regions comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4). In yet another aspect, the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences. In a still further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat subgroup I, II, or III sequence. In a still further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequence is a VH subgroup III consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the heavy chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 8. 9, 10 and 11. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat kappa I, II, II or IV subgroup sequence. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the light chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 15, 16, 17 and 18.
  • In a still further specific aspect, the antibody further comprises a human or murine constant region. In a still further aspect, the human constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4. In a still further specific aspect, the human constant region is IgG1. In a still further aspect, the murine constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2A, IgG2B, IgG3. In a still further aspect, the murine constant region if IgG2A. In a still further specific aspect, the antibody has reduced or minimal effector function. In a still further specific aspect the minimal effector function results from an “effector-less Fc mutation” or aglycosylation. In still a further embodiment, the effector-less Fc mutation is an N297A or D265A/N297A substitution in the constant region.
  • In another further embodiment, provided is an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein:
  • (a) the heavy chain sequence has at least 85% sequence identity to the heavy chain sequence:
  • (SEQ ID NO: 25)
    EVQLVESGGGLVQPGGSLRLSCAASGFTFSDSWIHWVRQAPGKGLEWVAW
    ISPYGGSTYYADSVKGRFTISADTSKNTAYLQMNSLRAEDTAVYYCARRH
    WPGGFDYWGQGTLVTVSS,

    and/or
  • (b) the light chain sequences has at least 85% sequence identity to the light chain sequence:
  • (SEQ ID NO: 4)
    DIQMTQSPSSLSASVGDRVTITCRASQDVSTAVAWYQQKPGKAPKLLIYS
    ASFLYSGVPSRFSGSGSGTDFTLTISSLQPEDFATYYCQQYLYHPATFGQ
    GTKVEIKR.
  • In a specific aspect, the sequence identity is 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or 100%. In another aspect, the heavy chain variable region comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4), and the light chain variable regions comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4). In yet another aspect, the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences. In a further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat subgroup I, II, or III sequence. In a still further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequence is a VH subgroup III consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the heavy chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 8, 9, 10 and WGQGTLVTVSS (SEQ ID NO:27).
  • In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat kappa I, II, II or IV subgroup sequence. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the light chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 15, 16, 17 and 18.
  • In a still further specific aspect, the antibody further comprises a human or murine constant region. In a still further aspect, the human constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4. In a still further specific aspect, the human constant region is IgG1. In a still further aspect, the murine constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2A. IgG2B, IgG3. In a still further aspect, the murine constant region if IgG2A. In a still further specific aspect, the antibody has reduced or minimal effector function. In a still further specific aspect, the minimal effector function results from production in prokaryotic cells. In a still further specific aspect the minimal effector function results from an “effector-less Fc mutation” or aglycosylation. In still a further embodiment, the effector-less Fc mutation is an N297A or D265A/N297A substitution in the constant region.
  • In a further aspect, the heavy chain variable region comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4), and the light chain variable regions comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4). In a still further aspect, the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences. In a still further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat subgroup I, II, or III sequence. In a still further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequence is a VH subgroup III consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the heavy chain framework sequences is the following:
  • HC-FR1
    (SEQ ID NO: 29)
    EVQLVESGGGLVQPGGSLRLSCAASGFTFS
    HC-FR2
    (SEQ ID NO: 30)
    WVRQAPGKGLEWVA
    HC-FR3
    (SEQ ID NO: 10)
    RFTISADTSKNTAYLQMNSLRAEDTAVYYCAR
    HC-FR4
    (SEQ ID NO: 27)
    WGQGTLVTVSS.
  • In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat kappa I, II, II or IV subgroup sequence. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the light chain framework sequences is the following:
  • LC-FR1
    (SEQ ID NO: 15)
    DIQMTQSPSSLSASVGDRVTITC
    LC-FR2
    (SEQ ID NO: 16)
    WYQQKPGKAPKLLIY
    LC-FR3
    (SEQ ID NO: 17)
    GVPSRFSGSGSGTDFTLTISSLQPEDFATYYC
    LC-FR4
    (SEQ ID NO: 28)
    FGQGTKVEIK.
  • In a still further specific aspect, the antibody further comprises a human or murine constant region. In a still further aspect, the human constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4. In a still further specific aspect, the human constant region is IgG1. In a still further aspect, the murine constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2A, IgG2B, IgG3. In a still further aspect, the murine constant region if IgG2A. In a still further specific aspect, the antibody has reduced or minimal effector function. In a still further specific aspect the minimal effector function results from an “effector-less Fc mutation” or aglycosylation. In still a further embodiment, the effector-less Fc mutation is an N297A or D265A/N297A substitution in the constant region.
  • In yet another embodiment, provided is an anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein:
  • (c) the heavy chain further comprises an HVR-H1, HVR-H2 and an HVR-H3 sequence having at least 85% sequence identity to GFTFSDSWIH (SEQ ID NO:19), AWISPYGGSTYYADSVKG (SEQ ID NO:20) and RHWPGGFDY (SEQ ID NO:21), respectively, and/or
  • (d) the light chain further comprises an HVR-L1, HVR-L2 and an HVR-L3 sequence having at least 85% sequence identity to RASQDVSTAVA (SEQ ID NO:22), SASFLYS (SEQ ID NO:23) and QQYLYHPAT (SEQ ID NO:24), respectively.
  • In a specific aspect, the sequence identity is 86%, 87%, 88%, 89%, 90%, 91%, 92%, 93%, 94%, 95%, 96%, 97%, 98%, 99% or 100%.
  • In another aspect, the heavy chain variable region comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (HC-FR1)-(HVR-H1)-(HC-FR2)-(HVR-H2)-(HC-FR3)-(HVR-H3)-(HC-FR4), and the light chain variable regions comprises one or more framework sequences juxtaposed between the HVRs as: (LC-FR1)-(HVR-L1)-(LC-FR2)-(HVR-L2)-(LC-FR3)-(HVR-L3)-(LC-FR4). In yet another aspect, the framework sequences are derived from human consensus framework sequences. In a still further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat subgroup I, II, or III sequence. In a still further aspect, the heavy chain framework sequence is a VH subgroup III consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the heavy chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 8, 9, 10 and WGQGTLVTVSSASTK (SEQ ID NO:31).
  • In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are derived from a Kabat kappa I, II, II or IV subgroup sequence. In a still further aspect, the light chain framework sequences are VL kappa I consensus framework. In a still further aspect, one or more of the light chain framework sequences are set forth as SEQ ID NOs: 15, 16, 17 and 18. In a still further specific aspect, the antibody further comprises a human or murine constant region. In a still further aspect, the human constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2, IgG2, IgG3, IgG4. In a still further specific aspect, the human constant region is IgG1. In a still further aspect, the murine constant region is selected from the group consisting of IgG1, IgG2A, IgG2B, IgG3. In a still further aspect, the murine constant region if IgG2A. In a still further specific aspect, the antibody has reduced or minimal effector function. In a still further specific aspect the minimal effector function results from an “effector-less Fc mutation” or aglycosylation. In still a further embodiment, the effector-less Fc mutation is an N297A or D265A/N297A substitution in the constant region.
  • In a still further embodiment, provided is an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence wherein:
  • (a) the heavy chain sequence has at least 85% sequence identity to the heavy chain sequence:
  • (SEQ ID NO: 26)
    EVQLVESGGGLVQPGGSLRLSCAASGFTFSDSWIHWVRQAPGKGLEWVAW
    ISPYGGSTYYADSVKGRFTISADTSKNTAYLQMNSLRAEDTAVYYCARRH
    WPGGFDYWGQGTLVTVSSASTK,

    or
  • (b) the light chain sequences has at least 85% sequence identity to the light chain sequence
  • (SEQ ID NO: 4)
    DIQMTQSPSSLSASVGDRVTITCRASQDVSTAVAWYQQKPGKAPKLLIYS
    ASFLYSGVPSRFSGSGSGTDFTLTISSLQPEDFATYYCQQYLYHPATFGQ
    GTKVEIKR.
  • In some embodiments, provided is an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein the light chain variable region sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4. In some embodiments, provided is an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein the heavy chain variable region sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99% or 100% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:26. In some embodiments, provided is an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain variable region sequence, wherein the light chain variable region sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4 and the heavy chain variable region sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, at least 99%, or 100% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:26. In some embodiments, one, two, three, four or five amino acid residues at the N-terminal of the heavy and/or light chain may be deleted, substituted or modified.
  • In a still further embodiment, provided is an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain sequence, wherein:
  • (a) the heavy chain sequence has at least 85% sequence identity to the heavy chain sequence:
  • and/or
  • (SEQ ID NO: 32)
    EVQLVESGGGLVQPGGSLRLSCAASGFTFSDSWIHWVRQAPGKGLEWVAW
    ISPYGGSTYYADSVKGRFTISADTSKNTAYLQMNSLRAEDTAVYYCARRH
    WPGGFDYWGQGTLVTVSSASTKGPSVFPLAPSSKSTSGGTAALGCLVKDY
    FPEPVTVSWNSGALTSGVHTFPAVLQSSGLYSLSSVVTVPSSSLGTQTYI
    CNVNHKPSNTKVDKKVEPKSCDKTHTCPPCPAPELLGGPSVFLFPPKPKD
    TLMISRTPEVTCVVVDVSHEDPEVKFNWYVDGVEVHNAKTKPREEQYAST
    YRVVSVLTVLHQDWLNGKEYKCKVSNKALPAPIEKTISKAKGQPREPQVY
    TLPPSREEMTKNQVSLTCLVKGFYPSDIAVEWESNGQPENNYKTTPPVLD
    SDGSFFLYSKLTVDKSRWQQGNVFSCSVMHEALHNHYTQKSLSLSPG,
  • (b) the light chain sequences has at least 85% sequence identity to the light chain sequence:
  • (SEQ ID NO: 33)
    DIQMTQSPSSLSASVGDRVTITCRASQDVSTAVAWYQQKPGKAPKLLIYS
    ASFLYSGVPSRFSGSGSGTDFTLTISSLQPEDFATYYCQQYLYHPATFGQ
    GTKVEIKRTVAAPSVFIFPPSDEQLKSGTASVVCLLNNFYPREAKVQWKV
    DNALQSGNSQESVTEQDSKDSTYSLSSTLTLSKADYEKHKVYACEVTHQG
    LSSPVTKSFNRGEC.
  • In some embodiments, provided is an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain sequence, wherein the light chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at east 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, or at least 99% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:33. In some embodiments, provided is an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain sequence, wherein the heavy chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, or at least 99% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:32. In some embodiments, provided is an isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody comprising a heavy chain and a light chain sequence, wherein the light chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, or at least 99% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:33 and the heavy chain sequence has at least 85%, at least 86%, at least 87%, at least 88%, at least 89%, at least 90%, at least 91%, at least 92%, at least 93%, at least 94%, at least 95%, at least 96%, at least 97%, at least 98%, or at least 99% sequence identity to the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:32.
  • In some embodiments, the isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody is aglycosylated. Glycosylation of antibodies is typically either N-linked or O-linked. N-linked refers to the attachment of the carbohydrate moiety to the side chain of an asparagine residue. The tripeptide sequences asparagine-X-serine and asparagine-X-threonine, where X is any amino acid except proline, are the recognition sequences for enzymatic attachment of the carbohydrate moiety to the asparagine side chain. Thus, the presence of either of these tripeptide sequences in a polypeptide creates a potential glycosylation site. O-linked glycosylation refers to the attachment of one of the sugars N-aceylgalactosamine, galactose, or xylose to a hydroxyamino acid, most commonly serine or threonine, although 5-hydroxyproline or 5-hydroxylysine may also be used. Removal of glycosylation sites form an antibody is conveniently accomplished by altering the amino acid sequence such that one of the above-described tripeptide sequences (for N-linked glycosylation sites) is removed. The alteration may be made by substitution of an asparagine, serine or threonine residue within the glycosylation site another amino acid residue (e.g., glycine, alanine or a conservative substitution).
  • In any of the embodiments herein, the isolated anti-PD-L1 antibody can bind to a human PD-L1, for example a human PD-L1 as shown in UniProtKB/Swiss-Prot Accession No. Q9NZQ7.1, or a variant thereof.
  • In a still further embodiment, provided is an isolated nucleic acid encoding any of the antibodies described herein. In some embodiments, the nucleic acid further comprises a vector suitable for expression of the nucleic acid encoding any of the previously described anti-PD-L1 antibodies. In a still further specific aspect, the vector is in a host cell suitable for expression of the nucleic acid. In a still further specific aspect, the host cell is a eukaryotic cell or a prokaryotic cell. In a still further specific aspect, the eukaryotic cell is a mammalian cell, such as Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) cell.
  • The antibody or antigen binding fragment thereof, may be made using methods known in the art, for example, by a process comprising culturing a host cell containing nucleic acid encoding any of the previously described anti-PD-L1 antibodies or antigen-binding fragment in a form suitable for expression, under conditions suitable to produce such antibody or fragment, and recovering the antibody or fragment.
  • III. Antibody Preparation
  • The antibodies described herein are prepared using techniques available in the art for generating antibodies, exemplary methods of which are described in more detail in the following sections.
  • The antibody is directed against an antigen of interest (e.g., PD-L1 (such as a human PD-L1), PD1 (such as human PD-L1). PD-L2 (such as human PD-L2), etc.). Preferably, the antigen is a biologically important polypeptide and administration of the antibody to a mammal suffering from a disorder can result in a therapeutic benefit in that mammal.
  • In certain embodiments, an antibody provided herein has a dissociation constant (Kd) of ≦1 μM, ≦150 nM, ≦100 nM, ≦50 nM, ≦10 nM, ≦1 nM, ≦0.1 nM, ≦0.01 nM, or ≦0.001 nM (e.g. 10−5 M or less, e.g. from 10−8 M to 10−13 M, e.g., from 10−9 M to 10−13 M).
  • In one embodiment, Kd is measured by a radiolabeled antigen binding assay (RIA) performed with the Fab version of an antibody of interest and its antigen as described by the following assay. Solution binding affinity of Fabs for antigen is measured by equilibrating Fab with a minimal concentration of (125I)-labeled antigen in the presence of a titration series of unlabeled antigen, then capturing bound antigen with an anti-Fab antibody-coated plate (see, e.g., Chen et al., J. Mol. Biol. 293:865-881(1999)). To establish conditions for the assay, MICROTITER® multi-well plates (Thermo Scientific) are coated overnight with 5 μg/ml of a capturing anti-Fab antibody (Cappel Labs) in 50 mM sodium carbonate (pH 9.6), and subsequently blocked with 2% (w/v) bovine serum albumin in PBS for two to five hours at room temperature (approximately 23° C.). In a non-adsorbent plate (Nunc #269620), 100 μM or 26 μM [125I]-antigen are mixed with serial dilutions of a Fab of interest. The Fab of interest is then incubated overnight; however, the incubation may continue for a longer period (e.g., about 65 hours) to ensure that equilibrium is reached. Thereafter, the mixtures are transferred to the capture plate for incubation at room temperature (e.g., for one hour). The solution is then removed and the plate washed eight times with 0.1% polysorbate 20 (TWEEN-20®) in PBS. When the plates have dried, 150 μl/well of scintillant (MICROSCINT-20™; Packard) is added, and the plates are counted on a TOPCOUNT™ gamma counter (Packard) for ten minutes. Concentrations of each Fab that give less than or equal to 20% of maximal binding are chosen for use in competitive binding assays.
  • According to another embodiment, Kd is measured using surface plasmon resonance assays using a BIACORE-2000 or a BIACORE®-3000 (BIAcore, Inc., Piscataway, N.J.) at 25° C. with immobilized antigen CM5 chips at approximately 10 response units (RU). Briefly, carboxymethylated dextran biosensor chips (CM5, BIACORE, Inc.) are activated with N-ethyl-N′-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-carbodiimide hydrochloride (EDC) and N-hydroxysuccinimide (NHS) according to the supplier's instructions. Antigen is diluted with 10 mM sodium acetate, pH 4.8, to 5 μg/ml (approximately 0.2 μM) before injection at a flow rate of 5 μl/minute to achieve approximately 10 response units (RU) of coupled protein. Following the injection of antigen, 1 M ethanolamine is injected to block unreacted groups. For kinetics measurements, two-fold serial dilutions of Fab (0.78 nM to 500 nM) are injected in PBS with 0.05% polysorbate 20 (TWEEN-20™) surfactant (PBST) at 25° C. at a flow rate of approximately 25 μl/min. Association rates (kon) and dissociation rates (koff) are calculated using a simple one-to-one Langmuir binding model (BIACORE® Evaluation Software version 3.2) by simultaneously fitting the association and dissociation sensorgrams. The equilibrium dissociation constant (Kd) is calculated as the ratio kon/koff See, e.g., Chen et al., J. Mol. Biol. 293:865-881 (1999). If the on-rate exceeds 106 M−1 s−1 by the surface plasmon resonance assay above, then the on-rate can be determined by using a fluorescent quenching technique that measures the increase or decrease in fluorescence emission intensity (excitation=295 nm; emission=340 nm, 16 nm band-pass) at 25° C. of a 20 nM anti-antigen antibody (Fab form) in PBS, pH 7.2, in the presence of increasing concentrations of antigen as measured in a spectrometer, such as a stop-flow equipped spectrophometer (Aviv Instruments) or a 8000-series SLM-AMINCO™ spectrophotometer (ThermoSpectronic) with a stirred cuvette.
  • (i) Antigen Preparation
  • Soluble antigens or fragments thereof, optionally conjugated to other molecules, can be used as immunogens for generating antibodies. For transmembrane molecules, such as receptors, fragments of these (e.g., the extracellular domain of a receptor) can be used as the immunogen. Alternatively, cells expressing the transmembrane molecule can be used as the immunogen. Such cells can be derived from a natural source (e.g., cancer cell lines) or may be cells which have been transformed by recombinant techniques to express the transmembrane molecule. Other antigens and forms thereof useful for preparing antibodies will be apparent to those in the art.
  • (ii) Certain Antibody-Based Methods
  • Polyclonal antibodies are preferably raised in animals by multiple subcutaneous (sc) or intraperitoneal (i.p.) injections of the relevant antigen and an adjuvant. It may be useful to conjugate the relevant antigen to a protein that is immunogenic in the species to be immunized, e.g., keyhole limpet hemocyanin, serum albumin, bovine thyroglobulin, or soybean trypsin inhibitor using a bifunctional or derivatizing agent, for example, maleimidobenzoyl sulfosuccinimide ester (conjugation through cysteine residues), N-hydroxysuccinimide (through lysine residues), glutaraidehyde, succinic anhydride, SOCl2, or R1N═C═NR, where R and R1 are different alkyl groups.
  • Animals are immunized against the antigen, immunogenic conjugates, or derivatives by combining, e.g., 100 μg or 5 μg of the protein or conjugate (for rabbits or mice, respectively) with 3 volumes of Freund's complete adjuvant and injecting the solution intradermally at multiple sites. One month later the animals are boosted with 1/5 to 1/10 the original amount of peptide or conjugate in Freund's complete adjuvant by subcutaneous injection at multiple sites. Seven to 14 days later the animals are bled and the serum is assayed for antibody titer. Animals are boosted until the titer plateaus. Preferably, the animal is boosted with the conjugate of the same antigen, but conjugated to a different protein and/or through a different cross-linking reagent. Conjugates also can be made in recombinant cell culture as protein fusions. Also, aggregating agents such as alum are suitably used to enhance the immune response.
  • Monoclonal antibodies of the invention can be made using the hybridoma method first described by Kohler et al., Nature, 256:495 (1975), and further described, for example, in Hongo et al., Hybridoma, 14 (3): 253-260 (1995), Harlow et al., Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual. (Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, 2nd ed. 1988); Hammerling et al., in: Monoclonal Antibodies and T-Cell Hybridomas 563-681 (Elsevier. N.Y., 1981), and Ni, Xiandai Mianyixue, 26(4):265-268 (2006) regarding human-human hybridomas. Additional methods include those described, for example, in U.S. Pat. No. 7,189,826 regarding production of monoclonal human natural IgM antibodies from hybridoma cell lines. Human hybridoma technology (Trioma technology) is described in Vollmers and Brandlein, Histology and Histopathology, 20(3):927-937 (2005) and Vollmers and Brandlein, Methods and Findings in Experimental and Clinical Pharmacology, 27(3):185-91 (2005).
  • For various other hybridoma techniques, see, for example, U.S. Patent Publication Nos. 2006/258841; 2006/183887 (fully human antibodies), 2006/059575; 2005/287149; 2005/100546; and 2005/026229; and U.S. Pat. Nos. 7,078,492 and 7,153,507. An exemplary protocol for producing monoclonal antibodies using the hybridoma method is described as follows. In one embodiment, a mouse or other appropriate host animal, such as a hamster, is immunized to elicit lymphocytes that produce or are capable of producing antibodies that will specifically bind to the protein used for immunization. Antibodies are raised in animals by multiple subcutaneous (SC) or intraperitoneal (IP) injections of a polypeptide of the invention or a fragment thereof, and an adjuvant, such as monophosphoryl lipid A (MPL)/trehalose dicrynomycolate (TDM) (Ribi Immunochem. Research, Inc., Hamilton, Mont.). A polypeptide of the invention (e.g., antigen) or a fragment thereof may be prepared using methods well known in the art, such as recombinant methods, some of which are further described herein. Serum from immunized animals is assayed for anti-antigen antibodies, and booster immunizations are optionally administered. Lymphocytes from animals producing anti-antigen antibodies are isolated. Alternatively, lymphocytes may be immunized in vitro.
  • Lymphocytes are then fused with myeloma cells using a suitable fusing agent, such as polyethylene glycol, to form a hybridoma cell. See, e.g., Goding, Monoclonal Antibodies: Principles and Practice, pp. 59-103 (Academic Press, 1986). Myeloma cells may be used that fuse efficiently, support stable high-level production of antibody by the selected antibody-producing cells, and are sensitive to a medium such as HAT medium. Exemplary myeloma cells include, but are not limited to, murine myeloma lines, such as those derived from MOPC-21 and MPC-11 mouse tumors available from the Salk Institute Cell Distribution Center, San Diego, Calif. USA, and SP-2 or X63-Ag8-653 cells available from the American Type Culture Collection, Rockville, Md. USA. Human myeloma and mouse-human heteromyeloma cell lines also have been described for the production of human monoclonal antibodies (Kozbor, J. Immunol., 133:3001 (1984); Brodeur et al., Monoclonal Antibody Production Techniques and Applications, pp. 51-63 (Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, 1987)).
  • The hybridoma cells thus prepared are seeded and grown in a suitable culture medium, e.g., a medium that contains one or more substances that inhibit the growth or survival of the unfused, parental myeloma cells. For example, if the parental myeloma cells lack the enzyme hypoxanthine guanine phosphoribosyl transferase (HGPRT or HPRT), the culture medium for the hybridomas typically will include hypoxanthine, aminopterin, and thymidine (HAT medium), which substances prevent the growth of HGPRT-deficient cells. Preferably, serum-free hybridoma cell culture methods are used to reduce use of animal-derived serum such as fetal bovine serum, as described, for example, in Even et al., Trends in Biotechnology, 24(3), 105-108 (2006).
  • Oligopeptides as tools for improving productivity of hybridoma cell cultures are described in Franek, Trends in Monoclonal Antibody Research, 111-122 (2005). Specifically, standard culture media are enriched with certain amino acids (alanine, serine, asparagine, proline), or with protein hydrolyzate fractions, and apoptosis may be significantly suppressed by synthetic oligopeptides, constituted of three to six amino acid residues. The peptides are present at millimolar or higher concentrations.
  • Culture medium in which hybridoma cells are growing may be assayed for production of monoclonal antibodies that bind to an antibody of the invention. The binding specificity of monoclonal antibodies produced by hybridoma cells may be determined by immunoprecipitation or by an in vitro binding assay, such as radioimmunoassay (RIA) or enzyme-linked immunosorbent assay (ELISA). The binding affinity of the monoclonal antibody can be determined, for example, by Scatchard analysis. See, e.g., Munson et al., Anal. Biochem., 107:220 (1980).
  • After hybridoma cells are identified that produce antibodies of the desired specificity, affinity, and/or activity, the clones may be subcloned by limiting dilution procedures and grown by standard methods. See, e.g., Goding, supra. Suitable culture media for this purpose include, for example, D-MEM or RPMI-1640 medium. In addition, hybridoma cells may be grown in vivo as ascites tumors in an animal. Monoclonal antibodies secreted by the subclones are suitably separated from the culture medium, ascites fluid, or serum by conventional immunoglobulin purification procedures such as, for example, protein A-Sepharose, hydroxylapatite chromatography, gel electrophoresis, dialysis, or affinity chromatography. One procedure for isolation of proteins from hybridoma cells is described in US 2005/176122 and U.S. Pat. No. 6,919,436. The method includes using minimal salts, such as lyotropic salts, in the binding process and preferably also using small amounts of organic solvents in the elution process.
  • (iii) Library-Derived Antibodies
  • Antibodies of the invention may be isolated by screening combinatorial libraries for antibodies with the desired activity or activities. For example, a variety of methods are known in the art for generating phage display libraries and screening such libraries for antibodies possessing the desired binding characteristics. Additional methods are reviewed, e.g., in Hoogenboom et al., in Methods in Molecular Biology 178:1-37 (O'Brien et al., ed., Human Press, Totowa, N.J., 2001) and further described, e.g., in McCafferty et al., Nature 348:552-554; Clackson et al., Nature 352: 624-628 (1991); Marks et al., J. Mol. Biol. 222: 581-597 (1992); Marks and Bradbury, in Methods in Molecular Biology 248:161-175 (Lo, ed., Human Press, Totowa, N.J., 2003); Sidhu et al., J. Mol. Biol. 338(2): 299-310 (2004); Lee et al., J. Mol. Biol. 340(5): 1073-1093 (2004); Fellouse, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 101(34): 12467-12472 (2004); and Lee et al., J. Immunol. Methods 284(1-2): 119-132(2004).
  • In certain phage display methods, repertoires of VH and VL genes are separately cloned by polymerase chain reaction (PCR) and recombined randomly in phage libraries, which can then be screened for antigen-binding phage as described in Winter et al., Ann. Rev. Immunol., 12: 433-455 (1994). Phage typically display antibody fragments, either as single-chain Fv (scFv) fragments or as Fab fragments. Libraries from immunized sources provide high-affinity antibodies to the immunogen without the requirement of constructing hybridomas. Alternatively, the naive repertoire can be cloned (e.g., from human) to provide a single source of antibodies to a wide range of non-self and also self-antigens without any immunization as described by Griffiths et al., EMBO J, 12: 725-734 (1993). Finally, naive libraries can also be made synthetically by cloning unrearranged V-gene segments from stem cells, and using PCR primers containing random sequence to encode the highly variable CDR3 regions and to accomplish rearrangement in vitro, as described by Hoogenboom and Winter, J. Mol. Biol., 227: 381-388 (1992). Patent publications describing human antibody phage libraries include, for example: U.S. Pat. No. 5,750,373, and US Patent Publication Nos. 2005/0079574, 2005/0119455, 2005/0266000, 2007/0117126, 2007/0160598, 2007/0237764, 2007/0292936, and 2009/0002360.
  • Antibodies or antibody fragments isolated from human antibody libraries are considered human antibodies or human antibody fragments herein.
  • (iv) Chimeric, Humanized and Human Antibodies
  • In certain embodiments, an antibody provided herein is a chimeric antibody. Certain chimeric antibodies are described, e.g., in U.S. Pat. No. 4,816,567; and Morrison et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 81:6851-6855 (1984). In one example, a chimeric antibody comprises a non-human variable region (e.g., a variable region derived from a mouse, rat, hamster, rabbit, or non-human primate, such as a monkey) and a human constant region. In a further example, a chimeric antibody is a “class switched” antibody in which the class or subclass has been changed from that of the parent antibody. Chimeric antibodies include antigen-binding fragments thereof.
  • In certain embodiments, a chimeric antibody is a humanized antibody. Typically, a non-human antibody is humanized to reduce immunogenicity to humans, while retaining the specificity and affinity of the parental non-human antibody. Generally, a humanized antibody comprises one or more variable domains in which HVRs, e.g., CDRs, (or portions thereof) are derived from a non-human antibody, and FRs (or portions thereof) are derived from human antibody sequences. A humanized antibody optionally will also comprise at least a portion of a human constant region. In some embodiments, some FR residues in a humanized antibody are substituted with corresponding residues from a non-human antibody (e.g., the antibody from which the HVR residues are derived), for example, to restore or improve antibody specificity or affinity.
  • Humanized antibodies and methods of making them are reviewed, e.g., in Almagro and Fransson, Front. Biosci. 13:1619-1633 (2008), and are further described, e.g., in Riechmann et al., Nature 332:323-329 (1988); Queen et al., Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 86:10029-10033 (1989); U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,821,337, 7,527,791, 6,982,321, and 7,087,409; Kashmiri et al., Methods 36:25-34 (2005) (describing SDR (a-CDR) grafting); Padlan, Mol. Immunol. 28:489-498 (1991) (describing “resurfacing”); Dall'Acqua et al., Methods 36:43-60 (2005) (describing “FR shuffling”); and Osboum et al., Methods 36:61-68 (2005) and Klimka et al., Br. J. Cancer, 83:252-260 (2000) (describing the “guided selection” approach to FR shuffling).
  • Human framework regions that may be used for humanization include but are not limited to: framework regions selected using the “best-fit” method (see, e.g., Sims et al. J. Immunol. 151:2296 (1993)); framework regions derived from the consensus sequence of human antibodies of a particular subgroup of light or heavy chain variable regions (see, e.g., Carter et al. Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 89:4285 (1992); and Presta et al. J. Immunol., 151:2623 (1993)); human mature (somatically mutated) framework regions or human germline framework regions (see, e.g., Almagro and Fransson, Front. Biosci. 13:1619-1633 (2008)); and framework regions derived from screening FR libraries (see. e.g., Baca et al., J. Biol. Chem. 272:10678-10684 (1997) and Rosok et al., J. Biol. Chem. 271:22611-22618 (1996)).
  • In certain embodiments, an antibody provided herein is a human antibody. Human antibodies can be produced using various techniques known in the art. Human antibodies are described generally in van Dijk and van de Winkel, Curr. Opin. Pharmacol. 5: 368-74 (2001) and Lonberg, Curr. Opin. Immunol. 20:450-459 (2008).
  • Human antibodies may be prepared by administering an immunogen to a transgenic animal that has been modified to produce intact human antibodies or intact antibodies with human variable regions in response to antigenic challenge. Such animals typically contain all or a portion of the human immunoglobulin loci, which replace the endogenous immunoglobulin loci, or which are present extrachromosomally or integrated randomly into the animal's chromosomes. In such transgenic mice, the endogenous immunoglobulin loci have generally been inactivated. For review of methods for obtaining human antibodies from transgenic animals, see Lonberg, Nat. Biotech. 23:1117-1125 (2005). See also, for example, U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,075,181 and 6,150,584 describing XENOMOUSE™ technology; U.S. Pat. No. 5,770,429 describing HUMAB® technology; U.S. Pat. No. 7,041,870 describing K-M MOUSE® technology, and U.S. Patent Application Publication No. US 2007/0061900, describing VELOCIMOUSE® technology). Human variable regions from intact antibodies generated by such animals may be further modified, e.g., by combining with a different human constant region.
  • Human antibodies can also be made by hybridoma-based methods. Human myeloma and mouse-human heteromyeloma cell lines for the production of human monoclonal antibodies have been described. (See, e.g., Kozbor J. Immunol., 133: 3001 (1984); Brodeur et al., Monoclonal Antibody Production Techniques and Applications, pp. 51-63 (Marcel Dekker, Inc., New York, 1987); and Boemer et al., J. Immunol., 147: 86 (1991).) Human antibodies generated via human B-cell hybridoma technology are also described in Li et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 103:3557-3562 (2006). Additional methods include those described, for example, in U.S. Pat. No. 7,189,826 (describing production of monoclonal human IgM antibodies from hybridoma cell lines) and Ni, Xiandai Mianyixue, 26(4):265-268 (2006) (describing human-human hybridomas). Human hybridoma technology (Trioma technology) is also described in Vollmers and Brandlein, Histology and Histopathology, 20(3):927-937 (2005) and Vollmers and Brandlein, Methods and Findings in Experimental and Clinical Pharmacology, 27(3):185-91 (2005).
  • Human antibodies may also be generated by isolating Fv clone variable domain sequences selected from human-derived phage display libraries. Such variable domain sequences may then be combined with a desired human constant domain. Techniques for selecting human antibodies from antibody libraries are described below.
  • (v) Antibody Fragments
  • Antibody fragments may be generated by traditional means, such as enzymatic digestion, or by recombinant techniques. In certain circumstances there are advantages of using antibody fragments, rather than whole antibodies. The smaller size of the fragments allows for rapid clearance, and may lead to improved access to solid tumors. For a review of certain antibody fragments, see Hudson et al. (2003) Nat. Med. 9:129-134.
  • Various techniques have been developed for the production of antibody fragments. Traditionally, these fragments were derived via proteolytic digestion of intact antibodies (see, e.g., Morimoto et al., Journal of Biochemical and Biophysical Methods 24:107-117 (1992); and Brennan et al., Science, 229:81 (1985)). However, these fragments can now be produced directly by recombinant host cells. Fab, Fv and ScFv antibody fragments can all be expressed in and secreted from E. coli, thus allowing the facile production of large amounts of these fragments. Antibody fragments can be isolated from the antibody phage libraries discussed above. Alternatively, Fab′-SH fragments can be directly recovered from E. coli and chemically coupled to form F(ab′)2 fragments (Carter et al., Bio/Technology 10:163-167 (1992)). According to another approach, F(ab′)2 fragments can be isolated directly from recombinant host cell culture. Fab and F(ab′)2 fragment with increased in vivo half-life comprising salvage receptor binding epitope residues are described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,869,046. Other techniques for the production of antibody fragments will be apparent to the skilled practitioner. In certain embodiments, an antibody is a single chain Fv fragment (scFv). See, for example, WO 93/16185; U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,571,894; and 5,587,458. Fv and scFv are the only species with intact combining sites that are devoid of constant regions; thus, they may be suitable for reduced nonspecific binding during in vivo use, scFv fusion proteins may be constructed to yield fusion of an effector protein at either the amino or the carboxy terminus of an scFv. See Antibody Engineering, ed. Borrebaeck, supra. The antibody fragment may also be a “linear antibody,” e.g., as described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,641,870, for example. Such linear antibodies may be monospecific or bispecific.
  • (vi) Multispecific Antibodies
  • Multispecific antibodies have binding specificities for at least two different epitopes, where the epitopes are usually from different antigens. While such molecules normally will only bind two different epitopes (i.e. bispecific antibodies, BsAbs), antibodies with additional specificities such as trispecific antibodies are encompassed by this expression when used herein. Bispecific antibodies can be prepared as full-length antibodies or antibody fragments (e.g. F(ab′)2 bispecific antibodies).
  • Methods for making bispecific antibodies are known in the art. Traditional production of full length bispecific antibodies is based on the coexpression of two immunoglobulin heavy chain-light chain pairs, where the two chains have different specificities (see, e.g., Millstein et al., Nature, 305:537-539 (1983)). Because of the random assortment of immunoglobulin heavy and light chains, these hybridomas (quadromas) produce a potential mixture of 10 different antibody molecules, of which only one has the correct bispecific structure. Purification of the correct molecule, which is usually done by affinity chromatography steps, is rather cumbersome, and the product yields are low. Similar procedures are disclosed in WO 93/08829, and in Traunecker et al., EMBO J., 10:3655-3659 (1991).
  • One approach known in the art for making bispecific antibodies is the “knobs-into-holes” or “protuberance-into-cavity” approach (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,731,168). In this approach, two immunoglobulin polypeptides (e.g., heavy chain polypeptides) each comprise an interface. An interface of one immunoglobulin polypeptide interacts with a corresponding interface on the other immunoglobulin polypeptide, thereby allowing the two immunoglobulin polypeptides to associate. These interfaces may be engineered such that a “knob” or “protuberance” (these terms may be used interchangeably herein) located in the interface of one immunoglobulin polypeptide corresponds with a “hole” or “cavity” (these terms may be used interchangeably herein) located in the interface of the other immunoglobulin polypeptide. In some embodiments, the hole is of identical or similar size to the knob and suitably positioned such that when the two interfaces interact, the knob of one interface is positionable in the corresponding hole of the other interface. Without wishing to be bound to theory, this is thought to stabilize the heteromultimer and favor formation of the heteromultimer over other species, for example homomultimers. In some embodiments, this approach may be used to promote the heteromultimerization of two different immunoglobulin polypeptides, creating a bispecific antibody comprising two immunoglobulin polypeptides with binding specificities for different epitopes.
  • In some embodiments, a knob may be constructed by replacing a small amino acid side chain with a larger side chain. In some embodiments, a hole may be constructed by replacing a large amino acid side chain with a smaller side chain. Knobs or holes may exist in the original interface, or they may be introduced synthetically. For example, knobs or holes may be introduced synthetically by altering the nucleic acid sequence encoding the interface to replace at least one “original” amino acid residue with at least one “import” amino acid residue. Methods for altering nucleic acid sequences may include standard molecular biology techniques well known in the art. The side chain volumes of various amino acid residues are shown in the following table. In some embodiments, original residues have a small side chain volume (e.g., alanine, asparagine, aspartic acid, glycine, serine, threonine, or valine), and import residues for forming a knob are naturally occurring amino acids and may include arginine, phenylalanine, tyrosine, and tryptophan. In some embodiments, original residues have a large side chain volume (e.g., arginine, phenylalanine, tyrosine, and tryptophan), and import residues for forming a hole are naturally occurring amino acids and may include alanine, serine, threonine, and valine.
  • TABLE 1
    Properties of amino acid residues
    Accessible
    One-letter Massa Volumeb surface
    Amino acid abbreviation (daltons) (Å3) areac (Å2)
    Alanine (Ala) A 71.08 88.6 115
    Arginine (Arg) R 156.20 173.4 225
    Asparagine (Asn) N 114.11 117.7 160
    Aspartic Acid (Asp) D 115.09 111.1 150
    Cysteine (Cys) C 103.14 108.5 135
    Glutamine (Gln) Q 128.14 143.9 180
    Glutamic Acid (Glu) E 129.12 138.4 190
    Glycine (Gly) G 57.06 60.1 75
    Histidine (His) H 137.15 153.2 195
    Isoleucine (Ile) I 113.17 166.7 175
    Leucine (Leu) L 113.17 166.7 170
    Lysine (Lys) K 128.18 168.6 200
    Methionine (Met) M 131.21 162.9 185
    Phenylalanine (Phe) F 147.18 189.9 210
    Proline (Pro) P 97.12 122.7 145
    Serine (Ser) S 87.08 89.0 115
    Threonine (Thr) T 101.11 116.1 140
    Tryptophan (Trp) W 186.21 227.8 255
    Tyrosine (Tyr) Y 163.18 193.6 230
    Valine (Val) V 99.14 140.0 155
    aMolecular weight of amino acid minus that of water. Values from Handbook of Chemistry and Physics, 43rd ed. Cleveland, Chemical Rubber Publishing Co., 1961.
    bValues from A. A. Zamyatnin, Prog. Biophys. Mol. Biol. 24: 107-123, 1972.
    cValues from C. Chothia, J. Mol. Biol. 105: 1-14, 1975. The accessible surface area is defined in FIGS. 6-20 of this reference.
  • In some embodiments, original residues for forming a knob or hole are identified based on the three-dimensional structure of the heteromultimer. Techniques known in the art for obtaining a three-dimensional structure may include X-ray crystallography and NMR. In some embodiments, the interface is the CH3 domain of an immunoglobulin constant domain. In these embodiments, the CH3/CH3 interface of human IgG1 involves sixteen residues on each domain located on four anti-parallel β-strands. Without wishing to be bound to theory, mutated residues are preferably located on the two central anti-parallel β-strands to minimize the risk that knobs can be accommodated by the surrounding solvent, rather than the compensatory holes in the partner CH3 domain. In some embodiments, the mutations forming corresponding knobs and holes in two immunoglobulin polypeptides correspond to one or more pairs provided in the following table.
  • TABLE 2
    Exemplary sets of corresponding knob-and hole-forming mutations
    CH3 of first immunoglobulin CH3 of second immunoglobulin
    T366Y Y407T
    T366W Y407A
    F405A T394W
    Y407T T366Y
    T366Y:F405A T394W:Y407T
    T366W:F405W T394S:Y407A
    F405W:Y407A T366W:T394S
    F405W T394S

    Mutations are denoted by the original residue, followed by the position using the Kabat numbering system, and then the import residue (all residues are given in single-letter amino acid code). Multiple mutations are separated by a colon.
  • In some embodiments, an immunoglobulin polypeptide comprises a CH3 domain comprising one or more amino acid substitutions listed in Table 2 above. In some embodiments, a bispecific antibody comprises a first immunoglobulin polypeptide comprising a CH3 domain comprising one or more amino acid substitutions listed in the left column of Table 2, and a second immunoglobulin polypeptide comprising a CH3 domain comprising one or more corresponding amino acid substitutions listed in the right column of Table 2.
  • Following mutation of the DNA as discussed above, polynucleotides encoding modified immunoglobulin polypeptides with one or more corresponding knob- or hole-forming mutations may be expressed and purified using standard recombinant techniques and cell systems known in the art. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,731,168; 5,807,706; 5,821,333; 7,642,228; 7,695,936; 8,216,805; U.S. Pub. No. 2013/0089553; and Spiess et al., Nature Biotechnology 31: 753-758, 2013. Modified immunoglobulin polypeptides may be produced using prokaryotic host cells, such as E. coli, or eukaryotic host cells, such as CHO cells. Corresponding knob-and-hole-bearing immunoglobulin polypeptides may be expressed in host cells in co-culture and purified together as a heteromultimer, or they may be expressed in single cultures, separately purified, and assembled in vitro. In some embodiments, two strains of bacterial host cells (one expressing an immunoglobulin polypeptide with a knob, and the other expressing an immunoglobulin polypeptide with a hole) are co-cultured using standard bacterial culturing techniques known in the art. In some embodiments, the two strains may be mixed in a specific ratio, e.g., so as to achieve equal expression levels in culture. In some embodiments, the two strains may be mixed in a 50:50, 60:40, or 70:30 ratio. After polypeptide expression, the cells may be lysed together, and protein may be extracted. Standard techniques known in the art that allow for measuring the abundance of homo-multimeric vs. hetero-multimeric species may include size exclusion chromatography. In some embodiments, each modified immunoglobulin polypeptide is expressed separately using standard recombinant techniques, and they may be assembled together in vitro. Assembly may be achieved, for example, by purifying each modified immunoglobulin polypeptide, mixing and incubating them together in equal mass, reducing disulfides (e.g., by treating with dithiothreitol), concentrating, and reoxidizing the polypeptides. Formed bispecific antibodies may be purified using standard techniques including cation-exchange chromatography and measured using standard techniques including size exclusion chromatography. For a more detailed description of these methods, see Speiss et al., Nat. Biotechnol. 31:753-8, 2013. In some embodiments, modified immunoglobulin polypeptides may be expressed separately in CHO cells and assembled in vitro using the methods described above.
  • According to a different approach, antibody variable domains with the desired binding specificities (antibody-antigen combining sites) are fused to immunoglobulin constant domain sequences. The fusion preferably is with an immunoglobulin heavy chain constant domain, comprising at least part of the hinge, CH2, and CH3 regions. It is typical to have the first heavy-chain constant region (CH1) containing the site necessary for light chain binding, present in at least one of the fusions. DNAs encoding the immunoglobulin heavy chain fusions and, if desired, the immunoglobulin light chain, are inserted into separate expression vectors, and are co-transfected into a suitable host organism. This provides for great flexibility in adjusting the mutual proportions of the three polypeptide fragments in embodiments when unequal ratios of the three polypeptide chains used in the construction provide the optimum yields. It is, however, possible to insert the coding sequences for two or all three polypeptide chains in one expression vector when the expression of at least two polypeptide chains in equal ratios results in high yields or when the ratios are of no particular significance.
  • In one embodiment of this approach, the bispecific antibodies are composed of a hybrid immunoglobulin heavy chain with a first binding specificity in one arm, and a hybrid immunoglobulin heavy chain-light chain pair (providing a second binding specificity) in the other arm. It was found that this asymmetric structure facilitates the separation of the desired bispecific compound from unwanted immunoglobulin chain combinations, as the presence of an immunoglobulin light chain in only one half of the bispecific molecule provides for a facile way of separation. This approach is disclosed in WO 94/04690. For further details of generating bispecific antibodies see, for example, Suresh et al., Methods in Enzymology, 121:210 (1986).
  • According to another approach described in WO96/27011, the interface between a pair of antibody molecules can be engineered to maximize the percentage of heterodimers which are recovered from recombinant cell culture. One interface comprises at least a part of the CH 3 domain of an antibody constant domain. In this method, one or more small amino acid side chains from the interface of the first antibody molecule are replaced with larger side chains (e.g. tyrosine or tryptophan). Compensatory “cavities” of identical or similar size to the large side chain(s) are created on the interface of the second antibody molecule by replacing large amino acid side chains with smaller ones (e.g. alanine or threonine). This provides a mechanism for increasing the yield of the heterodimer over other unwanted end-products such as homodimers.
  • Bispecific antibodies include cross-linked or “heteroconjugate” antibodies. For example, one of the antibodies in the heteroconjugate can be coupled to avidin, the other to biotin. Such antibodies have, for example, been proposed to target immune system cells to unwanted cells (U.S. Pat. No. 4,676,980), and for treatment of HIV infection (WO 91/00360, WO 92/200373, and EP 03089). Heteroconjugate antibodies may be made using any convenient cross-linking methods. Suitable cross-linking agents are well known in the art, and are disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 4,676,980, along with a number of cross-linking techniques.
  • Techniques for generating bispecific antibodies from antibody fragments have also been described in the literature. For example, bispecific antibodies can be prepared using chemical linkage. Brennan et al., Science, 229: 81 (1985) describe a procedure wherein intact antibodies are proteolytically cleaved to generate F(ab′)2 fragments. These fragments are reduced in the presence of the dithiol complexing agent sodium arsenite to stabilize vicinal dithiols and prevent intermolecular disulfide formation. The Fab′ fragments generated are then converted to thionitrobenzoate (TNB) derivatives. One of the Fab′-TNB derivatives is then reconverted to the Fab′-thiol by reduction with mercaptoethylamine and is mixed with an equimolar amount of the other Fab′-TNB derivative to form the bispecific antibody. The bispecific antibodies produced can be used as agents for the selective immobilization of enzymes.
  • Recent progress has facilitated the direct recovery of Fab′-SH fragments from E. coli, which can be chemically coupled to form bispecific antibodies. Shalaby et al., J. Exp. Med., 175: 217-225 (1992) describe the production of a fully humanized bispecific antibody F(ab′)2 molecule. Each Fab′ fragment was separately secreted from E. coli and subjected to directed chemical coupling in vitro to form the bispecific antibody.
  • Various techniques for making and isolating bispecific antibody fragments directly from recombinant cell culture have also been described. For example, bispecific antibodies have been produced using leucine zippers. Kostelny et al., J. Immunol., 148(5):1547-1553 (1992). The leucine zipper peptides from the Fos and Jun proteins were linked to the Fab′ portions of two different antibodies by gene fusion. The antibody homodimers were reduced at the hinge region to form monomers and then re-oxidized to form the antibody heterodimers. This method can also be utilized for the production of antibody homodimers. The “diabody” technology described by Hollinger et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 90:6444-6448 (1993) has provided an alternative mechanism for making bispecific antibody fragments. The fragments comprise a heavy-chain variable domain (VH) connected to a light-chain variable domain (VL) by a linker which is too short to allow pairing between the two domains on the same chain. Accordingly, the VH and VL domains of one fragment are forced to pair with the complementary VL and VH domains of another fragment, thereby forming two antigen-binding sites. Another strategy for making bispecific antibody fragments by the use of single-chain Fv (sFv) dimers has also been reported. See Gruber et al, J. Immunol, 152:5368 (1994).
  • Another technique for making bispecific antibody fragments is the “bispecific T cell engager” or BiTE® approach (see, e.g., WO2004/106381, WO2005/061547, WO2007/042261, and WO2008/119567). This approach utilizes two antibody variable domains arranged on a single polypeptide. For example, a single polypeptide chain includes two single chain Fv (scFv) fragments, each having a variable heavy chain (VH) and a variable light chain (VL) domain separated by a polypeptide linker of a length sufficient to allow intramolecular association between the two domains. This single polypeptide further includes a polypeptide spacer sequence between the two scFv fragments. Each scFv recognizes a different epitope, and these epitopes may be specific for different cell types, such that cells of two different cell types are brought into close proximity or tethered when each scFv is engaged with its cognate epitope. One particular embodiment of this approach includes a scFv recognizing a cell-surface antigen expressed by an immune cell, e.g., a CD3 polypeptide on a T cell, linked to another scFv that recognizes a cell-surface antigen expressed by a target cell, such as a malignant or tumor cell.
  • As it is a single polypeptide, the bispecific T cell engager may be expressed using any prokaryotic or eukaryotic cell expression system known in the art, e.g., a CHO cell line. However, specific purification techniques (see, e.g., EP1691833) may be necessary to separate monomeric bispecific T cell engagers from other multimeric species, which may have biological activities other than the intended activity of the monomer. In one exemplary purification scheme, a solution containing secreted polypeptides is first subjected to a metal affinity chromatography, and polypeptides are eluted with a gradient of imidazole concentrations. This eluate is further purified using anion exchange chromatography, and polypeptides are eluted using with a gradient of sodium chloride concentrations. Finally, this eluate is subjected to size exclusion chromatography to separate monomers from multimeric species.
  • Antibodies with more than two valencies are contemplated. For example, trispecific antibodies can be prepared. See, e.g., Tuft et al. J. Immunol. 147: 60 (1991).
  • (vii) Single-Domain Antibodies
  • In some embodiments, an antibody of the invention is a single-domain antibody. A single-domain antibody is a single polypeptide chain comprising all or a portion of the heavy chain variable domain or all or a portion of the light chain variable domain of an antibody. In certain embodiments, a single-domain antibody is a human single-domain antibody (Domantis, Inc., Waltham, Mass.; see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 6,248,516 BI). In one embodiment, a single-domain antibody consists of all or a portion of the heavy chain variable domain of an antibody.
  • (viii) Antibody Variants
  • In some embodiments, amino acid sequence modification(s) of the antibodies described herein are contemplated. For example, it may be desirable to improve the binding affinity and/or other biological properties of the antibody. Amino acid sequence variants of the antibody may be prepared by introducing appropriate changes into the nucleotide sequence encoding the antibody, or by peptide synthesis. Such modifications include, for example, deletions from, and/or insertions into and/or substitutions of, residues within the amino acid sequences of the antibody. Any combination of deletion, insertion, and substitution can be made to arrive at the final construct, provided that the final construct possesses the desired characteristics. The amino acid alterations may be introduced in the subject antibody amino acid sequence at the time that sequence is made.
  • (ix) Substitution, Insertion, and Deletion Variants
  • In certain embodiments, antibody variants having one or more amino acid substitutions are provided. Sites of interest for substitutional mutagenesis include the HVRs and FRs. Conservative substitutions are shown in Table 1 under the heading of “conservative substitutions.” More substantial changes are provided in Table 1 under the heading of “exemplary substitutions,” and as further described below in reference to amino acid side chain classes. Amino acid substitutions may be introduced into an antibody of interest and the products screened for a desired activity, e.g., retained/improved antigen binding, decreased immunogenicity, or improved ADCC or CDC.
  • TABLE 3
    Exemplary Substitutions.
    Preferred
    Original Residue Exemplary Substitutions Substitutions
    Ala (A) Val; Leu; Ile Val
    Arg (R) Lys; Gln; Asn Lys
    Asn (N) Gln; His; Asp, Lys; Arg Gln
    Asp (D) Glu; Asn Glu
    Cys (C) Ser; Ala Ser
    Gln (Q) Asn; Glu Asn
    Glu (E) Asp; Gln Asp
    Gly (G) Ala Ala
    His (H) Asn; Gln; Lys; Arg Arg
    Ile (I) Leu; Val; Met; Ala; Phe; Norleucine Leu
    Leu (L) Norleucine; Ile; Val; Met; Ala; Phe Ile
    Lys (K) Arg; Gln; Asn Arg
    Met (M) Leu; Phe; Ile Leu
    Phe (F) Trp; Leu; Val; Ile; Ala; Tyr Tyr
    Pro (P) Ala Ala
    Ser (S) Thr Thr
    Thr (T) Val; Ser Ser
    Trp (W) Tyr; Phe Tyr
    Tyr (Y) Trp; Phe; Thr; Ser Phe
    Val (V) Ile; Leu; Met; Phe; Ala; Norleucine Leu
  • Amino acids may be grouped according to common side-chain properties:
  • a. hydrophobic: Norleucine, Met, Ala, Val, Leu, Ile;
  • b. neutral hydrophilic: Cys, Ser, Thr, Asn, Gin;
  • c. acidic: Asp, Glu;
  • d. basic: His, Lys, Arg;
  • e. residues that influence chain orientation: Gly, Pro;
  • f. aromatic: Trp, Tyr, Phe.
  • Non-conservative substitutions will entail exchanging a member of one of these classes for another class.
  • One type of substitutional variant involves substituting one or more hypervariable region residues of a parent antibody (e.g., a humanized or human antibody). Generally, the resulting variant(s) selected for further study will have modifications (e.g., improvements) in certain biological properties (e.g., increased affinity, reduced immunogenicity) relative to the parent antibody and/or will have substantially retained certain biological properties of the parent antibody. An exemplary substitutional variant is an affinity matured antibody, which may be conveniently generated, e.g., using phage display-based affinity maturation techniques such as those described herein. Briefly, one or more HVR residues are mutated and the variant antibodies displayed on phage and screened for a particular biological activity (e.g. binding affinity).
  • Alterations (e.g., substitutions) may be made in HVRs, for example, to improve antibody affinity. Such alterations may be made in HVR “hotspots,” i.e., residues encoded by codons that undergo mutation at high frequency during the somatic maturation process (see, e.g., Chowdhury, Methods Mol. Biol. 207:179-196 (2008)), and/or SDRs (a-CDRs), with the resulting variant VH or VL being tested for binding affinity. Affinity maturation by constructing and reselecting from secondary libraries has been described, e.g., in Hoogenboom et al. in Methods in Molecular Biology 178:1-37 (O'Brien et al., ed., Human Press. Totowa, N.J., (2001)). In some embodiments of affinity maturation, diversity is introduced into the variable genes chosen for maturation by any of a variety of methods (e.g., error-prone PCR, chain shuffling, or oligonucleotide-directed mutagenesis). A secondary library is then created. The library is then screened to identify any antibody variants with the desired affinity. Another method to introduce diversity involves HVR-directed approaches, in which several HVR residues (e.g., 4-6 residues at a time) are randomized. HVR residues involved in antigen binding may be specifically identified, e.g., using alanine scanning mutagenesis or modeling. CDR-H3 and CDR-L3 in particular are often targeted.
  • In certain embodiments, substitutions, insertions, or deletions may occur within one or more HVRs so long as such alterations do not substantially reduce the ability of the antibody to bind antigen. For example, conservative alterations (e.g., conservative substitutions as provided herein) that do not substantially reduce binding affinity may be made in HVRs. Such alterations may be outside of HVR “hotspots” or SDRs. In certain embodiments of the variant VH and VL sequences provided above, each HVR either is unaltered, or contains no more than one, two or three amino acid substitutions.
  • A useful method for identification of residues or regions of an antibody that may be targeted for mutagenesis is called “alanine scanning mutagenesis” as described by Cunningham and Wells (1989) Science, 244:1081-1085. In this method, a residue or group of target residues (e.g., charged residues such as Arg, Asp, His, Lys, and Glu) are identified and replaced by a neutral or negatively charged amino acid (e.g., alanine or polyalanine) to determine whether the interaction of the antibody with antigen is affected. Further substitutions may be introduced at the amino acid locations demonstrating functional sensitivity to the initial substitutions. Alternatively, or additionally, a crystal structure of an antigen-antibody complex to identify contact points between the antibody and antigen. Such contact residues and neighboring residues may be targeted or eliminated as candidates for substitution. Variants may be screened to determine whether they contain the desired properties.
  • Amino acid sequence insertions include amino- and/or carboxyl-terminal fusions ranging in length from one residue to polypeptides containing a hundred or more residues, as well as intrasequence insertions of single or multiple amino acid residues. Examples of terminal insertions include an antibody with an N-terminal methionyl residue. Other insertional variants of the antibody molecule include the fusion to the N- or C-terminus of the antibody to an enzyme (e.g., for ADEPT) or a polypeptide which increases the serum half-life of the antibody.
  • (x) Glycosylation Variants
  • In certain embodiments, an antibody provided herein is altered to increase or decrease the extent to which the antibody is glycosylated. Addition or deletion of glycosylation sites to an antibody may be conveniently accomplished by altering the amino acid sequence such that one or more glycosylation sites is created or removed.
  • Where the antibody comprises an Fc region, the carbohydrate attached thereto may be altered. Native antibodies produced by mammalian cells typically comprise a branched, biantennary oligosaccharide that is generally attached by an N-linkage to Asn297 of the CH2 domain of the Fc region. See, e.g., Wright et al. TIBTECH 15:26-32 (1997). The oligosaccharide may include various carbohydrates, e.g., mannose, N-acetyl glucosamine (GlcNAc), galactose, and sialic acid, as well as a fucose attached to a GlcNAc in the “stem” of the biantennary oligosaccharide structure. In some embodiments, modifications of the oligosaccharide in an antibody of the invention may be made in order to create antibody variants with certain improved properties.
  • In one embodiment, antibody variants are provided comprising an Fc region wherein a carbohydrate structure attached to the Fc region has reduced fucose or lacks fucose, which may improve ADCC function. Specifically, antibodies are contemplated herein that have reduced fusose relative to the amount of fucose on the same antibody produced in a wild-type CHO cell. That is, they are characterized by having a lower amount of fucose than they would otherwise have if produced by native CHO cells (e.g., a CHO cell that produce a native glycosylation pattern, such as, a CHO cell containing a native FUT8 gene). In certain embodiments, the antibody is one wherein less than about 50%, 40%, 30%, 20%, 10%, or 5% of the N-linked glycans thereon comprise fucose. For example, the amount of fucose in such an antibody may be from 1% to 80%, from 1% to 65%, from 5% to 65% or from 20% to 40%. In certain embodiments, the antibody is one wherein none of the N-linked glycans thereon comprise fucose, i.e., wherein the antibody is completely without fucose, or has no fucose or is afucosylated. The amount of fucose is determined by calculating the average amount of fucose within the sugar chain at Asn297, relative to the sum of all glycostructures attached to Asn 297 (e.g. complex, hybrid and high mannose structures) as measured by MALDI-TOF mass spectrometry, as described in WO 2008/077546, for example. Asn297 refers to the asparagine residue located at about position 297 in the Fc region (EU numbering of Fc region residues); however, Asn297 may also be located about ±3 amino acids upstream or downstream of position 297, i.e., between positions 294 and 300, due to minor sequence variations in antibodies. Such fucosylation variants may have improved ADCC function. See, e.g., US Patent Publication Nos. US 2003/0157108 (Presta, L.); US 2004/0093621 (Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd). Examples of publications related to “defucosylated” or “fucose-deficient” antibody variants include: US 2003/0157108; WO 2000/61739; WO 2001/29246; US 2003/0115614; US 2002/0164328; US 2004/0093621; US 2004/0132140; US 2004/0110704; US 2004/0110282; US 2004/0109865; WO 2003/085119; WO 2003/084570; WO 2005/035586; WO 2005/035778; WO2005/053742; WO2002/031140; Okazaki et al. J. Mol. Biol. 336:1239-1249 (2004); Yamane-Ohnuki et al. Biotech. Bioeng. 87: 614 (2004). Examples of cell lines capable of producing defucosylated antibodies include Lec13 CHO cells deficient in protein fucosylation (Ripka et al. Arch. Biochem. Biophys. 249:533-545 (1986); US Pat Appl No US 2003/0157108 A1; and WO 2004/056312 A1, especially at Example 11), and knockout cell lines, such as alpha-1,6-fucosyltransferase gene, FUT8, knockout CHO cells (see, e.g., Yamane-Ohnuki et al. Biotech. Bioeng. 87: 614 (2004); Kanda, Y. et al., Biotechnol. Bioeng., 94(4):680-688 (2006); and WO2003/085107).
  • Antibody variants are further provided with bisected oligosaccharides, e.g., in which a biantennary oligosaccharide attached to the Fc region of the antibody is bisected by GlcNAc. Such antibody variants may have reduced fucosylation and/or improved ADCC function. Examples of such antibody variants are described, e.g., in WO 2003/011878; U.S. Pat. No. 6,602,684; US 2005/0123546, and Ferrara et al., Biotechnology and Bioengineering, 93(5): 851-861 (2006). Antibody variants with at least one galactose residue in the oligosaccharide attached to the Fc region are also provided. Such antibody variants may have improved CDC function. Such antibody variants are described, e.g., in WO 1997/30087; WO 1998/58964; and WO 1999/22764.
  • In certain embodiments, the antibody variants comprising an Fc region described herein are capable of binding to an FcγRIII. In certain embodiments, the antibody variants comprising an Fc region described herein have ADCC activity in the presence of human effector cells or have increased ADCC activity in the presence of human effector cells compared to the otherwise same antibody comprising a human wild-type IgG1Fc region.
  • (xi) Fc Region Variants
  • In certain embodiments, one or more amino acid modifications may be introduced into the Fc region of an antibody provided herein, thereby generating an Fc region variant. The Fc region variant may comprise a human Fc region sequence (e.g., a human IgG1, IgG2, IgG3 or IgG4 Fc region) comprising an amino acid modification (e.g., a substitution) at one or more amino acid positions.
  • In certain embodiments, the invention contemplates an antibody variant that possesses some but not all effector functions, which make it a desirable candidate for applications in which the half life of the antibody in vivo is important yet certain effector functions (such as complement and ADCC) are unnecessary or deleterious. In vitro and/or in vivo cytotoxicity assays can be conducted to confirm the reduction/depletion of CDC and/or ADCC activities. For example, Fc receptor (FcR) binding assays can be conducted to ensure that the antibody lacks FcγR binding (hence likely lacking ADCC activity), but retains FcRn binding ability. The primary cells for mediating ADCC, NK cells, express FcγRIII only, whereas monocytes express FcγRI, FcγRII, and FcγRIII. FcR expression on hematopoietic cells is summarized in Table 3 on page 464 of Ravetch and Kinet, Annu. Rev. Immunol. 9:457-492 (1991). Non-limiting examples of in vitro assays to assess ADCC activity of a molecule of interest is described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,500,362 (see, e.g. Hellstrom et al. Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 83:7059-7063 (1986)) and Hellstrom, I et al., Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 82:1499-1502 (1985); 5,821,337 (see Bruggemann et al., J. Exp. Med. 166:1351-1361 (1987)). Alternatively, non-radioactive assays methods may be employed (see, for example, ACTI™ non-radioactive cytotoxicity assay for flow cytometry (CellTechnology, Inc. Mountain View, Calif.; and CytoTox 96® non-radioactive cytotoxicity assay (Promega, Madison, Wis.). Useful effector cells for such assays include peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMC) and Natural Killer (NK) cells. Alternatively, or additionally, ADCC activity of the molecule of interest may be assessed in vivo, e.g., in an animal model such as that disclosed in Clynes et al. Proc. Nat'l Acad. Sci. USA 95:652-656 (1998). C1q binding assays may also be carried out to confirm that the antibody is unable to bind C1q and hence lacks CDC activity. See, e.g., C1q and C3c binding ELISA in WO 2006/029879 and WO 2005/100402. To assess complement activation, a CDC assay may be performed (see, for example, Gazzano-Santoro et al., J. Immunol. Methods 202:163 (1996); Cragg et al., Blood 101:1045-1052 (2003); and Cragg et al, Blood 103:2738-2743 (2004)). FcRn binding and in vivo clearance/half life determinations can also be performed using methods known in the art (see, e.g., Petkova et al., Int'l. Immunol. 18(12):1759-1769 (2006)).
  • Antibodies with reduced effector function include those with substitution of one or more of Fc region residues 238, 265, 269, 270, 297, 327 and 329 (U.S. Pat. No. 6,737,056). Such Fc mutants include Fc mutants with substitutions at two or more of amino acid positions 265, 269, 270, 297 and 327, including the so-called “DANA” Fc mutant with substitution of residues 265 and 297 to alanine (U.S. Pat. No. 7,332,581).
  • Certain antibody variants with improved or diminished binding to FcRs are described. (See, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 6,737,056; WO 2004/056312, and Shields et al., J. Biol. Chem. 9(2): 6591-6604 (2001).)
  • In certain embodiments, an antibody variant comprises an Fc region with one or more amino acid substitutions which improve ADCC, e.g., substitutions at positions 298, 333, and/or 334 of the Fc region (EU numbering of residues). In an exemplary embodiment, the antibody comprising the following amino acid substitutions in its Fc region: S298A, E333A, and K334A.
  • In some embodiments, alterations are made in the Fc region that result in altered (i.e., either improved or diminished) C1q binding and/or Complement Dependent Cytotoxicity (CDC), e.g., as described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,194,551, WO 99/51642, and Idusogie et al. J. Immunol. 164: 4178-4184 (2000).
  • Antibodies with increased half lives and improved binding to the neonatal Fc receptor (FcRn), which is responsible for the transfer of maternal IgGs to the fetus (Guyer et al., J. Immunol. 117:587 (1976) and Kim et al., J. Immunol. 24:249 (1994)), are described in US2005/0014934A1 (Hinton et al.)). Those antibodies comprise an Fc region with one or more substitutions therein which improve binding of the Fc region to FcRn. Such Fc variants include those with substitutions at one or more of Fc region residues: 238, 256, 265, 272, 286, 303, 305, 307, 311, 312, 317, 340, 356, 360, 362, 376, 378, 380, 382, 413, 424 or 434, e.g., substitution of Fc region residue 434 (U.S. Pat. No. 7,371,826). See also Duncan & Winter, Nature 322:738-40 (1988); U.S. Pat. No. 5,648,260; U.S. Pat. No. 5,624,821; and WO 94/29351 concerning other examples of Fc region variants.
  • (xii) Antibody Derivatives
  • The antibodies of the invention can be further modified to contain additional nonproteinaceous moieties that are known in the art and readily available. In certain embodiments, the moieties suitable for derivatization of the antibody are water soluble polymers. Non-limiting examples of water soluble polymers include, but are not limited to, polyethylene glycol (PEG), copolymers of ethylene glycol/propylene glycol, carboxymethylcellulose, dextran, polyvinyl alcohol, polyvinyl pyrrolidone, poly-1,3-dioxolane, poly-1,3,6-trioxane, ethylene/maleic anhydride copolymer, polyaminoacids (either homopolymers or random copolymers), and dextran or poly(n-vinyl pyrrolidone)polyethylene glycol, propropylene glycol homopolymers, prolypropylene oxide/ethylene oxide co-polymers, polyoxyethylated polyols (e.g., glycerol), polyvinyl alcohol, and mixtures thereof. Polyethylene glycol propionaldehyde may have advantages in manufacturing due to its stability in water. The polymer may be of any molecular weight, and may be branched or unbranched. The number of polymers attached to the antibody may vary, and if more than one polymer are attached, they can be the same or different molecules. In general, the number and/or type of polymers used for derivatization can be determined based on considerations including, but not limited to, the particular properties or functions of the antibody to be improved, whether the antibody derivative will be used in a therapy under defined conditions, etc.
  • (xiii) Vectors, Host Cells, and Recombinant Methods
  • Antibodies may also be produced using recombinant methods. For recombinant production of an anti-antigen antibody, nucleic acid encoding the antibody is isolated and inserted into a replicable vector for further cloning (amplification of the DNA) or for expression. DNA encoding the antibody may be readily isolated and sequenced using conventional procedures (e.g., by using oligonucleotide probes that are capable of binding specifically to genes encoding the heavy and light chains of the antibody). Many vectors are available. The vector components generally include, but are not limited to, one or more of the following: a signal sequence, an origin of replication, one or more marker genes, an enhancer element, a promoter, and a transcription termination sequence.
  • (a) Signal Sequence Component
  • An antibody of the invention may be produced recombinantly not only directly, but also as a fusion polypeptide with a heterologous polypeptide, which is preferably a signal sequence or other polypeptide having a specific cleavage site at the N-terminus of the mature protein or polypeptide. The heterologous signal sequence selected preferably is one that is recognized and processed (e.g., cleaved by a signal peptidase) by the host cell. For prokaryotic host cells that do not recognize and process a native antibody signal sequence, the signal sequence is substituted by a prokaryotic signal sequence selected, for example, from the group of the alkaline phosphatase, penicillinase, Ipp, or heat-stable enterotoxin II leaders. For yeast secretion the native signal sequence may be substituted by, e.g., the yeast invertase leader, a factor leader (including Saccharomyces and Kluyveromyces α-factor leaders), or acid phosphatase leader, the C. albicans glucoamylase leader, or the signal described in WO 90/13646. In mammalian cell expression, mammalian signal sequences as well as viral secretory leaders, for example, the herpes simplex gD signal, are available.
  • (b) Origin of Replication
  • Both expression and cloning vectors contain a nucleic acid sequence that enables the vector to replicate in one or more selected host cells. Generally, in cloning vectors this sequence is one that enables the vector to replicate independently of the host chromosomal DNA, and includes origins of replication or autonomously replicating sequences. Such sequences are well known for a variety of bacteria, yeast, and viruses. The origin of replication from the plasmid pBR322 is suitable for most Gram-negative bacteria, the 2μ, plasmid origin is suitable for yeast, and various viral origins (SV40, polyoma, adenovirus, VSV or BPV) are useful for cloning vectors in mammalian cells. Generally, the origin of replication component is not needed for mammalian expression vectors (the SV40 origin may typically be used only because it contains the early promoter.
  • (c) Selection Gene Component
  • Expression and cloning vectors may contain a selection gene, also termed a selectable marker. Typical selection genes encode proteins that (a) confer resistance to antibiotics or other toxins, e.g., ampicillin, neomycin, methotrexate, or tetracycline, (b) complement auxotrophic deficiencies, or (c) supply critical nutrients not available from complex media, e.g., the gene encoding D-alanine racemase for Bacilli.
  • One example of a selection scheme utilizes a drug to arrest growth of a host cell. Those cells that are successfully transformed with a heterologous gene produce a protein conferring drug resistance and thus survive the selection regimen. Examples of such dominant selection use the drugs neomycin, mycophenolic acid and hygromycin.
  • Another example of suitable selectable markers for mammalian cells are those that enable the identification of cells competent to take up antibody-encoding nucleic acid, such as DHFR, glutamine synthetase (GS), thymidine kinase, metallothionein-I and -II, preferably primate metallothionein genes, adenosine deaminase, omithine decarboxylase, etc.
  • For example, cells transformed with the DHFR gene are identified by culturing the transformants in a culture medium containing methotrexate (Mtx), a competitive antagonist of DHFR. Under these conditions, the DHFR gene is amplified along with any other co-transformed nucleic acid. A Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) cell line deficient in endogenous DHFR activity (e.g., ATCC CRL-9096) may be used.
  • Alternatively, cells transformed with the GS gene are identified by culturing the transformants in a culture medium containing L-methionine sulfoximine (Msx), an inhibitor of GS. Under these conditions, the GS gene is amplified along with any other co-transformed nucleic acid. The GS selection/amplification system may be used in combination with the DHFR selection/amplification system described above.
  • Alternatively, host cells (particularly wild-type hosts that contain endogenous DHFR) transformed or co-transformed with DNA sequences encoding an antibody of interest, wild-type DHFR gene, and another selectable marker such as aminoglycoside 3′-phosphotransferase (APH) can be selected by cell growth in medium containing a selection agent for the selectable marker such as an aminoglycosidic antibiotic, e.g., kanamycin, neomycin, or G418. See U.S. Pat. No. 4,965,199.
  • A suitable selection gene for use in yeast is the trp1 gene present in the yeast plasmid YRp7 (Stinchcomb et al., Nature, 282:39 (1979)). The trp1 gene provides a selection marker for a mutant strain of yeast lacking the ability to grow in tryptophan, for example, ATCC No. 44076 or PEP4-1. Jones, Genetics, 85:12 (1977). The presence of the trp1 lesion in the yeast host cell genome then provides an effective environment for detecting transformation by growth in the absence of tryptophan. Similarly, Leu2-deficient yeast strains (ATCC 20,622 or 38,626) are complemented by known plasmids bearing the Leu2 gene.
  • In addition, vectors derived from the 1.6 μm circular plasmid pKD1 can be used for transformation of Kluyveromyces yeasts. Alternatively, an expression system for large-scale production of recombinant calf chymosin was reported for K. lactis. Van den Berg, Bio/Technology, 8:135 (1990). Stable multi-copy expression vectors for secretion of mature recombinant human serum albumin by industrial strains of Kluyveromyces have also been disclosed. Fleer et al., Bio/Technology, 9:968-975 (1991).
  • (d) Promoter Component
  • Expression and cloning vectors generally contain a promoter that is recognized by the host organism and is operably linked to nucleic acid encoding an antibody. Promoters suitable for use with prokaryotic hosts include the phoA promoter, β-lactamase and lactose promoter systems, alkaline phosphatase promoter, a tryptophan (trp) promoter system, and hybrid promoters such as the tac promoter. However, other known bacterial promoters are suitable. Promoters for use in bacterial systems also will contain a Shine-Dalgamo (S.D.) sequence operably linked to the DNA encoding an antibody.
  • Promoter sequences are known for eukaryotes. Virtually all eukaryotic genes have an AT-rich region located approximately 25 to 30 bases upstream from the site where transcription is initiated. Another sequence found 70 to 80 bases upstream from the start of transcription of many genes is a CNCAAT region where N may be any nucleotide. At the 3′ end of most eukaryotic genes is an AATAAA sequence that may be the signal for addition of the poly A tail to the 3′ end of the coding sequence. All of these sequences are suitably inserted into eukaryotic expression vectors.
  • Examples of suitable promoter sequences for use with yeast hosts include the promoters for 3-phosphoglycerate kinase or other glycolytic enzymes, such as enolase, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, hexokinase, pyruvate decarboxylase, phosphofructokinase, glucose-6-phosphate isomerase, 3-phosphoglycerate mutase, pyruvate kinase, triosephosphate isomerase, phosphoglucose isomerase, and glucokinase.
  • Other yeast promoters, which are inducible promoters having the additional advantage of transcription controlled by growth conditions, are the promoter regions for alcohol dehydrogenase 2, isocytochrome C, acid phosphatase, degradative enzymes associated with nitrogen metabolism, metallothionein, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, and enzymes responsible for maltose and galactose utilization. Suitable vectors and promoters for use in yeast expression are further described in EP 73,657. Yeast enhancers also are advantageously used with yeast promoters.
  • Antibody transcription from vectors in mammalian host cells can be controlled, for example, by promoters obtained from the genomes of viruses such as polyoma virus, fowlpox virus, adenovirus (such as Adenovirus 2), bovine papilloma virus, avian sarcoma virus, cytomegalovirus, a retrovirus, hepatitis-B virus, Simian Virus 40 (SV40), or from heterologous mammalian promoters, e.g., the actin promoter or an immunoglobulin promoter, from heat-shock promoters, provided such promoters are compatible with the host cell systems.
  • The early and late promoters of the SV40 virus are conveniently obtained as an SV40 restriction fragment that also contains the SV40 viral origin of replication. The immediate early promoter of the human cytomegalovirus is conveniently obtained as a HindIII E restriction fragment. A system for expressing DNA in mammalian hosts using the bovine papilloma virus as a vector is disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 4,419,446. A modification of this system is described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,601,978. See also Reyes et al., Nature 297:598-601 (1982) on expression of human n-interferon cDNA in mouse cells under the control of a thymidine kinase promoter from herpes simplex virus. Alternatively, the Rous Sarcoma Virus long terminal repeat can be used as the promoter.
  • (e) Enhancer Element Component
  • Transcription of a DNA encoding an antibody of this invention by higher eukaryotes is often increased by inserting an enhancer sequence into the vector. Many enhancer sequences are now known from mammalian genes (globin, elastase, albumin, α-fetoprotein, and insulin). Typically, however, one will use an enhancer from a eukaryotic cell virus. Examples include the SV40 enhancer on the late side of the replication origin (bp 100-270), the cytomegalovirus early promoter enhancer, the polyoma enhancer on the late side of the replication origin, and adenovirus enhancers. See also Yaniv, Nature 297:17-18 (1982) on enhancing elements for activation of eukaryotic promoters. The enhancer may be spliced into the vector at a position 5′ or 3′ to the antibody-encoding sequence, but is preferably located at a site 5′ from the promoter.
  • (f) Transcription Termination Component
  • Expression vectors used in eukaryotic host cells (yeast, fungi, insect, plant, animal, human, or nucleated cells from other multicellular organisms) will also contain sequences necessary for the termination of transcription and for stabilizing the mRNA. Such sequences are commonly available from the 5′ and, occasionally 3′, untranslated regions of eukaryotic or viral DNAs or cDNAs. These regions contain nucleotide segments transcribed as polyadenylated fragments in the untranslated portion of the mRNA encoding antibody. One useful transcription termination component is the bovine growth hormone polyadenylation region. See WO94/11026 and the expression vector disclosed therein.
  • (a) Selection and Transformation of Host Cells
  • Suitable host cells for cloning or expressing the DNA in the vectors herein are the prokaryote, yeast, or higher eukaryote cells described above. Suitable prokaryotes for this purpose include eubacteria, such as Gram-negative or Gram-positive organisms, for example, Enterobacteriaceae such as Escherichia, e.g., E. coli, Enterobacter, Erwinia, Klebsiella, Proteus, Salmonella, e.g., Salmonella typhimurium, Serratia, e.g., Serratia marcescans, and Shigella, as well as Bacilli such as B. subtilis and B. licheniformis (e.g., B. licheniformis 41P disclosed in DD 266,710 published 12 Apr. 1989), Pseudomonas such as P. aeruginosa, and Streptomyces. One preferred E. coli cloning host is E. coli 294 (ATCC 31,446), although other strains such as E. coli B, E. coli X1776 (ATCC 31,537), and E. coli W3110 (ATCC 27,325) are suitable. These examples are illustrative rather than limiting.
  • Full length antibody, antibody fusion proteins, and antibody fragments can be produced in bacteria, in particular when glycosylation and Fc effector function are not needed, such as when the therapeutic antibody is conjugated to a cytotoxic agent (e.g., a toxin) that by itself shows effectiveness in tumor cell destruction. Full length antibodies have greater half-life in circulation. Production in E. coli is faster and more cost efficient. For expression of antibody fragments and polypeptides in bacteria, see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 5,648,237 (Carter et. al.), U.S. Pat. No. 5,789,199 (Joly et al.), U.S. Pat. No. 5,840,523 (Simmons et al.), which describes translation initiation region (TIR) and signal sequences for optimizing expression and secretion. See also Charlton, Methods in Molecular Biology, Vol. 248 (B. K. C. Lo, ed., Humana Press, Totowa, N.J., 2003), pp. 245-254, describing expression of antibody fragments in E. coli. After expression, the antibody may be isolated from the E. coli cell paste in a soluble fraction and can be purified through, e.g., a protein A or G column depending on the isotype. Final purification can be carried out similar to the process for purifying antibody expressed e.g., in CHO cells.
  • In addition to prokaryotes, eukaryotic microbes such as filamentous fungi or yeast are suitable cloning or expression hosts for antibody-encoding vectors. Saccharomyces cerevisiae, or common baker's yeast, is the most commonly used among lower eukaryotic host microorganisms. However, a number of other genera, species, and strains are commonly available and useful herein, such as Schizosaccharomyces pombe; Kluyveromyces hosts such as, e.g., K. lactis, K fragilis (ATCC 12,424), K. bulgaricus (ATCC 16,045), K. wickeramii (ATCC 24,178), K. waltii (ATCC 56,500), Ki drosophilarum (ATCC 36,906), K. thermotolerans, and K. marxianus; yarrowia (EP 402,226); Pichia pastoris (EP 183,070); Candida; Trichoderma reesia (EP 244,234); Neurospora crassa; Schwanniomyces such as Schwanniomyces occidentalis; and filamentous fungi such as, e.g., Neurospora, Penicillium, Tolypocladium, and Aspergillus hosts such as A. nidulans and A. niger. For a review discussing the use of yeasts and filamentous fungi for the production of therapeutic proteins, see, e.g., Gemgross, Nat. Biotech. 22:1409-1414 (2004).
  • Certain fungi and yeast strains may be selected in which glycosylation pathways have been “humanized,” resulting in the production of an antibody with a partially or fully human glycosylation pattern. See, e.g., Li et al., Nat. Biotech. 24:210-215 (2006) (describing humanization of the glycosylation pathway in Pichia pastoris); and Gemgross et al., supra.
  • Suitable host cells for the expression of glycosylated antibody are also derived from multicellular organisms (invertebrates and vertebrates). Examples of invertebrate cells include plant and insect cells. Numerous baculoviral strains and variants and corresponding permissive insect host cells from hosts such as Spodoptera frugiperda (caterpillar), Aedes aegypti (mosquito), Aedes albopictus (mosquito), Drosophila melanogaster (fruitfly), and Bombyx mari have been identified. A variety of viral strains for transfection are publicly available, e.g., the L-1 variant of Autographa californica NPV and the Bm-5 strain of Bombyx mori NPV, and such viruses may be used as the virus herein according to the invention, particularly for transfection of Spodoptera frugiperda cells.
  • Plant cell cultures of cotton, corn, potato, soybean, petunia, tomato, duckweed (Leninaceae), alfalfa (M. truncatula), and tobacco can also be utilized as hosts. See, e.g., U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,959,177, 6,040,498, 6,420,548, 7,125,978, and 6,417,429 (describing PLANTIBODIES™ technology for producing antibodies in transgenic plants).
  • Vertebrate cells may be used as hosts, and propagation of vertebrate cells in culture (tissue culture) has become a routine procedure. Examples of useful mammalian host cell lines are monkey kidney CV1 line transformed by SV40 (COS-7, ATCC CRL 1651); human embryonic kidney line (293 or 293 cells subcloned for growth in suspension culture, Graham et al., J. Gen Virol. 36:59 (1977)); baby hamster kidney cells (BHK, ATCC CCL 10); mouse sertoli cells (TM4, Mather, Biol. Reprod. 23:243-251 (1980)); monkey kidney cells (CV1 ATCC CCL 70); African green monkey kidney cells (VERO-76, ATCC CRL-1587); human cervical carcinoma cells (HELA, ATCC CCL 2); canine kidney cells (MDCK, ATCC CCL 34); buffalo rat liver cells (BRL 3A, ATCC CRL 1442); human lung cells (W138, ATCC CCL 75); human liver cells (Hep G2, HB 8065); mouse mammary tumor (MMT 060562, ATCC CCL51); TRI cells (Mather et al., Annals N.Y. Acad. Sci. 383:44-68 (1982)); MRC 5 cells; FS4 cells; and a human hepatoma line (Hep G2). Other useful mammalian host cell lines include Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) cells, including DHFR-CHO cells (Urlaub et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 77:4216 (1980)); and myeloma cell lines such as NS0 and Sp2/0. For a review of certain mammalian host cell lines suitable for antibody production, see, e.g., Yazaki and Wu, Methods in Molecular Biology, Vol. 248 (B. K. C. Lo, ed., Humana Press, Totowa, N.J., 2003), pp. 255-268.
  • Host cells are transformed with the above-described expression or cloning vectors for antibody production and cultured in conventional nutrient media modified as appropriate for inducing promoters, selecting transformants, or amplifying the genes encoding the desired sequences.
  • (h) Culturing the Host Cells
  • The host cells used to produce an antibody of this invention may be cultured in a variety of media. Commercially available media such as Ham's F10 (Sigma), Minimal Essential Medium ((MEM), (Sigma), RPMI-1640 (Sigma), and Dulbecco's Modified Eagle's Medium ((DMEM), Sigma) are suitable for culturing the host cells. In addition, any of the media described in Ham et al., Meth. Enz. 58:44 (1979), Barnes et al., Anal. Biochem. 102:255 (1980), U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,767,704; 4,657,866; 4,927,762; 4,560,655; or 5,122,469; WO 90/03430; WO 87/00195; or U.S. Pat. Re. 30,985 may be used as culture media for the host cells. Any of these media may be supplemented as necessary with hormones and/or other growth factors (such as insulin, transferrin, or epidermal growth factor), salts (such as sodium chloride, calcium, magnesium, and phosphate), buffers (such as HEPES), nucleotides (such as adenosine and thymidine), antibiotics (such as GENTAMYCIN™ drug), trace elements (defined as inorganic compounds usually present at final concentrations in the micromolar range), and glucose or an equivalent energy source. Any other necessary supplements may also be included at appropriate concentrations that would be known to those skilled in the art. The culture conditions, such as temperature, pH, and the like, are those previously used with the host cell selected for expression, and will be apparent to the ordinarily skilled artisan.
  • (xiv) Purification of Antibody
  • When using recombinant techniques, the antibody can be produced intracellularly, in the periplasmic space, or directly secreted into the medium. If the antibody is produced intracellularly, as a first step, the particulate debris, either host cells or lysed fragments, are removed, for example, by centrifugation or ultrafiltration. Carter et al., Bio/Technology 10:163-167 (1992) describe a procedure for isolating antibodies which are secreted to the periplasmic space of E. coli Briefly, cell paste is thawed in the presence of sodium acetate (pH 3.5), EDTA, and phenylmethylsulfonylfluoride (PMSF) over about 30 min. Cell debris can be removed by centrifugation. Where the antibody is secreted into the medium, supernatants from such expression systems are generally first concentrated using a commercially available protein concentration filter, for example, an Amicon or Millipore Pellicon ultrafiltration unit. A protease inhibitor such as PMSF may be included in any of the foregoing steps to inhibit proteolysis and antibiotics may be included to prevent the growth of adventitious contaminants.
  • The antibody composition prepared from the cells can be purified using, for example, hydroxylapatite chromatography, hydrophobic interaction chromatography, gel electrophoresis, dialysis, and affinity chromatography, with affinity chromatography being among one of the typically preferred purification steps. The suitability of protein A as an affinity ligand depends on the species and isotype of any immunoglobulin Fc domain that is present in the antibody. Protein A can be used to purify antibodies that are based on human γ1, γ2, or γ4 heavy chains (Lindmark et al., J. Immunol. Meth. 62:1-13 (1983)). Protein G is recommended for all mouse isotypes and for human γ3 (Guss et al., EMBO J. 5:15671575 (1986)). The matrix to which the affinity ligand is attached is most often agarose, but other matrices are available. Mechanically stable matrices such as controlled pore glass or poly(styrenedivinyl)benzene allow for faster flow rates and shorter processing times than can be achieved with agarose. Where the antibody comprises a CM3 domain, the Bakerbond ABX™ resin (J. T. Baker, Phillipsburg, N.J.) is useful for purification. Other techniques for protein purification such as fractionation on an ion-exchange column, ethanol precipitation, Reverse Phase HPLC, chromatography on silica, chromatography on heparin SEPHAROSE™ chromatography on an anion or cation exchange resin (such as a polyaspartic acid column), chromatofocusing, SDS-PAGE, and ammonium sulfate precipitation are also available depending on the antibody to be recovered.
  • In general, various methodologies for preparing antibodies for use in research, testing, and clinical are well-established in the art, consistent with the above-described methodologies and/or as deemed appropriate by one skilled in the art for a particular antibody of interest.
  • (xv) Selecting Biologically Active Antibodies
  • Antibodies produced as described above may be subjected to one or more “biological activity” assays to select an antibody with beneficial properties from a therapeutic perspective or selecting formulations and conditions that retain biological activity of the antibody. The antibody may be tested for its ability to bind the antigen against which it was raised. For example, methods known in the art (such as ELISA, Western Blot, etc.) may be used.
  • For example, for an anti-PD-L1 antibody, the antigen binding properties of the antibody can be evaluated in an assay that detects the ability to bind to PD-L1. In some embodiments, the binding of the antibody may be determined by saturation binding; ELISA; and/or competition assays (e.g. RIA's), for example. Also, the antibody may be subjected to other biological activity assays, e.g., in order to evaluate its effectiveness as a therapeutic. Such assays are known in the art and depend on the target antigen and intended use for the antibody. For example, the biological effects of PD-L1 blockade by the antibody can be assessed in CD8+ T cells, a lymphocytic choriomeningitis virus (LCMV) mouse model and/or a syngeneic tumor model e.g., as described in U.S. Pat. No. 8,217,149.
  • To screen for antibodies which bind to a particular epitope on the antigen of interest (e.g., those which block binding of the anti-PD-L1 antibody of the example to PD-L1), a routine cross-blocking assay such as that described in Antibodies, A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory, Ed Harlow and David Lane (1988), can be performed. Alternatively, epitope mapping, e.g. as described in Champe et al., J. Biol. Chem. 270:1388-1394 (1995), can be performed to determine whether the antibody binds an epitope of interest.
  • IV. Pharmaceutical Compositions and Formulations
  • Also provided herein are pharmaceutical compositions and formulations comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or an antibody described herein (such as an anti-PD-L1 antibody) and, optionally, a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. The invention also provides pharmaceutical compositions and formulations comprising taxanes, e.g., nab-paditaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions and formulations as described herein can be prepared by mixing the active ingredients (e.g., a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or a taxane) having the desired degree of purity with one or more optional pharmaceutically acceptable carriers (Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences 16th edition, Osol, A. Ed. (1980)), in the form of lyophilized formulations or aqueous solutions. Pharmaceutically acceptable carriers are generally nontoxic to recipients at the dosages and concentrations employed, and include, but are not limited to: buffers such as phosphate, citrate, and other organic acids; antioxidants including ascorbic acid and methionine; preservatives (such as octadecyldimethylbenzyl ammonium chloride; hexamethonium chloride; benzalkonium chloride; benzethonium chloride; phenol, butyl or benzyl alcohol; alkyl parabens such as methyl or propyl paraben; catechol; resorcinol; cyclohexanol; 3-pentanol; and m-cresol); low molecular weight (less than about 10 residues) polypeptides; proteins, such as serum albumin, gelatin, or immunoglobulins; hydrophilic polymers such as polyvinylpyrrolidone; amino acids such as glycine, glutamine, asparagine, histidine, arginine, or lysine; monosaccharides, disaccharides, and other carbohydrates including glucose, mannose, or dextrins; chelating agents such as EDTA; sugars such as sucrose, mannitol, trehalose or sorbitol; salt-forming counter-ions such as sodium; metal complexes (e.g. Zn-protein complexes); and/or non-ionic surfactants such as polyethylene glycol (PEG). Exemplary pharmaceutically acceptable carriers herein further include insterstitial drug dispersion agents such as soluble neutral-active hyaluronidase glycoproteins (sHASEGP), for example, human soluble PH-20 hyaluronidase glycoproteins, such as rHuPH20 (HYLENEX®, Baxter Intemational, Inc.). Certain exemplary sHASEGPs and methods of use, including rHuPH20, are described in US Patent Publication Nos. 2005/0260186 and 2006/0104968. In one aspect, a sHASEGP is combined with one or more additional glycosaminoglycanases such as chondroitinases.
  • Exemplary lyophilized antibody formulations are described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,267,958. Aqueous antibody formulations include those described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,171,586 and WO2006/044908, the latter formulations including a histidine-acetate buffer.
  • The compositions and formulations herein may also contain more than one active ingredients as necessary for the particular indication being treated, preferably those with complementary activities that do not adversely affect each other. Such active ingredients are suitably present in combination in amounts that are effective for the purpose intended.
  • Active ingredients may be entrapped in microcapsules prepared, for example, by coacervation techniques or by interfacial polymerization, for example, hydroxymethylcellulose or gelatin-microcapsules and poly-(methylmethacylate) microcapsules, respectively, in colloidal drug delivery systems (for example, liposomes, albumin microspheres, microemulsions, nano-particles and nanocapsules) or in macroemulsions. Such techniques are disclosed in Remington's Pharmaceutical Sciences 16th edition, Osol, A. Ed. (1980).
  • Sustained-release preparations may be prepared. Suitable examples of sustained-release preparations include semipermeable matrices of solid hydrophobic polymers containing the antibody, which matrices are in the form of shaped articles, e.g. films, or microcapsules. The formulations to be used for in vivo administration are generally sterile. Sterility may be readily accomplished, e.g., by filtration through sterile filtration membranes.
  • IV. Methods of Treatment
  • Provided herein are methods for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer (e.g., mTNBC) in an individual comprising administering to the individual an effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) or paclitaxel). In some embodiments, the treatment results in a response in the individual after treatment. In some embodiments, the response is a partial response. In some embodiments, the response is a complete response. In some embodiments, the treatment results in a sustained response (e.g., a sustained partial response or complete response) in the individual after cessation of the treatment. The methods described herein may find use in treating conditions where enhanced immunogenicity is desired such as increasing tumor immunogenicity for the treatment of cancer. Also provided herein are methods of enhancing immune function in an individual having a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer comprising administering to the individual an effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., MPDL3280A) and a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)). Any of the PD-1 axis binding antagonists and the taxanes known in the art or described herein may be used in the methods.
  • In some instances, the methods provided herein include administration of an effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist, and a PD-L2 binding antagonist. In some instances, the PD-L1 binding antagonist is an antibody, such as an antibody that is capable of inhibiting PD-L1 binding to PD-1 and B7.1, but does not disrupt binding of PD-1 to PD-L2. In some instances, the PD-L1 binding antagonist antibody is MPDL3280A, which may be administered at a dose of about 700 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks (e.g., about 750 mg to about 900 mg every two weeks, e.g., about 800 mg to about 850 mg every two weeks). In some embodiments, MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 840 mg every two weeks.
  • As a general proposition, the therapeutically effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., an anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) may be administered to a human will be in the range of about 0.01 to about 50 mg/kg of patient body weight whether by one or more administrations. In some embodiments, for example, the antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) is administered in a dose of about 0.01 to about 45 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 40 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 35 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 30 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 25 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 20 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 15 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 10 mg/kg, about 0.01 to about 5 mg/kg, or about 0.01 to about 1 mg/kg administered daily, for example. In some embodiments, the antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) is administered at 15 mg/kg. However, other dosage regimens may be useful. In one embodiment, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) is administered to a human at a dose of about 100 mg, about 200 mg, about 300 mg, about 400 mg, about 500 mg, about 600 mg, about 700 mg, about 800 mg, about 900 mg, about 1000 mg, about 1100 mg, about 1200 mg, about 1300 mg, about 1400 mg, or about 1500 mg. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) is administered at a dose of about 800 mg to about 850 mg every two weeks. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) is administered at a dose of about 840 mg every two weeks. The dose may be administered as a single dose or as multiple doses (e.g., 2 or 3 doses), such as infusions. The dose of the antibody administered in a combination treatment may be reduced as compared to a single treatment. In some embodiments, for example, the method for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual comprises a dosing regimen comprising treatment cycles, wherein the individual is administered, on days 1 and 15 of each cycle, a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) at a dose of about 840 mg, wherein each cycle is 28 days (i.e., each cycle is repeated every 28 days). The progress of this therapy is easily monitored by conventional techniques.
  • In some instances, the methods provided herein include administration of an effective amount of a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel). In some instances, the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®). In some instances, the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 to about 125 mg/m2 every week. In some instances, the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 every week. As a general proposition, the therapeutically effective amount of a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)) administered to a human will be in the range of about 25 to about 300 mg/m2 (e.g., about 25 mg/m2, about 50 mg/m2, about 75 mg/m2, about 100 mg/m2, about 125 mg/m2, about 150 mg/m2, about 175 mg/m2, about 200 mg/m2, about 225 mg/m2, about 250 mg/m2, about 275 mg/m2, or about 300 mg/m2), whether by one or more administrations. For example, in some embodiments, about 100 mg/m2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered. In some embodiments, nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered at 100 mg/m2 once a week. In some embodiments, about 125 mg/m2 of paclitaxel is administered. In some embodiments, paclitaxel is administered at 200 mg/m2 every three weeks. In some embodiments, the taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)) may be administered weekly, every 2 weeks, every 3 weeks, every 4 weeks, on days 1, 8 and 15 of each 21-day cycle, or on days 1, 8, and 15 of each 28-day cycle.
  • In some instances, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., an anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) and the taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) are administered in a single dosing regimen. The administration of these agents may be concurrent or separate within the context of the dosing regimen. For example, in some instances, the methods provided herein include a dosing regimen comprising treatment cycles, wherein the individual is administered, on days 1 and 15 of each cycle, a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist at a dose of about 840 mg, and on days 1, 8, and 15 of each cycle, a taxane at a dose of about 100 mg/m2, each cycle being repeated every 28 days.
  • In some embodiments, the methods further comprise administering an effective amount of a chemotherapeutic agent. In some instances, the chemotherapeutic agent is a platinum-based chemotherapeutic agent, such as carboplatin.
  • In some embodiments, the individual is a human. In some embodiments, the individual is suffering from locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. In some embodiments, the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC. In some embodiments, the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. In some embodiments, the individual has never had prior targeted systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. Thus, in certain instances, the methods for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer (e.g., mTNBC) in an individual or for enhancing immune function in an individual having a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer can serve as a first-line therapy for the individual.
  • In some embodiments, the individual has been treated with a cancer therapy before the combination treatment with a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane. In some embodiments, the individual has cancer that is resistant to one or more cancer therapies. In some embodiments, resistance to cancer therapy includes recurrence of cancer or refractory cancer. Recurrence may refer to the reappearance of cancer, in the original site or a new site, after treatment. In some embodiments, resistance to a cancer therapy includes progression of the cancer during treatment with the anti-cancer therapy. In some embodiments, resistance to a cancer therapy includes cancer that does not response to treatment. The cancer may be resistant at the beginning of treatment or it may become resistant during treatment. In some embodiments, the cancer is at early stage or at late stage.
  • In some embodiments, the combination therapy of the invention comprises administration of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane. The PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)) may be administered in any suitable manner known in the art. For example, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane may be administered sequentially (at different times) or concurrently (at the same time). In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is in a separate composition as the taxane. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is in the same composition as the taxane.
  • The PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane may be administered by the same route of administration or by different routes of administration. In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is administered intravenously, intramuscularly, subcutaneously, topically, orally, transdermally, intraperitoneally, intraorbitally, by implantation, by inhalation, intrathecally, intraventricularly, or intranasally. In some embodiments, the taxane is administered intravenously, intramuscularly, subcutaneously, topically, orally, transdermally, intraperitoneally, intraorbitally, by implantation, by inhalation, intrathecally, intraventricularly, or intranasally. An effective amount of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane may be administered for prevention or treatment of disease. The appropriate dosage of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or the taxane may be determined based on the type of disease to be treated, the type of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane, the severity and course of the disease, the clinical condition of the individual, the individual's clinical history and response to the treatment, and the discretion of the attending physician.
  • In some embodiments, the methods may further comprise an additional therapy. The additional therapy may be radiation therapy, surgery (e.g., lumpectomy and a mastectomy), chemotherapy, gene therapy, DNA therapy, viral therapy, RNA therapy, immunotherapy, bone marrow transplantation, nanotherapy, monoclonal antibody therapy, or a combination of the foregoing. The additional therapy may be in the form of adjuvant or neoadjuvant therapy. In some embodiments, the additional therapy is the administration of small molecule enzymatic inhibitor or anti-metastatic agent. In some embodiments, the additional therapy is the administration of side-effect limiting agents (e.g., agents intended to lessen the occurrence and/or severity of side effects of treatment, such as anti-nausea agents, etc.). In some embodiments, the additional therapy is radiation therapy. In some embodiments, the additional therapy is surgery. In some embodiments, the additional therapy is a combination of radiation therapy and surgery. In some embodiments, the additional therapy is gamma irradiation. In some embodiments, the additional therapy is therapy targeting PI3KAKT/mTOR pathway, HSP90 inhibitor, tubulin inhibitor, apoptosis inhibitor, and/or chemopreventative agent. The additional therapy may be one or more of the chemotherapeutic agents described herein.
  • In some embodiments, the methods further comprise administering a platinum-based chemotherapeutic agent with the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and taxane. In some embodiments, the platinum-based chemotherapeutic agent is carboplatin. Dosages and administration of carboplatin are well-known in the art. An exemplary dosage of carboplatin is administered with a target area under the curve (AUC) of 6 mg/ml. In some embodiments, the carboplatin is administered intravenously every 3 weeks.
  • In some embodiments, the methods include treating an individual suffering from mTNBC by administering anti-PD-L1 antibody MPDL3280A at 800 mg IV administered every two weeks (q2w), along with nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at 125 mg/m2 IV every week (q1w), for three weeks within the context of a 4-week (28-day) treatment cycle, which may be repeated until there is loss of clinical benefit, complete response, remission, or otherwise, at the discretion of the attending physician.
  • V. Other Combination Therapies
  • Also provided herein are methods for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual comprising administering to the individual a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) and a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)) in conjunction with another anti-cancer agent or cancer therapy. In some embodiments, the methods comprise administering to the individual a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist, a taxane, and an additional therapeutic agent.
  • In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a chemotherapy or chemotherapeutic agent. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a radiation therapy or radiotherapeutic agent. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a targeted therapy or targeted therapeutic agent. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an immunotherapy or immunotherapeutic agent, for example a monoclonal antibody.
  • Without wishing to be bound to theory, it is thought that enhancing T cell stimulation, by promoting an activating co-stimulatory molecule or by inhibiting a negative co-stimulatory molecule, may promote tumor cell death thereby treating or delaying progression of cancer. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) and a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)) may be administered in conjunction with an agonist directed against an activating co-stimulatory molecule. In some embodiments, an activating co-stimulatory molecule may include CD40, CD226, CD28, OX40, GITR, CD137, CD27, HVEM, or CD127. In some embodiments, the agonist directed against an activating co-stimulatory molecule is an agonist antibody that binds to CD40, CD226, CD28, OX40, GITR, CD137, CD27, HVEM, or CD127. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) and a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)) may be administered in conjunction with an antagonist directed against an inhibitory co-stimulatory molecule. In some embodiments, an inhibitory co-stimulatory molecule may include CTLA-4 (also known as CD152), PD-1, TIM-3, BTLA, VISTA, LAG-3, B7-H3, B7-H4, IDO, TIGIT, MICA/B, or arginase. In some embodiments, the antagonist directed against an inhibitory co-stimulatory molecule is an antagonist antibody that binds to CTLA-4, PD-1, TIM-3, BTLA, VISTA, LAG-3, B7-H3, B7-H4, IDO, TIGIT, MICA/B, or arginase.
  • In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) and a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)) may be administered in conjunction with an antagonist directed against CTLA-4 (also known as CD152), for example, a blocking antibody. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with ipilimumab (also known as MDX-010, MDX-101, or YERVOY®). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with tremelimumab (also known as ticilimumab or CP-675,206). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antagonist directed against B7-H3 (also known as CD276), for example, a blocking antibody. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with MGA271. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antagonist directed against a TGF beta, for example, metelimumab (also known as CAT-192), fresolimumab (also known as GC1008), or LY2157299.
  • In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment comprising adoptive transfer of a T cell (e.g., a cytotoxic T cell or CTL) expressing a chimeric antigen receptor (CAR). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment comprising adoptive transfer of a T cell comprising a dominant-negative TGF beta receptor, e.g, a dominant-negative TGF beta type II receptor. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment comprising a HERCREEM protocol (see, e.g., ClinicalTrials.gov Identifier NCT00889954).
  • In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an agonist directed against CD137 (also known as TNFRSF9, 4-1BB, or ILA), for example, an activating antibody. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with urelumab (also known as BMS-663513). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an agonist directed against CD40, for example, an activating antibody. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with CP-870893. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an agonist directed against OX40 (also known as CD134), for example, an activating antibody. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an anti-OX40 antibody (e.g., AgonOX). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an agonist directed against CD27, for example, an activating antibody. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with CDX-1127. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antagonist directed against indoleamine-2,3-dioxygenase (IDO). In some embodiments, with the IDO antagonist is 1-methyl-D-tryptophan (also known as I-D-MT).
  • In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody-drug conjugate. In some embodiments, the antibody-drug conjugate comprises mertansine or monomethyl auristatin E (MMAE). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with and anti-NaPi2b antibody-MMAE conjugate (also known as DNIB0600A or RG7599). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with trastuzumab emtansine (also known as T-DM1, ado-trastuzumab emtansine, or KADCYLA®, Genentech). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with DMUC5754A. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody-drug conjugate targeting the endothelin B receptor (EDNBR), for example, an antibody directed against EDNBR conjugated with MMAE.
  • In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an angiogenesis inhibitor. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody directed against a VEGF, for example, VEGF-A. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) and a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)) may be administered in conjunction with bevacizumab (also known as AVASTIN®, Genentech). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody directed against angiopoietin 2 (also known as Ang2). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with MEDI3617.
  • In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antineoplastic agent. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an agent targeting CSF-1R (also known as M-CSFR or CD115). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with anti-CSF-1 R (also known as IMC-CS4). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an interferon, for example interferon alpha or interferon gamma. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with Roferon-A (also known as recombinant Interferon alpha-2a). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with GM-CSF (also known as recombinant human granulocyte macrophage colony stimulating factor, rhu GM-CSF, sargramostim, or LEUKINE®). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with IL-2 (also known as aldesleukin or PROLEUKIN®). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with IL-12. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody targeting CD20. In some embodiments, the antibody targeting CD20 is obinutuzumab (also known as GA101 or GAZYVA®) or rituximab. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an antibody targeting GITR. In some embodiments, the antibody targeting GITR is TRX518.
  • In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a cancer vaccine. In some embodiments, the cancer vaccine is a peptide cancer vaccine, which in some embodiments is a personalized peptide vaccine. In some embodiments the peptide cancer vaccine is a multivalent long peptide, a multi-peptide, a peptide cocktail, a hybrid peptide, or a peptide-pulsed dendritic cell vaccine (see, e.g., Yamada et al., Cancer Sci, 104:14-21, 2013). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an adjuvant. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment comprising a TLR agonist, for example, Poly-ICLC (also known as HILTONOL®), LPS, MPL, or CpG ODN. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with tumor necrosis factor (TNF) alpha. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with IL-1. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with HMGB1. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an IL-10 antagonist. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an IL-4 antagonist. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an IL-13 antagonist. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an HVEM antagonist. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an ICOS agonist, e.g., by administration of ICOS-L, or an agonistic antibody directed against ICOS. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment targeting CX3CL1. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment targeting CXCL9. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment targeting CXCL10. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a treatment targeting CCL5. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an LFA-1 or ICAM1 agonist. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a Selectin agonist.
  • In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a targeted therapy. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of B-Raf. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with vemurafenib (also known as ZELBORAF®). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with dabrafenib (also known as TAFINLAR®). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with erlotinib (also known as TARCEVA®). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of a MEK, such as MEK1 (also known as MAP2K1) or MEK2 (also known as MAP2K2). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with cobimetinib (also known as GDC-0973 or XL-518). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with trametinib (also known as MEKINIST®). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of K-Ras. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of c-Met. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with onartuzumab (also known as MetMAb). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of Alk. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with AF802 (also known as CH5424802 or alectinib). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of a phosphatidylinositol 3-kinase (P13K). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with BKM120. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with idelalisib (also known as GS-1101 or CAL-101). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with perifosine (also known as KRX-0401). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of an Akt. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist may be administered in conjunction with MK2206. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with GSK690693. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with GDC-0941. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with an inhibitor of mTOR. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with sirolimus (also known as rapamycin). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with temsirolimus (also known as CCI-779 or TORISEL®). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with everolimus (also known as RAD001). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with ridaforolimus (also known as AP-23573, MK-8669, or deforolimus). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with OSI-027. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with AZD8055. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with INK128. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with a dual PI3K/mTOR inhibitor. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with XL765. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with GDC-0980. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with BEZ235 (also known as NVP-BEZ235). In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with BGT226. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with GSK2126458. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with PF-04691502. In some embodiments, a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane may be administered in conjunction with PF-05212384 (also known as PKI-587).
  • VI. Articles of Manufacture or Kits
  • In another embodiment of the invention, an article of manufacture or a kit is provided comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist (e.g., anti-PD-L1 antibody, e.g., MPDL3280A) and/or a taxane (e.g., nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®)). In some embodiments, the article of manufacture or kit further comprises package insert comprising instructions for using the PD-1 axis binding antagonist in conjunction with a a taxane to treat or delay progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual or to enhance immune function of an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer. Any of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or taxanes described herein may be included in the article of manufacture or kits.
  • In some embodiments, the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane are in the same container or separate containers. Suitable containers include, for example, bottles, vials, bags and syringes. The container may be formed from a variety of materials such as glass, plastic (such as polyvinyl chloride or polyolefin), or metal alloy (such as stainless steel or hastelloy). In some embodiments, the container holds the formulation and the label on, or associated with, the container may indicate directions for use. The article of manufacture or kit may further include other materials desirable from a commercial and user standpoint, including other buffers, diluents, filters, needles, syringes, and package inserts with instructions for use. In some embodiments, the article of manufacture further includes one or more of another agent (e.g., a chemotherapeutic agent, and anti-neoplastic agent). Suitable containers for the one or more agent include, for example, bottles, vials, bags and syringes.
  • The specification is considered to be sufficient to enable one skilled in the art to practice the invention. Various modifications of the invention in addition to those shown and described herein will become apparent to those skilled in the art from the foregoing description and fall within the scope of the appended claims.
  • EXAMPLES
  • The invention will be more fully understood by reference to the following examples. They should not, however, be construed as limiting the scope of the invention. It is understood that the examples and embodiments described herein are for illustrative purposes only and that various modifications or changes in light thereof will be suggested to persons skilled in the art and are to be included within the spirit and purview of this application and scope of the appended claims.
  • Example 1: Combination Treatment with Anti-Pd-L1 Antibody and Nab-Paclitaxel (Abraxane®) Achieved Response in a Phase Ib Clinical Trial for Patients with Metastatic Triple-Negative Breast Cancer (mTNBC)
  • Metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC) is associated with poor prognosis and is characterized by a high mutation rate, increased levels of tumor-infiltrating lymphocytes, and high PD-L1 expression levels. MPDL3280A is a humanized monoclonal antibody that can restore tumor-specific T-cell immunity by inhibiting the binding of PD-L1 to PD-1 and has demonstrated durable responses as a monotherapy in mTNBC. This study is the first combination trial of a checkpoint inhibitor with chemotherapy in patients with mTNBC.
  • Methods
  • This arm of a multi-center, multi-arm phase Ib study evaluated MPDL3280A in combination with weekly nab-paclitaxel in patients with mTNBC. Primary endpoints were safety and tolerability, with secondary endpoints of PK and clinical activity. Key eligibility criteria included measurable disease; Eastern Cooperative Oncology Group (ECOG) performance status of 0 or 1; and ≦2 prior cytotoxic regimens. Patients received atezolizumab 800 mg once every two weeks (on days 1 and 15) with nab-paditaxel 125 mg/m2 weekly (on days 1, 8, and 15) for 3 weeks in 4-week cycles, continued until loss of clinical benefit. If nab-paditaxel was discontinued due to toxicity, MPDL3280A could be continued as monotherapy. ORR was assessed by Response Evaluation Criteria In Solid Tumors (RECIST) v1.1. PD-L1 expression was scored at 4 diagnostic levels based on PD-L1 staining on tumor cells and tumor-infiltrating immune cells in an immunohistochemical (IHC) assay.
  • Results
  • Eleven patients were safety-evaluable. All patients were female with a median age of 58 years (age range: 32-75). No unexpected or dose-limiting toxicities were observed. The median duration of safety follow-up was 88 days (range: 27-182 days). The efficacy-evaluable population consisted of 5 patients who had ≧1 scan and ≧3 months follow-up. Of the five patients, four patients showed a partial response (PR) and one patient showed stable disease (SD). The observed results indicate that the combination of MPDL3280A and nab-paclitaxel is both safe and efficacious in patients with mTNBC.
  • Example 2: A Combination Treatment Regimen of Anti-PD-L1 Antibody and Nab-Paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) as a First-Line Therapy for Patients with mTNBC
  • As an alternative, a combination treatment regimen of MPDL3280A and nab-paclitaxel can serve as a first-line therapy for patients with mTNBC.
  • Patients with histologically documented locally advanced or metastatic TNBC; no prior systemic therapy for advanced TNBC; ECOG performance status of 0 or 1; and measurable disease per RECIST v1.1 may be dosed with MPDL3280A (840 mg) on days 1 and 15, plus nab-paclitaxel (100 mg/m2) on days 1, 8, and 15. All treatments are given on a 28-day cycle. Patients may be stratified by the presence of liver metastases, prior taxane therapy, and the PD-L1 status of tumor-infiltrating immune cells (IC0 vs IC1/2/3), which can be centrally evaluated by IHC. To capture pseudo-progression and delayed responses to MPDL3280A, patients with radiographic progression may continue to receive open-label MPDL3280A alone or with nab-paclitaxel until unacceptable toxicity or loss of clinical benefit.
  • OTHER EMBODIMENTS
  • Although the foregoing invention has been described in some detail by way of illustration and example for purposes of clarity of understanding, the descriptions and examples should not be construed as limiting the scope of the invention. The disclosures of all patent and scientific literature cited herein are expressly incorporated in their entirety by reference.

Claims (164)

What is claimed is:
1. A method for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual comprising administering to the individual an effective amount of a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
2. The method of claim 1, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist, and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
3. The method of claim 2, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-1 binding antagonist.
4. The method of claim 3, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to its ligand binding partners.
5. The method of claim 4, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L1.
6. The method of claim 4, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L2.
7. The method of claim 4, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to both PD-L1 and PD-L2.
8. The method of any one of claims 4-7, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist is an antibody.
9. The method of claim 3, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of MDX 1106 (nivolumab), MK-3475 (pembrolizumab), CT-011 (pidilizumab), MEDI-0680 (AMP-514), PDR001, REGN2810, and BGB-108.
10. The method of claim 2, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
11. The method of claim 10, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to PD-1.
12. The method of claim 10, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to B7-1.
13. The method of claim 10, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to both PD-1 and B7-1.
14. The method of any one of claims 11-13, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist is an antibody.
15. The method of claim 14, wherein the antibody is selected from the group consisting of: MPDL3280A (atezolizumab), YW243.55.S70, MDX-1105, MED14736 (durvalumab), and MSB0010718C (avelumab).
16. The method of claim 15, wherein the antibody is MPDL3280A.
17. The method of claim 16, wherein MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 800 mg to about 850 mg every two weeks.
18. The method of claim 17, wherein MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 840 mg every two weeks.
19. The method of claim 14, wherein the antibody comprises a heavy chain comprising HVR-H1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:19, HVR-H2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:20, and HVR-H3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:21; and a light chain comprising HVR-L1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:22, HVR-L2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:23, and HVR-L3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:24.
20. The method of claim 14 or 19, wherein the antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:25 and a light chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4.
21. The method of claim 2, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
22. The method of claim 21, wherein the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an antibody.
23. The method of claim 21, wherein the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an immunoadhesin.
24. The method of any one of claims 1-23, wherein the metastatic breast cancer is metastatic triple-negative breast cancer (mTNBC).
25. The method of any one of claims 1-24, wherein the individual has locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer or has been diagnosed with locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
26. The method of claim 25, wherein the cancer cells in the individual express PD-L1.
27. The method of claim 26, wherein PD-L1 expression is determined by an immunohistochemistry (IHC) assay.
28. The method of any one of claims 1-27, wherein the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
29. The method of any one of claims 1-28, wherein the individual has never had prior targeted systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
30. The method of any one of claims 1-29, wherein the treatment results in a response in the individual.
31. The method of claim 30, wherein the response is a complete response.
32. The method of claim 30, wherein the response is a partial response.
33. The method of any one of claims 30-32, wherein the response is a sustained response after cessation of the treatment.
34. The method of any one of claims 1-33, wherein the taxane is administered before the PD-1 axis binding antagonist, simultaneous with the PD-1 axis binding antagonist, or after the PD-1 axis binding antagonist.
35. The method of any one of claims 1-34, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel.
36. The method of claim 35, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
37. The method of claim 36, wherein the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 to about 125 mg/m2 every week.
38. The method of claim 37, wherein the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 every week.
39. The method of claim 32, wherein the taxane is paclitaxel.
40. A method for treating or delaying progression of locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the method comprises a dosing regimen comprising treatment cycles, wherein the individual is administered, on days 1 and 15 of each cycle, a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist at a dose of about 840 mg, and on days 1, 8, and 15 of each cycle, a taxane at a dose of about 100 mg/m2, each cycle being repeated every 28 days.
41. The method of claim 40, wherein the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC.
42. The method of claim 40 or 41, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
43. The method of claim 42, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
44. The method of any one of claims 40-43, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
45. The method of any one of claims 40-44, wherein the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
46. The method of any one of claims 40-45, wherein the individual has never had prior targeted systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
47. A method of enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer comprising administering an effective amount of a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and a taxane.
48. The method of claim 47, wherein CD8+ T cells in the individual have enhanced priming, activation, proliferation, and/or cytolytic activity relative to prior to the administration of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane.
49. The method of claim 47, wherein the number of CD8+ T cells is elevated relative to prior to administration of the combination.
50. The method of claim 49, wherein the CD8+ T cell is an antigen-specific CD8+ T cell.
51. The method of claim 47, wherein Treg function is suppressed relative to prior to the administration of the combination.
52. The method of claim 47, wherein T cell exhaustion is decreased relative to prior to the administration of the combination.
53. The method of any one of claims 47-52, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of a PD-1 binding antagonist, a PD-L1 binding antagonist and a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
54. The method of claim 53, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-1 binding antagonist.
55. The method of claim 54, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to its ligand binding partners.
56. The method of claim 55, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L1.
57. The method of claim 55, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to PD-L2.
58. The method of claim 55, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-1 to both PD-L1 and PD-L2.
59. The method of any one of claims 55-58, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist is an antibody.
60. The method of claim 54, wherein the PD-1 binding antagonist is selected from the group consisting of MDX 1106 (nivolumab), MK-3475 (pembrolizumab), CT-011 (pidilizumab), MEDI-0680 (AMP-514), PDR001, REGN2810, and BGB-108.
61. The method of claim 53, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
62. The method of claim 61, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to PD-1.
63. The method of claim 61, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to B7-1.
64. The method of claim 61, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist inhibits the binding of PD-L1 to both PD-1 and B7-1.
65. The method of any one of claims 61-64, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist is an antibody.
66. The method of claim 65, wherein antibody is selected from the group consisting of: MPDL3280A (atezolizumab), YW243.55.S70, MDX-1105, MED14736 (durvalumab), and MSB0010718C (avelumab).
67. The method of claim 66, wherein the antibody is MPDL3280A.
68. The method of claim 67, wherein MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 800 mg to about 850 mg every two weeks.
69. The method of claim 68, wherein MPDL3280A is administered at a dose of about 840 mg every two weeks.
70. The method of claim 65, wherein the antibody comprises a heavy chain comprising HVR-H1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:19, HVR-H2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:20, and HVR-H3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:21; and a light chain comprising HVR-L1 sequence of SEQ ID NO:22, HVR-L2 sequence of SEQ ID NO:23, and HVR-L3 sequence of SEQ ID NO:24.
71. The method of claim 65, wherein the antibody comprises a heavy chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:25 and a light chain variable region comprising the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO:4.
72. The method of claim 53, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L2 binding antagonist.
73. The method of claim 72, wherein the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an antibody.
74. The method of claim 72, wherein the PD-L2 binding antagonist is an immunoadhesin.
75. The method of any one of claims 47-74, wherein the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC.
76. The method of any one of claims 47-75, wherein the cancer cells in the individual express PD-L1.
77. The method of claim 76, wherein PD-L1 expression is determined by an IHC assay.
78. The method of any one of claims 47-77, wherein the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
79. The method of any one of claims 47-78, wherein the individual has never had prior targeted systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
80. The method of any one of claims 47-79, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), paclitaxel, or docetaxel.
81. The method of claim 80, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
82. The method of claim 81, wherein the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 to about 125 mg/m2 every week.
83. The method of claim 82, wherein the nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) is administered to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 every week.
84. The method of claim 80, wherein the taxane is paclitaxel.
85. A method of enhancing immune function in an individual having locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer, wherein the method comprises a dosing regimen comprising treatment cycles, wherein the individual is administered, on days 1 and 15 of each cycle, a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist at a dose of about 840 mg, and on days 1, 8, and 15 of each cycle, a taxane at a dose of about 100 mg/m2, each cycle being repeated every 28 days.
86. The method of claim 85, wherein CD8+ T cells in the individual have enhanced priming, activation, proliferation, and/or cytolytic activity relative to prior to the administration of the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and the taxane.
87. The method of claim 85, wherein the number of CD8+ T cells is elevated relative to prior to administration of the combination.
88. The method of claim 87, wherein the CD8+ T cell is an antigen-specific CD8+ T cell.
89. The method of claim 85, wherein Treg function is suppressed relative to prior to the administration of the combination.
90. The method of claim 85, wherein T cell exhaustion is decreased relative to prior to the administration of the combination.
91. The method of any one of claims 85-90, wherein the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC.
92. The method of any one of claims 85-91, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
93. The method of claim 92, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
94. The method of any one of claims 85-93, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
95. The method of any one of claims 85-94, wherein the individual has had two or fewer prior cytotoxic treatment regimens for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
96. The method of any one of claims 85-95, wherein the individual has never had prior targeted systemic treatment for locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer.
97. The method of any one of claims 1-96, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist and/or the taxane are administered intravenously, intramuscularly, subcutaneously, topically, orally, transdermally, intraperitoneally, intraorbitally, by implantation, by inhalation, intrathecally, intraventricularly, or intranasally.
98. The method of any one of claims 1-97, further comprising administering an effective amount of a chemotherapeutic agent.
99. Use of a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist in the manufacture of a medicament for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the medicament comprises the human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and wherein the treatment comprises administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
100. The use of claim 99, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
101. The use of claim 100, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
102. The use of claim 101, wherein the medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
103. The use of claim 102, wherein the treatment comprises administration of the medicament once every two weeks to the individual.
104. The use of any one of claims 99-103, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
105. The use of claim 104, wherein the treatment comprises administration of the composition to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
106. The use of claim 105, wherein the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every week to the individual.
107. The use of claim 103, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) and the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every week to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 of nab-paditaxel (ABRAXANE®).
108. Use of a taxane in the manufacture of a medicament for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the medicament comprises the taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and wherein the treatment comprises administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
109. The use of claim 108, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
110. The use of claim 109, wherein the treatment comprises administration of the medicament to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
111. The use of claim 110, wherein the treatment comprises administration of the medicament once every week to the individual.
112. The use of any one of claims 108-111, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
113. The use of claim 112, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
114. The use of claim 113, wherein the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
115. The use of claim 114, wherein the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual.
116. The use of claim 111, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is MPDL3280A and the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual at a dose of about 840 mg of MPDL3280A.
117. The use of any one of claims 99-116, wherein the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC.
118. A composition comprising a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier for use in treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the treatment comprises administration of said composition in combination with a second composition, wherein the second composition comprises a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
119. The composition of claim 118, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
120. The composition of claim 119, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
121. The composition of claim 120, wherein the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
122. The composition of claim 121, wherein the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual.
123. The composition of any one of claims 118-122, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
124. The composition of claim 123, wherein the second composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2.
125. The composition of claim 124, wherein the treatment comprises administration of the second composition once every week to the individual.
126. The composition of claim 122, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) and the treatment comprises administration of the second composition once every week to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 of nab-paditaxel (ABRAXANE®).
127. A composition comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier for use in treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual, wherein the treatment comprises administration of said composition in combination with a second composition, wherein the second composition comprises a human PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
128. The composition of claim 127, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
129. The composition of claim 128, wherein the composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2.
130. The composition of claim 129, wherein the treatment comprises administration of the composition once every week to the individual.
131. The composition of any one of claims 127-130, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-LI binding antagonist.
132. The composition of claim 131, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
133. The composition of claim 132, wherein the second composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
134. The composition of claim 133, wherein the treatment comprises administration of the second composition once every two weeks to the individual.
135. The composition of claim 130, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is MPDL3280A and the treatment comprises administration of the second composition once every two weeks to the individual at a dose of about 840 mg of MPDL3280A.
136. The composition of any one of claims 99-116, wherein the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC.
137. A kit comprising a medicament comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and a package insert comprising instructions for administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carder for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual.
138. The kit of claim 137, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
139. The kit of claim 138, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
140. The kit of claim 139, wherein the medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
141. The kit of claim 140, wherein the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the medicament once every two weeks to the individual.
142. The kit of any one of claims 137-141, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
143. The kit of claim 142, wherein the composition comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2.
144. The kit of claim 143, wherein the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the composition once every week to the individual.
145. The kit of claim 141, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®), and the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the composition once every week to the individual at a dose of about 100 mg/m2 of nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
146. A kit comprising a first medicament comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, a second medicament comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and a package insert comprising instructions for administration of the first medicament and the second medicament for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual.
147. The kit of claim 146, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
148. The kit of claim 147, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
149. The kit of claim 148, wherein the first medicament comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
150. The kit of claim 149, wherein the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the first medicament once every two weeks to the individual.
151. The kit of any one of claims 146-150, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
152. The kit of claim 151, wherein the second medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2.
153. The kit of claim 152, wherein the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the second medicament once every week to the individual.
154. The kit of claim 150, wherein the second medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2, and the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the second medicament once every week to the individual.
155. A kit comprising a medicament comprising a taxane and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, and a package insert comprising instructions for administration of the medicament in combination with a composition comprising a PD-1 axis binding antagonist and an optional pharmaceutically acceptable carrier for treating or delaying progression of a locally advanced or metastatic breast cancer in an individual.
156. The kit of claim 155, wherein the taxane is nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®).
157. The kit of claim 156, wherein the medicament comprises nab-paclitaxel (ABRAXANE®) at a dose of about 100 mg/m2.
158. The kit of claim 157, wherein the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the medicament once every week to the individual.
159. The kit of any one of claims 155-158, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is a PD-L1 binding antagonist.
160. The kit of claim 159, wherein the PD-L1 binding antagonist is MPDL3280A.
161. The kit of claim 160, wherein the composition comprises MPDL3280A at a dose of about 840 mg.
162. The kit of claim 161, wherein the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual.
163. The kit of claim 158, wherein the PD-1 axis binding antagonist is MPDL3280A, and the package insert comprises instructions for administration of the composition once every two weeks to the individual at a dose of about 840 mg of MPDL3280A.
164. The kit of any one of claims 137-163, wherein the metastatic breast cancer is mTNBC.
US15/811,026 2015-06-17 2017-11-13 Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using PD-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes Active 2036-11-18 US11154616B2 (en)

Priority Applications (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US15/811,026 US11154616B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2017-11-13 Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using PD-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes
US17/477,090 US20220133886A1 (en) 2015-06-17 2021-09-16 Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes

Applications Claiming Priority (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US201562181159P 2015-06-17 2015-06-17
PCT/US2016/037559 WO2016205320A1 (en) 2015-06-17 2016-06-15 Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes
US15/811,026 US11154616B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2017-11-13 Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using PD-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2016/037559 Continuation WO2016205320A1 (en) 2015-06-17 2016-06-15 Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US17/477,090 Division US20220133886A1 (en) 2015-06-17 2021-09-16 Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes

Publications (2)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20180055927A1 true US20180055927A1 (en) 2018-03-01
US11154616B2 US11154616B2 (en) 2021-10-26

Family

ID=56322299

Family Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US15/811,026 Active 2036-11-18 US11154616B2 (en) 2015-06-17 2017-11-13 Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using PD-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes
US17/477,090 Pending US20220133886A1 (en) 2015-06-17 2021-09-16 Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes

Family Applications After (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US17/477,090 Pending US20220133886A1 (en) 2015-06-17 2021-09-16 Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes

Country Status (12)

Country Link
US (2) US11154616B2 (en)
EP (1) EP3310815A1 (en)
JP (2) JP6896650B2 (en)
KR (1) KR20180018538A (en)
CN (2) CN116327953A (en)
AR (1) AR105027A1 (en)
AU (2) AU2016280070B2 (en)
CA (1) CA2986263A1 (en)
HK (1) HK1251493A1 (en)
IL (1) IL256080A (en)
MX (2) MX2017016353A (en)
WO (1) WO2016205320A1 (en)

Cited By (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US10570213B2 (en) 2013-12-17 2020-02-25 Genentech, Inc. Methods of treating cancers using PD-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes
US10596257B2 (en) 2016-01-08 2020-03-24 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Methods of treating CEA-positive cancers using PD-1 axis binding antagonists and anti-CEA/anti-CD3 bispecific antibodies

Families Citing this family (11)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CA2974651A1 (en) 2014-01-24 2015-07-30 Children's Hospital Of Eastern Ontario Research Institute Inc. Smc combination therapy for the treatment of cancer
EP3310815A1 (en) 2015-06-17 2018-04-25 F. Hoffmann-La Roche AG Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes
KR20180040138A (en) 2015-07-13 2018-04-19 싸이톰스 테라퓨틱스, 인크. Anti-PD-1 antibodies, activatable anti-PD-1 antibodies, and methods of using them
BR112018003186A2 (en) 2015-09-01 2018-09-25 Agenus Inc. anti-pd-1 antibodies and their methods of use
WO2018064299A1 (en) * 2016-09-29 2018-04-05 Genentech, Inc. Combination therapy with a mek inhibitor, a pd-1 axis inhibitor, and a taxane
EP3691631A1 (en) * 2017-10-03 2020-08-12 Crititech, Inc. Local delivery of antineoplastic particles in combination with systemic delivery of immunotherapeutic agents for the treatment of cancer
US20210147547A1 (en) * 2018-04-13 2021-05-20 Novartis Ag Dosage Regimens For Anti-Pd-L1 Antibodies And Uses Thereof
EP4249917A3 (en) * 2018-09-21 2023-11-08 F. Hoffmann-La Roche AG Diagnostic methods for triple-negative breast cancer
WO2020081398A1 (en) * 2018-10-14 2020-04-23 Dynavax Technologies Corporation Combination including a cpg-c type oligonucleotide and a pd-1 antagonist for treating breast cancer
EP3962947A2 (en) * 2019-05-03 2022-03-09 F. Hoffmann-La Roche AG Methods of treating cancer with an anti-pd-l1 antibody
WO2023144973A1 (en) * 2022-01-27 2023-08-03 中外製薬株式会社 Pharmaceutical composition containing anti-pd-l1 antibody to be used in combination with anti-vegf antibody and paclitaxel

Family Cites Families (192)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CU22545A1 (en) 1994-11-18 1999-03-31 Centro Inmunologia Molecular OBTAINING A CHEMICAL AND HUMANIZED ANTIBODY AGAINST THE RECEPTOR OF THE EPIDERMAL GROWTH FACTOR FOR DIAGNOSTIC AND THERAPEUTIC USE
USRE30985E (en) 1978-01-01 1982-06-29 Serum-free cell culture media
FR2413974A1 (en) 1978-01-06 1979-08-03 David Bernard DRYER FOR SCREEN-PRINTED SHEETS
US4419446A (en) 1980-12-31 1983-12-06 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services Recombinant DNA process utilizing a papilloma virus DNA as a vector
NZ201705A (en) 1981-08-31 1986-03-14 Genentech Inc Recombinant dna method for production of hepatitis b surface antigen in yeast
US4601978A (en) 1982-11-24 1986-07-22 The Regents Of The University Of California Mammalian metallothionein promoter system
US4560655A (en) 1982-12-16 1985-12-24 Immunex Corporation Serum-free cell culture medium and process for making same
US4657866A (en) 1982-12-21 1987-04-14 Sudhir Kumar Serum-free, synthetic, completely chemically defined tissue culture media
US4816567A (en) 1983-04-08 1989-03-28 Genentech, Inc. Recombinant immunoglobin preparations
DD266710A3 (en) 1983-06-06 1989-04-12 Ve Forschungszentrum Biotechnologie Process for the biotechnical production of alkaline phosphatase
US4767704A (en) 1983-10-07 1988-08-30 Columbia University In The City Of New York Protein-free culture medium
US4943533A (en) 1984-03-01 1990-07-24 The Regents Of The University Of California Hybrid cell lines that produce monoclonal antibodies to epidermal growth factor receptor
US4965199A (en) 1984-04-20 1990-10-23 Genentech, Inc. Preparation of functional human factor VIII in mammalian cells using methotrexate based selection
US4879231A (en) 1984-10-30 1989-11-07 Phillips Petroleum Company Transformation of yeasts of the genus pichia
GB8516415D0 (en) 1985-06-28 1985-07-31 Celltech Ltd Culture of animal cells
US4676980A (en) 1985-09-23 1987-06-30 The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Department Of Health And Human Services Target specific cross-linked heteroantibodies
US6548640B1 (en) 1986-03-27 2003-04-15 Btg International Limited Altered antibodies
US4927762A (en) 1986-04-01 1990-05-22 Cell Enterprises, Inc. Cell culture medium with antioxidant
GB8610600D0 (en) 1986-04-30 1986-06-04 Novo Industri As Transformation of trichoderma
IL85035A0 (en) 1987-01-08 1988-06-30 Int Genetic Eng Polynucleotide molecule,a chimeric antibody with specificity for human b cell surface antigen,a process for the preparation and methods utilizing the same
EP0307434B2 (en) 1987-03-18 1998-07-29 Scotgen Biopharmaceuticals, Inc. Altered antibodies
EP0435911B1 (en) 1988-09-23 1996-03-13 Cetus Oncology Corporation Cell culture medium for enhanced cell growth, culture longevity and product expression
GB8823869D0 (en) 1988-10-12 1988-11-16 Medical Res Council Production of antibodies
AU634186B2 (en) 1988-11-11 1993-02-18 Medical Research Council Single domain ligands, receptors comprising said ligands, methods for their production, and use of said ligands and receptors
FR2646437B1 (en) 1989-04-28 1991-08-30 Transgene Sa NOVEL DNA SEQUENCES, THEIR APPLICATION AS A SEQUENCE ENCODING A SIGNAL PEPTIDE FOR THE SECRETION OF MATURE PROTEINS BY RECOMBINANT YEASTS, EXPRESSION CASSETTES, PROCESSED YEASTS AND PROCESS FOR PREPARING THE SAME
EP0402226A1 (en) 1989-06-06 1990-12-12 Institut National De La Recherche Agronomique Transformation vectors for yeast yarrowia
DE3920358A1 (en) 1989-06-22 1991-01-17 Behringwerke Ag BISPECIFIC AND OLIGO-SPECIFIC, MONO- AND OLIGOVALENT ANTI-BODY CONSTRUCTS, THEIR PRODUCTION AND USE
DK0479909T3 (en) 1989-06-29 1997-04-07 Medarex Inc Bispecific reagents for AIDS treatment
ATE135373T1 (en) 1989-09-08 1996-03-15 Univ Johns Hopkins MODIFICATIONS OF THE STRUCTURE OF THE EGF RECEPTOR GENE IN HUMAN GLIOMA
US5959177A (en) 1989-10-27 1999-09-28 The Scripps Research Institute Transgenic plants expressing assembled secretory antibodies
EP1690935A3 (en) 1990-01-12 2008-07-30 Abgenix, Inc. Generation of xenogeneic antibodies
US6150584A (en) 1990-01-12 2000-11-21 Abgenix, Inc. Human antibodies derived from immunized xenomice
US6075181A (en) 1990-01-12 2000-06-13 Abgenix, Inc. Human antibodies derived from immunized xenomice
US5770429A (en) 1990-08-29 1998-06-23 Genpharm International, Inc. Transgenic non-human animals capable of producing heterologous antibodies
US5661016A (en) 1990-08-29 1997-08-26 Genpharm International Inc. Transgenic non-human animals capable of producing heterologous antibodies of various isotypes
US5545806A (en) 1990-08-29 1996-08-13 Genpharm International, Inc. Ransgenic non-human animals for producing heterologous antibodies
US5625126A (en) 1990-08-29 1997-04-29 Genpharm International, Inc. Transgenic non-human animals for producing heterologous antibodies
ES2246502T3 (en) 1990-08-29 2006-02-16 Genpharm International, Inc. TRANSGENIC NON-HUMAN ANIMALS ABLE TO PRODUCE HETEROLOGICAL ANTIBODIES.
US5633425A (en) 1990-08-29 1997-05-27 Genpharm International, Inc. Transgenic non-human animals capable of producing heterologous antibodies
US5122469A (en) 1990-10-03 1992-06-16 Genentech, Inc. Method for culturing Chinese hamster ovary cells to improve production of recombinant proteins
EP0564531B1 (en) 1990-12-03 1998-03-25 Genentech, Inc. Enrichment method for variant proteins with altered binding properties
US5571894A (en) 1991-02-05 1996-11-05 Ciba-Geigy Corporation Recombinant antibodies specific for a growth factor receptor
JPH06507398A (en) 1991-05-14 1994-08-25 リプリジェン コーポレーション Heterogeneous conjugate antibody for treatment of HIV infection
LU91067I2 (en) 1991-06-14 2004-04-02 Genentech Inc Trastuzumab and its variants and immunochemical derivatives including immotoxins
GB9114948D0 (en) 1991-07-11 1991-08-28 Pfizer Ltd Process for preparing sertraline intermediates
US7018809B1 (en) 1991-09-19 2006-03-28 Genentech, Inc. Expression of functional antibody fragments
US5587458A (en) 1991-10-07 1996-12-24 Aronex Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Anti-erbB-2 antibodies, combinations thereof, and therapeutic and diagnostic uses thereof
WO1993008829A1 (en) 1991-11-04 1993-05-13 The Regents Of The University Of California Compositions that mediate killing of hiv-infected cells
GB9300059D0 (en) 1992-01-20 1993-03-03 Zeneca Ltd Quinazoline derivatives
ATE503496T1 (en) 1992-02-06 2011-04-15 Novartis Vaccines & Diagnostic BIOSYNTHETIC BINDING PROTEIN FOR TUMOR MARKERS
ATE149570T1 (en) 1992-08-17 1997-03-15 Genentech Inc BISPECIFIC IMMUNOADHESINS
ES2091684T3 (en) 1992-11-13 1996-11-01 Idec Pharma Corp THERAPEUTIC APPLICATION OF CHEMICAL AND RADIO-MARKED ANTIBODIES AGAINST THE RESTRICTED DIFFERENTIATION ANTIGEN OF HUMAN B-LYMPHOCYTES FOR THE TREATMENT OF B-CELL LYMPHOMA.
AU691811B2 (en) 1993-06-16 1998-05-28 Celltech Therapeutics Limited Antibodies
GB9314893D0 (en) 1993-07-19 1993-09-01 Zeneca Ltd Quinazoline derivatives
DK0659439T3 (en) 1993-12-24 2002-01-14 Merck Patent Gmbh immunoconjugates
IL112249A (en) 1994-01-25 2001-11-25 Warner Lambert Co Pharmaceutical compositions containing di and tricyclic pyrimidine derivatives for inhibiting tyrosine kinases of the epidermal growth factor receptor family and some new such compounds
IL112248A0 (en) 1994-01-25 1995-03-30 Warner Lambert Co Tricyclic heteroaromatic compounds and pharmaceutical compositions containing them
US5679683A (en) 1994-01-25 1997-10-21 Warner-Lambert Company Tricyclic compounds capable of inhibiting tyrosine kinases of the epidermal growth factor receptor family
HU216142B (en) 1994-07-21 1999-04-28 Akzo Nobel N.V. Cyclic ketone peroxide formulations and their use for modification of (co)polymers
US5804396A (en) 1994-10-12 1998-09-08 Sugen, Inc. Assay for agents active in proliferative disorders
US5789199A (en) 1994-11-03 1998-08-04 Genentech, Inc. Process for bacterial production of polypeptides
US5840523A (en) 1995-03-01 1998-11-24 Genetech, Inc. Methods and compositions for secretion of heterologous polypeptides
US5731168A (en) 1995-03-01 1998-03-24 Genentech, Inc. Method for making heteromultimeric polypeptides
EP2163546B1 (en) 1995-03-30 2016-06-01 Pfizer Products Inc. Quinazoline derivatives
US5641870A (en) 1995-04-20 1997-06-24 Genentech, Inc. Low pH hydrophobic interaction chromatography for antibody purification
US5869046A (en) 1995-04-14 1999-02-09 Genentech, Inc. Altered polypeptides with increased half-life
GB9508538D0 (en) 1995-04-27 1995-06-14 Zeneca Ltd Quinazoline derivatives
EP1709970A1 (en) 1995-04-27 2006-10-11 Abgenix, Inc. Human antibodies against EGFR, derived from immunized xenomice
GB9508565D0 (en) 1995-04-27 1995-06-14 Zeneca Ltd Quiazoline derivative
CA2219486A1 (en) 1995-04-28 1996-10-31 Abgenix, Inc. Human antibodies derived from immunized xenomice
US5747498A (en) 1996-05-28 1998-05-05 Pfizer Inc. Alkynyl and azido-substituted 4-anilinoquinazolines
JPH11507535A (en) 1995-06-07 1999-07-06 イムクローン システムズ インコーポレイテッド Antibodies and antibody fragments that suppress tumor growth
BR9609617B1 (en) 1995-07-06 2010-07-27 7h-pyrrol [2,3-d] pyrimidine derivatives, and pharmaceutical composition.
US6267958B1 (en) 1995-07-27 2001-07-31 Genentech, Inc. Protein formulation
US5760041A (en) 1996-02-05 1998-06-02 American Cyanamid Company 4-aminoquinazoline EGFR Inhibitors
GB9603095D0 (en) 1996-02-14 1996-04-10 Zeneca Ltd Quinazoline derivatives
GB9603256D0 (en) 1996-02-16 1996-04-17 Wellcome Found Antibodies
BR9708640B1 (en) 1996-04-12 2013-06-11 irreversible tyrosine kinase inhibitors and pharmaceutical composition comprising them.
AU3766897A (en) 1996-07-13 1998-02-09 Glaxo Group Limited Fused heterocyclic compounds as protein tyrosine kinase inhibitors
CA2264177C (en) 1996-08-30 2015-03-17 Upfront Chromatography A/S Isolation of immunoglobulins
ID18494A (en) 1996-10-02 1998-04-16 Novartis Ag PIRAZOLA DISTRIBUTION IN THE SEQUENCE AND THE PROCESS OF MAKING IT
CA2722378C (en) 1996-12-03 2015-02-03 Amgen Fremont Inc. Human antibodies that bind tnf.alpha.
US20080318254A9 (en) 1997-03-10 2008-12-25 The Regents Of The University Of California PSCA antibodies and hybridomas producing them
US6002008A (en) 1997-04-03 1999-12-14 American Cyanamid Company Substituted 3-cyano quinolines
UA73073C2 (en) 1997-04-03 2005-06-15 Уайт Холдінгз Корпорейшн Substituted 3-cyan chinolines
US20020173629A1 (en) 1997-05-05 2002-11-21 Aya Jakobovits Human monoclonal antibodies to epidermal growth factor receptor
US6235883B1 (en) 1997-05-05 2001-05-22 Abgenix, Inc. Human monoclonal antibodies to epidermal growth factor receptor
DE69815340T2 (en) 1997-05-06 2004-05-06 Wyeth Holdings Corp. USE OF CHINAZOLIN COMPOUNDS FOR TREATING POLYCYSTIC KIDNEY DISEASE
US6171586B1 (en) 1997-06-13 2001-01-09 Genentech, Inc. Antibody formulation
EP0994903B1 (en) 1997-06-24 2005-05-25 Genentech, Inc. Methods and compositions for galactosylated glycoproteins
ZA986732B (en) 1997-07-29 1999-02-02 Warner Lambert Co Irreversible inhibitiors of tyrosine kinases
ZA986729B (en) 1997-07-29 1999-02-02 Warner Lambert Co Irreversible inhibitors of tyrosine kinases
TW436485B (en) 1997-08-01 2001-05-28 American Cyanamid Co Substituted quinazoline derivatives
US6040498A (en) 1998-08-11 2000-03-21 North Caroline State University Genetically engineered duckweed
WO1999022764A1 (en) 1997-10-31 1999-05-14 Genentech, Inc. Methods and compositions comprising glycoprotein glycoforms
CN1278176A (en) 1997-11-06 2000-12-27 美国氰胺公司 Use of quinazoline derivatives as tyrosine kinase inhibitors for treating colonic polyps
US6610833B1 (en) 1997-11-24 2003-08-26 The Institute For Human Genetics And Biochemistry Monoclonal human natural antibodies
BR9813365A (en) 1997-12-05 2004-06-15 Scripps Research Inst Method for Production and Humanization of a Mouse Monoclonal Antibody
US6194551B1 (en) 1998-04-02 2001-02-27 Genentech, Inc. Polypeptide variants
PT1068241E (en) 1998-04-02 2007-11-19 Genentech Inc Antibody variants and fragments thereof
DK1071700T3 (en) 1998-04-20 2010-06-07 Glycart Biotechnology Ag Glycosylation modification of antibodies to enhance antibody-dependent cellular cytotoxicity
PL347717A1 (en) 1998-11-19 2002-04-22 Warner Lambert Co N-[4-(3-chloro-4-fluoro-phenylamino)-7-(3-morpholin-4-yl-propoxy)-quinazolin-6-yl]-acrylamide, an irreversible inhibitor of tyrosine kinases
EP2364997A3 (en) 1999-01-15 2012-07-04 Genentech, Inc. Polypeptide variants with altered effector function
US6737056B1 (en) 1999-01-15 2004-05-18 Genentech, Inc. Polypeptide variants with altered effector function
AU754808B2 (en) 1999-03-30 2002-11-28 Amgen Fremont Inc. Method for preparing Monoclonal Antibody
ES2420835T3 (en) 1999-04-09 2013-08-27 Kyowa Hakko Kirin Co., Ltd. Procedure to control the activity of immunofunctional molecules
ES2248127T3 (en) 1999-10-04 2006-03-16 Medicago Inc. METHOD FOR REGULATING THE TRANSCRIPTION OF FOREIGN GENES IN THE PRESENCE OF NIGTROGEN.
US7125978B1 (en) 1999-10-04 2006-10-24 Medicago Inc. Promoter for regulating expression of foreign genes
EP1229125A4 (en) 1999-10-19 2005-06-01 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Kk Process for producing polypeptide
IL149809A0 (en) 1999-12-15 2002-11-10 Genentech Inc Shotgun scanning, a combinatorial method for mapping functional protein epitopes
US7064191B2 (en) 2000-10-06 2006-06-20 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd. Process for purifying antibody
BR0114475A (en) 2000-10-06 2003-12-23 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Kk Cell for the production of antibody composition
US6946292B2 (en) 2000-10-06 2005-09-20 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd. Cells producing antibody compositions with increased antibody dependent cytotoxic activity
US6596541B2 (en) 2000-10-31 2003-07-22 Regeneron Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Methods of modifying eukaryotic cells
IL155977A0 (en) 2000-11-30 2003-12-23 Medarex Inc Transgenic transchromosomal rodents for making human antibodies
EP1463522A4 (en) 2001-05-16 2005-04-13 Einstein Coll Med Human antipneumococcal antibodies from non-human animals
NZ592087A (en) 2001-08-03 2012-11-30 Roche Glycart Ag Antibody glycosylation variants having increased antibody-dependent cellular cytotoxicity
NZ531211A (en) 2001-08-23 2007-04-27 Genmad As Human antibodies specific for interleukin 15 (IL-15)
JP2005532253A (en) 2001-10-25 2005-10-27 ジェネンテック・インコーポレーテッド Glycoprotein composition
US20040093621A1 (en) 2001-12-25 2004-05-13 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd Antibody composition which specifically binds to CD20
EP1500698B1 (en) 2002-04-09 2011-03-30 Kyowa Hakko Kirin Co., Ltd. Cell with depression or deletion of the activity of protein participating in gdp-fucose transport
AU2003236015A1 (en) 2002-04-09 2003-10-20 Kyowa Hakko Kirin Co., Ltd. Process for producing antibody composition
EP1498485A4 (en) 2002-04-09 2006-09-06 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Kk Cells with modified genome
JPWO2003084569A1 (en) 2002-04-09 2005-08-11 協和醗酵工業株式会社 Antibody composition-containing medicine
AU2003236019A1 (en) 2002-04-09 2003-10-20 Kyowa Hakko Kirin Co., Ltd. Drug containing antibody composition appropriate for patient suffering from Fc Gamma RIIIa polymorphism
US20040259150A1 (en) 2002-04-09 2004-12-23 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd. Method of enhancing of binding activity of antibody composition to Fcgamma receptor IIIa
AU2003239966B9 (en) 2002-06-03 2010-08-26 Genentech, Inc. Synthetic antibody phage libraries
US20040033228A1 (en) 2002-08-16 2004-02-19 Hans-Juergen Krause Formulation of human antibodies for treating TNF-alpha associated disorders
US7361740B2 (en) 2002-10-15 2008-04-22 Pdl Biopharma, Inc. Alteration of FcRn binding affinities or serum half-lives of antibodies by mutagenesis
JP4351674B2 (en) 2002-12-16 2009-10-28 ジェネンテック・インコーポレーテッド Immunoglobulin variants and their use and use
EP1585767A2 (en) 2003-01-16 2005-10-19 Genentech, Inc. Synthetic antibody phage libraries
WO2004064734A2 (en) 2003-01-17 2004-08-05 Threshold Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Combination therapies for the treatment of cancer
US20060258841A1 (en) 2003-01-17 2006-11-16 Josef Michl Pancreatic cancer associated antigen, antibody thereto, and diagnostic and treatment methods
US20060104968A1 (en) 2003-03-05 2006-05-18 Halozyme, Inc. Soluble glycosaminoglycanases and methods of preparing and using soluble glycosaminogly ycanases
US7871607B2 (en) 2003-03-05 2011-01-18 Halozyme, Inc. Soluble glycosaminoglycanases and methods of preparing and using soluble glycosaminoglycanases
JP4999158B2 (en) 2003-05-21 2012-08-15 メダレツクス・インコーポレーテツド Human monoclonal antibody against infection protective antigen of Bacillus anthracis
RU2005141512A (en) 2003-05-31 2007-07-20 Микромет Аг (De) PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS, INCLUDING BISPECIFIC ANTI-CD3, ANTI-CD19 ANTIBODY STRUCTURES FOR TREATMENT OF B-CELL DISORDERS
AU2004279742A1 (en) 2003-10-08 2005-04-21 Kyowa Hakko Kirin Co., Ltd. Fused protein composition
JPWO2005035778A1 (en) 2003-10-09 2006-12-21 協和醗酵工業株式会社 Method for producing antibody composition using RNA that suppresses function of α1,6-fucosyltransferase
WO2005044859A2 (en) 2003-11-05 2005-05-19 Glycart Biotechnology Ag Cd20 antibodies with increased fc receptor binding affinity and effector function
DE602004025840D1 (en) 2003-11-28 2010-04-15 Micromet Ag POLYPEPTIDE CONTAINING COMPOSITIONS
WO2005053742A1 (en) 2003-12-04 2005-06-16 Kyowa Hakko Kogyo Co., Ltd. Medicine containing antibody composition
US7235641B2 (en) 2003-12-22 2007-06-26 Micromet Ag Bispecific antibodies
AU2005230848B9 (en) 2004-03-31 2011-06-02 Genentech, Inc. Humanized anti-TGF-beta antibodies
US7785903B2 (en) 2004-04-09 2010-08-31 Genentech, Inc. Variable domain library and uses
EP2067789A1 (en) 2004-04-13 2009-06-10 F. Hoffmann-La Roche Ag Anti-P selectin antibodies
TWI309240B (en) 2004-09-17 2009-05-01 Hoffmann La Roche Anti-ox40l antibodies
JO3000B1 (en) 2004-10-20 2016-09-05 Genentech Inc Antibody Formulations.
CN109485727A (en) 2005-05-09 2019-03-19 小野药品工业株式会社 The human monoclonal antibodies of programmed death-1 (PD-1) and the method for carrying out treating cancer using anti-PD-1 antibody
DK1907424T3 (en) 2005-07-01 2015-11-09 Squibb & Sons Llc HUMAN MONOCLONAL ANTIBODIES TO PROGRAMMED death ligand 1 (PD-L1)
DK1940881T3 (en) 2005-10-11 2017-02-20 Amgen Res (Munich) Gmbh COMPOSITIONS WITH ARTICLE CROSS-SPECIFIC ANTIBODIES AND APPLICATIONS THEREOF
ES2577292T3 (en) 2005-11-07 2016-07-14 Genentech, Inc. Binding polypeptides with diversified VH / VL hypervariable sequences and consensus
EP1973951A2 (en) 2005-12-02 2008-10-01 Genentech, Inc. Binding polypeptides with restricted diversity sequences
WO2007134050A2 (en) 2006-05-09 2007-11-22 Genentech, Inc. Binding polypeptides with optimized scaffolds
WO2008085562A2 (en) 2006-09-20 2008-07-17 The Johns Hopkins University Combinatorieal therapy of cancer and infectious diseases with anti-b7-h1 antibodies
US20080226635A1 (en) 2006-12-22 2008-09-18 Hans Koll Antibodies against insulin-like growth factor I receptor and uses thereof
RU2561457C2 (en) 2007-04-03 2015-08-27 Эмджен Рисерч (Мьюник) Гмбх Cd3-epsilon-binding domain having interspecies specificity
CN100592373C (en) 2007-05-25 2010-02-24 群康科技(深圳)有限公司 Liquid crystal panel drive device and its drive method
WO2009089149A1 (en) 2008-01-03 2009-07-16 The Johns Hopkins University B7-h1 (cd274) antagonists induce apoptosis of tumor cells
US8747847B2 (en) 2008-02-11 2014-06-10 Curetech Ltd. Monoclonal antibodies for tumor treatment
EP2262837A4 (en) 2008-03-12 2011-04-06 Merck Sharp & Dohme Pd-1 binding proteins
US20110223188A1 (en) 2008-08-25 2011-09-15 Solomon Langermann Targeted costimulatory polypeptides and methods of use to treat cancer
BRPI0917592B1 (en) 2008-12-09 2021-08-17 Genentech, Inc ANTI-PD-L1 ANTIBODY, COMPOSITION, MANUFACTURED ARTICLES AND USES OF A COMPOSITION
RS56469B1 (en) 2009-11-24 2018-01-31 Medimmune Ltd Targeted binding agents against b7-h1
WO2011066342A2 (en) 2009-11-24 2011-06-03 Amplimmune, Inc. Simultaneous inhibition of pd-l1/pd-l2
AU2011205343B2 (en) 2010-01-12 2015-08-13 Nestec S.A. Methods for predicting response of triple-negative breast cancer to therapy
TWI481401B (en) 2010-01-27 2015-04-21 Takeda Pharmaceutical Medicament
US20130064831A1 (en) 2010-05-17 2013-03-14 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Immunotherapeutic dosing regimens and combinations thereof
CN103842030B (en) 2011-08-01 2018-07-31 霍夫曼-拉罗奇有限公司 Use the method for PD-1 axis binding antagonists and mek inhibitor treating cancer
CN116271013A (en) * 2011-10-14 2023-06-23 霍夫曼-拉罗奇有限公司 Use of the HER2 dimerization inhibitor pertuzumab and articles of manufacture comprising the HER2 dimerization inhibitor pertuzumab
DK2785375T3 (en) 2011-11-28 2020-10-12 Merck Patent Gmbh ANTI-PD-L1 ANTIBODIES AND USES THEREOF
WO2013173223A1 (en) 2012-05-15 2013-11-21 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Cancer immunotherapy by disrupting pd-1/pd-l1 signaling
WO2013172955A1 (en) 2012-05-15 2013-11-21 Diatech Oncology Tumor cell isolation/purification process and methods for use thereof
EP3553086A1 (en) 2012-05-31 2019-10-16 Sorrento Therapeutics Inc. Antigen binding proteins that bind pd-l1
US9682143B2 (en) 2012-08-14 2017-06-20 Ibc Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Combination therapy for inducing immune response to disease
US9149455B2 (en) 2012-11-09 2015-10-06 Abraxis Bioscience, Llc Methods of treating melanoma
MX363188B (en) 2012-11-30 2019-03-13 Hoffmann La Roche Identification of patients in need of pd-l1 inhibitor cotherapy.
DK2944323T3 (en) 2013-01-11 2019-04-15 Dingfu Biotarget Co Ltd Means for the treatment of tumors, their use and their method
KR102158924B1 (en) 2013-03-15 2020-09-22 제넨테크, 인크. Biomarkers and methods of treating pd-1 and pd-l1 related conditions
AR095363A1 (en) 2013-03-15 2015-10-14 Genentech Inc BIOMARKERS AND METHODS FOR THE TREATMENT OF CONDITIONS RELATED TO PD-1 AND PD-L1
SG11201509742QA (en) 2013-06-03 2015-12-30 Novartis Ag Combinations of an anti-pd-l1 antibody and a mek inhibitor and/or a braf inhibitor
AR097306A1 (en) 2013-08-20 2016-03-02 Merck Sharp & Dohme MODULATION OF TUMOR IMMUNITY
EP3808338A1 (en) 2013-09-11 2021-04-21 Eagle Biologics, Inc. Liquid protein formulations containing ionic liquids
AR097584A1 (en) 2013-09-12 2016-03-23 Hoffmann La Roche ANTIBODY COMBINATION THERAPY AGAINST HUMAN CSF-1R AND ANTIBODIES AGAINST HUMAN PD-L1
AU2014339900B2 (en) * 2013-10-25 2019-10-24 Dana-Farber Cancer Institute, Inc. Anti-PD-L1 monoclonal antibodies and fragments thereof
KR20160066554A (en) 2013-10-25 2016-06-10 파마싸이클릭스 엘엘씨 Treatment using bruton's tyrosine kinase inhibitors and immunotherapy
NZ720515A (en) 2013-12-17 2022-12-23 Genentech Inc Methods of treating cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes
CA2949121A1 (en) 2014-05-15 2015-11-19 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Treatment of lung cancer using a combination of an anti-pd-1 antibody and another anti-cancer agent
JP7032929B2 (en) 2014-07-11 2022-03-09 ヴェンタナ メディカル システムズ, インク. Anti-PD-L1 antibody and its diagnostic use
EP3310815A1 (en) 2015-06-17 2018-04-25 F. Hoffmann-La Roche AG Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes
BR112017028287A2 (en) 2015-06-29 2018-09-04 Syndax Pharmaceuticals Inc COMBINATION OF THE HDAC INHIBITOR AND ANTICORPIDE ANTI-PD- L1 FOR CANCER TREATMENT
WO2018064299A1 (en) 2016-09-29 2018-04-05 Genentech, Inc. Combination therapy with a mek inhibitor, a pd-1 axis inhibitor, and a taxane

Cited By (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US10570213B2 (en) 2013-12-17 2020-02-25 Genentech, Inc. Methods of treating cancers using PD-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes
US10596257B2 (en) 2016-01-08 2020-03-24 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Methods of treating CEA-positive cancers using PD-1 axis binding antagonists and anti-CEA/anti-CD3 bispecific antibodies

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
MX2017016353A (en) 2018-05-02
EP3310815A1 (en) 2018-04-25
AU2016280070B2 (en) 2022-09-15
KR20180018538A (en) 2018-02-21
AR105027A1 (en) 2017-08-30
JP2018522851A (en) 2018-08-16
WO2016205320A1 (en) 2016-12-22
HK1251493A1 (en) 2019-02-01
JP6896650B2 (en) 2021-06-30
US11154616B2 (en) 2021-10-26
US20220133886A1 (en) 2022-05-05
CN116327953A (en) 2023-06-27
JP2021167312A (en) 2021-10-21
AU2022287558A1 (en) 2023-02-02
MX2021010035A (en) 2021-09-14
AU2016280070A1 (en) 2017-12-07
IL256080A (en) 2018-02-28
CA2986263A1 (en) 2016-12-22
CN107771076A (en) 2018-03-06

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US20240076404A1 (en) Methods of treating cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes
US20200376119A1 (en) Methods of treating cea-positive cancers using pd-1 axis binding antagonists and anti-cea/anti-cd3 bispecific antibodies
US11154616B2 (en) Methods of treating locally advanced or metastatic breast cancers using PD-1 axis binding antagonists and taxanes
US20190315868A1 (en) Therapeutic and diagnostic methods for cancer

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
FEPP Fee payment procedure

Free format text: ENTITY STATUS SET TO UNDISCOUNTED (ORIGINAL EVENT CODE: BIG.); ENTITY STATUS OF PATENT OWNER: LARGE ENTITY

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: DOCKETED NEW CASE - READY FOR EXAMINATION

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: NON FINAL ACTION MAILED

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: RESPONSE TO NON-FINAL OFFICE ACTION ENTERED AND FORWARDED TO EXAMINER

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: NON FINAL ACTION MAILED

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: RESPONSE TO NON-FINAL OFFICE ACTION ENTERED AND FORWARDED TO EXAMINER

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: FINAL REJECTION MAILED

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: NON FINAL ACTION MAILED

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: RESPONSE TO NON-FINAL OFFICE ACTION ENTERED AND FORWARDED TO EXAMINER

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: NOTICE OF ALLOWANCE MAILED -- APPLICATION RECEIVED IN OFFICE OF PUBLICATIONS

STPP Information on status: patent application and granting procedure in general

Free format text: PUBLICATIONS -- ISSUE FEE PAYMENT VERIFIED

STCF Information on status: patent grant

Free format text: PATENTED CASE

CC Certificate of correction